CHAPTER
45. The Affidavit.
So
far as what there may be of a narrative in this book; and, indeed, as
indirectly touching one or two very interesting and curious particulars in the
habits of sperm whales, the foregoing chapter, in its earlier part, is as
important a one as will be found in this volume; but the leading matter of it
requires to be still further and more familiarly enlarged upon, in order to be
adequately understood, and moreover to take away any incredulity which a
profound ignorance of the entire subject may induce in some minds, as to the
natural verity of the main points of this affair.
I
care not to perform this part of my task methodically; but shall be content to
produce the desired impression by separate citations of items, practically or
reliably known to me as a whaleman; and from these citations, I take it—the
conclusion aimed at will naturally follow of itself.
First:
I have personally known three instances where a whale, after receiving a
harpoon, has effected a complete escape; and, after an interval (in one
instance of three years), has been again struck by the same hand, and slain;
when the two irons, both marked by the same private cypher, have been taken
from the body. In the instance where three years intervened between the
flinging of the two harpoons; and I think it may have been something more than
that; the man who darted them happening, in the interval, to go in a trading
ship on a voyage to Africa, went ashore there, joined a discovery party, and
penetrated far into the interior, where he travelled for a period of nearly two
years, often endangered by serpents, savages, tigers, poisonous miasmas, with
all the other common perils incident to wandering in the heart of unknown
regions. Meanwhile, the whale he had struck must also have been on its travels;
no doubt it had thrice circumnavigated the globe, brushing with its flanks all
the coasts of Africa; but to no purpose. This man and this whale again came
together, and the one vanquished the other. I say I, myself, have known three
instances similar to this; that is in two of them I saw the whales struck; and,
upon the second attack, saw the two irons with the respective marks cut in
them, afterwards taken from the dead fish. In the three-year instance, it so
fell out that I was in the boat both times, first and last, and the last time
distinctly recognised a peculiar sort of huge mole under the whale's eye, which
I had observed there three years previous. I say three years, but I am pretty
sure it was more than that. Here are three instances, then, which I personally
know the truth of; but I have heard of many other instances from persons whose
veracity in the matter there is no good ground to impeach.
Secondly:
It is well known in the Sperm Whale Fishery, however ignorant the world ashore
may be of it, that there have been several memorable historical instances where
a particular whale in the ocean has been at distant times and places popularly
cognisable. Why such a whale became thus marked was not altogether and
originally owing to his bodily peculiarities as distinguished from other
whales; for however peculiar in that respect any chance whale may be, they soon
put an end to his peculiarities by killing him, and boiling him down into a
peculiarly valuable oil. No: the reason was this: that from the fatal experiences
of the fishery there hung a terrible prestige of perilousness about such a
whale as there did about Rinaldo Rinaldini, insomuch that most fishermen were
content to recognise him by merely touching their tarpaulins when he would be
discovered lounging by them on the sea, without seeking to cultivate a more
intimate acquaintance. Like some poor devils ashore that happen to know an
irascible great man, they make distant unobtrusive salutations to him in the
street, lest if they pursued the acquaintance further, they might receive a
summary thump for their presumption.
But
not only did each of these famous whales enjoy great individual celebrity—Nay,
you may call it an ocean-wide renown; not only was he famous in life and now is
immortal in forecastle stories after death, but he was admitted into all the
rights, privileges, and distinctions of a name; had as much a name indeed as
Cambyses or Cæsar. Was it not so, O Timor Tom! thou famed leviathan, scarred
like an iceberg, who so long did'st lurk in the Oriental straits of that name,
whose spout was oft seen from the palmy beach of Ombay? Was it not so, O New
Zealand Jack! thou terror of all cruisers that crossed their wakes in the
vicinity of the Tattoo Land? Was it not so, O Morquan! King of Japan, whose lofty
jet they say at times assumed the semblance of a snow-white cross against the
sky? Was it not so, O Don Miguel! thou Chilian whale, marked like an old
tortoise with mystic hieroglyphics upon the back! In plain prose, here are four
whales as well known to the students of Cetacean History as Marius or Sylla to
the classic scholar.
But
this is not all. New Zealand Tom and Don Miguel, after at various times
creating great havoc among the boats of different vessels, were finally gone in
quest of, systematically hunted out, chased and killed by valiant whaling
captains, who heaved up their anchors with that express object as much in view,
as in setting out through the Narragansett Woods, Captain Butler of old had it
in his mind to capture that notorious murderous savage Annawon, the headmost
warrior of the Indian King Philip.
I
do not know where I can find a better place than just here, to make mention of
one or two other things, which to me seem important, as in printed form
establishing in all respects the reasonableness of the whole story of the White
Whale, more especially the catastrophe. For this is one of those disheartening
instances where truth requires full as much bolstering as error. So ignorant
are most landsmen of some of the plainest and most palpable wonders of the
world, that without some hints touching the plain facts, historical and
otherwise, of the fishery, they might scout at Moby Dick as a monstrous fable,
or still worse and more detestable, a hideous and intolerable allegory.
First:
Though most men have some vague flitting ideas of the general perils of the
grand fishery, yet they have nothing like a fixed, vivid conception of those
perils, and the frequency with which they recur. One reason perhaps is, that
not one in fifty of the actual disasters and deaths by casualties in the
fishery, ever finds a public record at home, however transient and immediately
forgotten that record. Do you suppose that that poor fellow there, who this
moment perhaps caught by the whale-line off the coast of New Guinea, is being
carried down to the bottom of the sea by the sounding leviathan—do you suppose
that that poor fellow's name will appear in the newspaper obituary you will
read to-morrow at your breakfast? No: because the mails are very irregular between
here and New Guinea. In fact, did you ever hear what might be called regular
news direct or indirect from New Guinea? Yet I tell you that upon one
particular voyage which I made to the Pacific, among many others we spoke
thirty different ships, every one of which had had a death by a whale, some of
them more than one, and three that had each lost a boat's crew. For God's sake,
be economical with your lamps and candles! not a gallon you burn, but at least
one drop of man's blood was spilled for it.
Secondly:
People ashore have indeed some indefinite idea that a whale is an enormous
creature of enormous power; but I have ever found that when narrating to them
some specific example of this two-fold enormousness, they have significantly
complimented me upon my facetiousness; when, I declare upon my soul, I had no
more idea of being facetious than Moses, when he wrote the history of the
plagues of Egypt.
But
fortunately the special point I here seek can be established upon testimony
entirely independent of my own. That point is this: The Sperm Whale is in some
cases sufficiently powerful, knowing, and judiciously malicious, as with direct
aforethought to stave in, utterly destroy, and sink a large ship; and what is
more, the Sperm Whale has done it.
First:
In the year 1820 the ship Essex, Captain Pollard, of Nantucket, was cruising in
the Pacific Ocean. One day she saw spouts, lowered her boats, and gave chase to
a shoal of sperm whales. Ere long, several of the whales were wounded; when,
suddenly, a very large whale escaping from the boats, issued from the shoal,
and bore directly down upon the ship. Dashing his forehead against her hull, he
so stove her in, that in less than “ten minutes” she settled down and fell
over. Not a surviving plank of her has been seen since. After the severest
exposure, part of the crew reached the land in their boats. Being returned home
at last, Captain Pollard once more sailed for the Pacific in command of another
ship, but the gods shipwrecked him again upon unknown rocks and breakers; for
the second time his ship was utterly lost, and forthwith forswearing the sea,
he has never tempted it since. At this day Captain Pollard is a resident of
Nantucket. I have seen Owen Chace, who was chief mate of the Essex at the time
of the tragedy; I have read his plain and faithful narrative; I have conversed
with his son; and all this within a few miles of the scene of the catastrophe.*
*The
following are extracts from Chace's narrative: “Every fact seemed to warrant me
in concluding that it was anything but chance which directed his operations; he
made two several attacks upon the ship, at a short interval between them, both
of which, according to their direction, were calculated to do us the most
injury, by being made ahead, and thereby combining the speed of the two objects
for the shock; to effect which, the exact manœuvres which he made were
necessary. His aspect was most horrible, and such as indicated resentment and
fury. He came directly from the shoal which we had just before entered, and in
which we had struck three of his companions, as if fired with revenge for their
sufferings.” Again: “At all events, the whole circumstances taken together, all
happening before my own eyes, and producing, at the time, impressions in my
mind of decided, calculating mischief, on the part of the whale (many of which
impressions I cannot now recall), induce me to be satisfied that I am correct
in my opinion.”
Here
are his reflections some time after quitting the ship, during a black night in
an open boat, when almost despairing of reaching any hospitable shore. “The
dark ocean and swelling waters were nothing; the fears of being swallowed up by
some dreadful tempest, or dashed upon hidden rocks, with all the other ordinary
subjects of fearful contemplation, seemed scarcely entitled to a moment's
thought; the dismal looking wreck, and the horrid aspect and revenge of the
whale, wholly engrossed my reflections, until day again made its appearance.”
In
another place—p. 45,—he speaks of “the mysterious and mortal attack of the
animal.”
Secondly:
The ship Union, also of Nantucket, was in the year 1807 totally lost off the
Azores by a similar onset, but the authentic particulars of this catastrophe I
have never chanced to encounter, though from the whale hunters I have now and
then heard casual allusions to it.
Thirdly:
Some eighteen or twenty years ago Commodore J——, then commanding an American
sloop-of-war of the first class, happened to be dining with a party of whaling
captains, on board a Nantucket ship in the harbor of Oahu, Sandwich Islands.
Conversation turning upon whales, the Commodore was pleased to be sceptical
touching the amazing strength ascribed to them by the professional gentlemen
present. He peremptorily denied for example, that any whale could so smite his
stout sloop-of-war as to cause her to leak so much as a thimbleful. Very good;
but there is more coming. Some weeks after, the Commodore set sail in this
impregnable craft for Valparaiso. But he was stopped on the way by a portly
sperm whale, that begged a few moments' confidential business with him. That
business consisted in fetching the Commodore's craft such a thwack, that with
all his pumps going he made straight for the nearest port to heave down and
repair. I am not superstitious, but I consider the Commodore's interview with
that whale as providential. Was not Saul of Tarsus converted from unbelief by a
similar fright? I tell you, the sperm whale will stand no nonsense.
I
will now refer you to Langsdorff's Voyages for a little circumstance in point,
peculiarly interesting to the writer hereof. Langsdorff, you must know by the
way, was attached to the Russian Admiral Krusenstern's famous Discovery
Expedition in the beginning of the present century. Captain Langsdorff thus
begins his seventeenth chapter:
“By
the thirteenth of May our ship was ready to sail, and the next day we were out
in the open sea, on our way to Ochotsh. The weather was very clear and fine,
but so intolerably cold that we were obliged to keep on our fur clothing. For
some days we had very little wind; it was not till the nineteenth that a brisk
gale from the northwest sprang up. An uncommon large whale, the body of which
was larger than the ship itself, lay almost at the surface of the water, but
was not perceived by any one on board till the moment when the ship, which was
in full sail, was almost upon him, so that it was impossible to prevent its
striking against him. We were thus placed in the most imminent danger, as this
gigantic creature, setting up its back, raised the ship three feet at least out
of the water. The masts reeled, and the sails fell altogether, while we who
were below all sprang instantly upon the deck, concluding that we had struck
upon some rock; instead of this we saw the monster sailing off with the utmost
gravity and solemnity. Captain D'Wolf applied immediately to the pumps to
examine whether or not the vessel had received any damage from the shock, but
we found that very happily it had escaped entirely uninjured.”
Now,
the Captain D'Wolf here alluded to as commanding the ship in question, is a New
Englander, who, after a long life of unusual adventures as a sea-captain, this
day resides in the village of Dorchester near Boston. I have the honor of being
a nephew of his. I have particularly questioned him concerning this passage in
Langsdorff. He substantiates every word. The ship, however, was by no means a
large one: a Russian craft built on the Siberian coast, and purchased by my
uncle after bartering away the vessel in which he sailed from home.
In
that up and down manly book of old-fashioned adventure, so full, too, of honest
wonders—the voyage of Lionel Wafer, one of ancient Dampier's old chums—I found
a little matter set down so like that just quoted from Langsdorff, that I
cannot forbear inserting it here for a corroborative example, if such be
needed.
Lionel,
it seems, was on his way to “John Ferdinando,” as he calls the modern Juan
Fernandes. “In our way thither,” he says, “about four o'clock in the morning,
when we were about one hundred and fifty leagues from the Main of America, our
ship felt a terrible shock, which put our men in such consternation that they
could hardly tell where they were or what to think; but every one began to
prepare for death. And, indeed, the shock was so sudden and violent, that we
took it for granted the ship had struck against a rock; but when the amazement
was a little over, we cast the lead, and sounded, but found no ground. * * * *
* The suddenness of the shock made the guns leap in their carriages, and
several of the men were shaken out of their hammocks. Captain Davis, who lay
with his head on a gun, was thrown out of his cabin!” Lionel then goes on to
impute the shock to an earthquake, and seems to substantiate the imputation by
stating that a great earthquake, somewhere about that time, did actually do
great mischief along the Spanish land. But I should not much wonder if, in the
darkness of that early hour of the morning, the shock was after all caused by
an unseen whale vertically bumping the hull from beneath.
I
might proceed with several more examples, one way or another known to me, of
the great power and malice at times of the sperm whale. In more than one
instance, he has been known, not only to chase the assailing boats back to
their ships, but to pursue the ship itself, and long withstand all the lances
hurled at him from its decks. The English ship Pusie Hall can tell a story on
that head; and, as for his strength, let me say, that there have been examples
where the lines attached to a running sperm whale have, in a calm, been
transferred to the ship, and secured there; the whale towing her great hull
through the water, as a horse walks off with a cart. Again, it is very often
observed that, if the sperm whale, once struck, is allowed time to rally, he
then acts, not so often with blind rage, as with wilful, deliberate designs of
destruction to his pursuers; nor is it without conveying some eloquent
indication of his character, that upon being attacked he will frequently open
his mouth, and retain it in that dread expansion for several consecutive
minutes. But I must be content with only one more and a concluding illustration;
a remarkable and most significant one, by which you will not fail to see, that
not only is the most marvellous event in this book corroborated by plain facts
of the present day, but that these marvels (like all marvels) are mere
repetitions of the ages; so that for the millionth time we say amen with
Solomon—Verily there is nothing new under the sun.
In
the sixth Christian century lived Procopius, a Christian magistrate of
Constantinople, in the days when Justinian was Emperor and Belisarius general.
As many know, he wrote the history of his own times, a work every way of
uncommon value. By the best authorities, he has always been considered a most
trustworthy and unexaggerating historian, except in some one or two
particulars, not at all affecting the matter presently to be mentioned.
Now,
in this history of his, Procopius mentions that, during the term of his
prefecture at Constantinople, a great sea-monster was captured in the
neighboring Propontis, or Sea of Marmora, after having destroyed vessels at
intervals in those waters for a period of more than fifty years. A fact thus
set down in substantial history cannot easily be gainsaid. Nor is there any
reason it should be. Of what precise species this sea-monster was, is not
mentioned. But as he destroyed ships, as well as for other reasons, he must
have been a whale; and I am strongly inclined to think a sperm whale. And I
will tell you why. For a long time I fancied that the sperm whale had been
always unknown in the Mediterranean and the deep waters connecting with it.
Even now I am certain that those seas are not, and perhaps never can be, in the
present constitution of things, a place for his habitual gregarious resort. But
further investigations have recently proved to me, that in modern times there
have been isolated instances of the presence of the sperm whale in the
Mediterranean. I am told, on good authority, that on the Barbary coast, a
Commodore Davis of the British navy found the skeleton of a sperm whale. Now,
as a vessel of war readily passes through the Dardanelles, hence a sperm whale
could, by the same route, pass out of the Mediterranean into the Propontis.
In
the Propontis, as far as I can learn, none of that peculiar substance called
brit is to be found, the aliment of the right whale. But I have every reason to
believe that the food of the sperm whale—squid or cuttle-fish—lurks at the
bottom of that sea, because large creatures, but by no means the largest of
that sort, have been found at its surface. If, then, you properly put these
statements together, and reason upon them a bit, you will clearly perceive
that, according to all human reasoning, Procopius's sea-monster, that for half
a century stove the ships of a Roman Emperor, must in all probability have been
a sperm whale.
CHAPTER
46. Surmises.
Though,
consumed with the hot fire of his purpose, Ahab in all his thoughts and actions
ever had in view the ultimate capture of Moby Dick; though he seemed ready to
sacrifice all mortal interests to that one passion; nevertheless it may have
been that he was by nature and long habituation far too wedded to a fiery
whaleman's ways, altogether to abandon the collateral prosecution of the
voyage. Or at least if this were otherwise, there were not wanting other
motives much more influential with him. It would be refining too much, perhaps,
even considering his monomania, to hint that his vindictiveness towards the
White Whale might have possibly extended itself in some degree to all sperm
whales, and that the more monsters he slew by so much the more he multiplied the
chances that each subsequently encountered whale would prove to be the hated
one he hunted. But if such an hypothesis be indeed exceptionable, there were
still additional considerations which, though not so strictly according with
the wildness of his ruling passion, yet were by no means incapable of swaying
him.
To
accomplish his object Ahab must use tools; and of all tools used in the shadow
of the moon, men are most apt to get out of order. He knew, for example, that
however magnetic his ascendency in some respects was over Starbuck, yet that
ascendency did not cover the complete spiritual man any more than mere
corporeal superiority involves intellectual mastership; for to the purely
spiritual, the intellectual but stand in a sort of corporeal relation.
Starbuck's body and Starbuck's coerced will were Ahab's, so long as Ahab kept
his magnet at Starbuck's brain; still he knew that for all this the chief mate,
in his soul, abhorred his captain's quest, and could he, would joyfully
disintegrate himself from it, or even frustrate it. It might be that a long
interval would elapse ere the White Whale was seen. During that long interval
Starbuck would ever be apt to fall into open relapses of rebellion against his
captain's leadership, unless some ordinary, prudential, circumstantial
influences were brought to bear upon him. Not only that, but the subtle
insanity of Ahab respecting Moby Dick was noways more significantly manifested
than in his superlative sense and shrewdness in foreseeing that, for the present,
the hunt should in some way be stripped of that strange imaginative impiousness
which naturally invested it; that the full terror of the voyage must be kept
withdrawn into the obscure background (for few men's courage is proof against
protracted meditation unrelieved by action); that when they stood their long
night watches, his officers and men must have some nearer things to think of
than Moby Dick. For however eagerly and impetuously the savage crew had hailed
the announcement of his quest; yet all sailors of all sorts are more or less
capricious and unreliable—they live in the varying outer weather, and they
inhale its fickleness—and when retained for any object remote and blank in the
pursuit, however promissory of life and passion in the end, it is above all
things requisite that temporary interests and employments should intervene and
hold them healthily suspended for the final dash.
Nor
was Ahab unmindful of another thing. In times of strong emotion mankind disdain
all base considerations; but such times are evanescent. The permanent
constitutional condition of the manufactured man, thought Ahab, is sordidness.
Granting that the White Whale fully incites the hearts of this my savage crew,
and playing round their savageness even breeds a certain generous
knight-errantism in them, still, while for the love of it they give chase to
Moby Dick, they must also have food for their more common, daily appetites. For
even the high lifted and chivalric Crusaders of old times were not content to
traverse two thousand miles of land to fight for their holy sepulchre, without
committing burglaries, picking pockets, and gaining other pious perquisites by
the way. Had they been strictly held to their one final and romantic
object—that final and romantic object, too many would have turned from in
disgust. I will not strip these men, thought Ahab, of all hopes of cash—aye,
cash. They may scorn cash now; but let some months go by, and no perspective
promise of it to them, and then this same quiescent cash all at once mutinying
in them, this same cash would soon cashier Ahab.
Nor
was there wanting still another precautionary motive more related to Ahab
personally. Having impulsively, it is probable, and perhaps somewhat
prematurely revealed the prime but private purpose of the Pequod's voyage, Ahab
was now entirely conscious that, in so doing, he had indirectly laid himself
open to the unanswerable charge of usurpation; and with perfect impunity, both
moral and legal, his crew if so disposed, and to that end competent, could
refuse all further obedience to him, and even violently wrest from him the
command. From even the barely hinted imputation of usurpation, and the possible
consequences of such a suppressed impression gaining ground, Ahab must of
course have been most anxious to protect himself. That protection could only
consist in his own predominating brain and heart and hand, backed by a heedful,
closely calculating attention to every minute atmospheric influence which it
was possible for his crew to be subjected to.
For
all these reasons then, and others perhaps too analytic to be verbally
developed here, Ahab plainly saw that he must still in a good degree continue
true to the natural, nominal purpose of the Pequod's voyage; observe all
customary usages; and not only that, but force himself to evince all his well
known passionate interest in the general pursuit of his profession.
Be
all this as it may, his voice was now often heard hailing the three mast-heads
and admonishing them to keep a bright look-out, and not omit reporting even a
porpoise. This vigilance was not long without reward.
CHAPTER
47. The Mat-Maker.
It
was a cloudy, sultry afternoon; the seamen were lazily lounging about the
decks, or vacantly gazing over into the lead-coloured waters. Queequeg and I
were mildly employed weaving what is called a sword-mat, for an additional
lashing to our boat. So still and subdued and yet somehow preluding was all the
scene, and such an incantation of reverie lurked in the air, that each silent
sailor seemed resolved into his own invisible self.
I
was the attendant or page of Queequeg, while busy at the mat. As I kept passing
and repassing the filling or woof of marline between the long yarns of the
warp, using my own hand for the shuttle, and as Queequeg, standing sideways,
ever and anon slid his heavy oaken sword between the threads, and idly looking
off upon the water, carelessly and unthinkingly drove home every yarn: I say so
strange a dreaminess did there then reign all over the ship and all over the
sea, only broken by the intermitting dull sound of the sword, that it seemed as
if this were the Loom of Time, and I myself were a shuttle mechanically weaving
and weaving away at the Fates. There lay the fixed threads of the warp subject
to but one single, ever returning, unchanging vibration, and that vibration
merely enough to admit of the crosswise interblending of other threads with its
own. This warp seemed necessity; and here, thought I, with my own hand I ply my
own shuttle and weave my own destiny into these unalterable threads. Meantime,
Queequeg's impulsive, indifferent sword, sometimes hitting the woof slantingly,
or crookedly, or strongly, or weakly, as the case might be; and by this
difference in the concluding blow producing a corresponding contrast in the
final aspect of the completed fabric; this savage's sword, thought I, which
thus finally shapes and fashions both warp and woof; this easy, indifferent
sword must be chance—aye, chance, free will, and necessity—no wise
incompatible—all interweavingly working together. The straight warp of
necessity, not to be swerved from its ultimate course—its every alternating
vibration, indeed, only tending to that; free will still free to ply her
shuttle between given threads; and chance, though restrained in its play within
the right lines of necessity, and sideways in its motions directed by free
will, though thus prescribed to by both, chance by turns rules either, and has
the last featuring blow at events.
Thus
we were weaving and weaving away when I started at a sound so strange, long
drawn, and musically wild and unearthly, that the ball of free will dropped from
my hand, and I stood gazing up at the clouds whence that voice dropped like a
wing. High aloft in the cross-trees was that mad Gay-Header, Tashtego. His body
was reaching eagerly forward, his hand stretched out like a wand, and at brief
sudden intervals he continued his cries. To be sure the same sound was that
very moment perhaps being heard all over the seas, from hundreds of whalemen's
look-outs perched as high in the air; but from few of those lungs could that
accustomed old cry have derived such a marvellous cadence as from Tashtego the
Indian's.
As
he stood hovering over you half suspended in air, so wildly and eagerly peering
towards the horizon, you would have thought him some prophet or seer beholding
the shadows of Fate, and by those wild cries announcing their coming.
“There
she blows! there! there! there! she blows! she blows!”
“Where-away?”
“On
the lee-beam, about two miles off! a school of them!”
Instantly
all was commotion.
The
Sperm Whale blows as a clock ticks, with the same undeviating and reliable
uniformity. And thereby whalemen distinguish this fish from other tribes of his
genus.
“There
go flukes!” was now the cry from Tashtego; and the whales disappeared.
“Quick,
steward!” cried Ahab. “Time! time!”
Dough-Boy
hurried below, glanced at the watch, and reported the exact minute to Ahab.
The
ship was now kept away from the wind, and she went gently rolling before it.
Tashtego reporting that the whales had gone down heading to leeward, we
confidently looked to see them again directly in advance of our bows. For that
singular craft at times evinced by the Sperm Whale when, sounding with his head
in one direction, he nevertheless, while concealed beneath the surface, mills
round, and swiftly swims off in the opposite quarter—this deceitfulness of his
could not now be in action; for there was no reason to suppose that the fish
seen by Tashtego had been in any way alarmed, or indeed knew at all of our
vicinity. One of the men selected for shipkeepers—that is, those not appointed
to the boats, by this time relieved the Indian at the main-mast head. The
sailors at the fore and mizzen had come down; the line tubs were fixed in their
places; the cranes were thrust out; the mainyard was backed, and the three
boats swung over the sea like three samphire baskets over high cliffs. Outside
of the bulwarks their eager crews with one hand clung to the rail, while one
foot was expectantly poised on the gunwale. So look the long line of
man-of-war's men about to throw themselves on board an enemy's ship.
But
at this critical instant a sudden exclamation was heard that took every eye
from the whale. With a start all glared at dark Ahab, who was surrounded by
five dusky phantoms that seemed fresh formed out of air.
CHAPTER
48. The First Lowering.
The
phantoms, for so they then seemed, were flitting on the other side of the deck,
and, with a noiseless celerity, were casting loose the tackles and bands of the
boat which swung there. This boat had always been deemed one of the spare
boats, though technically called the captain's, on account of its hanging from
the starboard quarter. The figure that now stood by its bows was tall and
swart, with one white tooth evilly protruding from its steel-like lips. A
rumpled Chinese jacket of black cotton funereally invested him, with wide black
trowsers of the same dark stuff. But strangely crowning this ebonness was a
glistening white plaited turban, the living hair braided and coiled round and
round upon his head. Less swart in aspect, the companions of this figure were
of that vivid, tiger-yellow complexion peculiar to some of the aboriginal
natives of the Manillas;—a race notorious for a certain diabolism of subtilty,
and by some honest white mariners supposed to be the paid spies and secret
confidential agents on the water of the devil, their lord, whose counting-room
they suppose to be elsewhere.
While
yet the wondering ship's company were gazing upon these strangers, Ahab cried
out to the white-turbaned old man at their head, “All ready there, Fedallah?”
“Ready,”
was the half-hissed reply.
“Lower
away then; d'ye hear?” shouting across the deck. “Lower away there, I say.”
Such
was the thunder of his voice, that spite of their amazement the men sprang over
the rail; the sheaves whirled round in the blocks; with a wallow, the three
boats dropped into the sea; while, with a dexterous, off-handed daring, unknown
in any other vocation, the sailors, goat-like, leaped down the rolling ship's
side into the tossed boats below.
Hardly
had they pulled out from under the ship's lee, when a fourth keel, coming from
the windward side, pulled round under the stern, and showed the five strangers
rowing Ahab, who, standing erect in the stern, loudly hailed Starbuck, Stubb,
and Flask, to spread themselves widely, so as to cover a large expanse of
water. But with all their eyes again riveted upon the swart Fedallah and his
crew, the inmates of the other boats obeyed not the command.
“Captain
Ahab?—” said Starbuck.
“Spread
yourselves,” cried Ahab; “give way, all four boats. Thou, Flask, pull out more
to leeward!”
“Aye,
aye, sir,” cheerily cried little King-Post, sweeping round his great steering
oar. “Lay back!” addressing his crew. “There!—there!—there again! There she
blows right ahead, boys!—lay back!”
“Never
heed yonder yellow boys, Archy.”
“Oh,
I don't mind 'em, sir,” said Archy; “I knew it all before now. Didn't I hear
'em in the hold? And didn't I tell Cabaco here of it? What say ye, Cabaco? They
are stowaways, Mr. Flask.”
“Pull,
pull, my fine hearts-alive; pull, my children; pull, my little ones,”
drawlingly and soothingly sighed Stubb to his crew, some of whom still showed
signs of uneasiness. “Why don't you break your backbones, my boys? What is it
you stare at? Those chaps in yonder boat? Tut! They are only five more hands
come to help us—never mind from where—the more the merrier. Pull, then, do
pull; never mind the brimstone—devils are good fellows enough. So, so; there
you are now; that's the stroke for a thousand pounds; that's the stroke to
sweep the stakes! Hurrah for the gold cup of sperm oil, my heroes! Three
cheers, men—all hearts alive! Easy, easy; don't be in a hurry—don't be in a
hurry. Why don't you snap your oars, you rascals? Bite something, you dogs! So,
so, so, then:—softly, softly! That's it—that's it! long and strong. Give way
there, give way! The devil fetch ye, ye ragamuffin rapscallions; ye are all
asleep. Stop snoring, ye sleepers, and pull. Pull, will ye? pull, can't ye?
pull, won't ye? Why in the name of gudgeons and ginger-cakes don't ye
pull?—pull and break something! pull, and start your eyes out! Here!” whipping
out the sharp knife from his girdle; “every mother's son of ye draw his knife,
and pull with the blade between his teeth. That's it—that's it. Now ye do
something; that looks like it, my steel-bits. Start her—start her, my
silver-spoons! Start her, marling-spikes!”
Stubb's
exordium to his crew is given here at large, because he had rather a peculiar
way of talking to them in general, and especially in inculcating the religion
of rowing. But you must not suppose from this specimen of his sermonizings that
he ever flew into downright passions with his congregation. Not at all; and
therein consisted his chief peculiarity. He would say the most terrific things
to his crew, in a tone so strangely compounded of fun and fury, and the fury
seemed so calculated merely as a spice to the fun, that no oarsman could hear
such queer invocations without pulling for dear life, and yet pulling for the
mere joke of the thing. Besides he all the time looked so easy and indolent
himself, so loungingly managed his steering-oar, and so broadly
gaped—open-mouthed at times—that the mere sight of such a yawning commander, by
sheer force of contrast, acted like a charm upon the crew. Then again, Stubb
was one of those odd sort of humorists, whose jollity is sometimes so curiously
ambiguous, as to put all inferiors on their guard in the matter of obeying
them.
In
obedience to a sign from Ahab, Starbuck was now pulling obliquely across
Stubb's bow; and when for a minute or so the two boats were pretty near to each
other, Stubb hailed the mate.
“Mr.
Starbuck! larboard boat there, ahoy! a word with ye, sir, if ye please!”
“Halloa!”
returned Starbuck, turning round not a single inch as he spoke; still earnestly
but whisperingly urging his crew; his face set like a flint from Stubb's.
“What
think ye of those yellow boys, sir!”
“Smuggled
on board, somehow, before the ship sailed. (Strong, strong, boys!)” in a whisper
to his crew, then speaking out loud again: “A sad business, Mr. Stubb! (seethe
her, seethe her, my lads!) but never mind, Mr. Stubb, all for the best. Let all
your crew pull strong, come what will. (Spring, my men, spring!) There's
hogsheads of sperm ahead, Mr. Stubb, and that's what ye came for. (Pull, my
boys!) Sperm, sperm's the play! This at least is duty; duty and profit hand in
hand.”
“Aye,
aye, I thought as much,” soliloquized Stubb, when the boats diverged, “as soon
as I clapt eye on 'em, I thought so. Aye, and that's what he went into the
after hold for, so often, as Dough-Boy long suspected. They were hidden down
there. The White Whale's at the bottom of it. Well, well, so be it! Can't be
helped! All right! Give way, men! It ain't the White Whale to-day! Give way!”
Now
the advent of these outlandish strangers at such a critical instant as the
lowering of the boats from the deck, this had not unreasonably awakened a sort
of superstitious amazement in some of the ship's company; but Archy's fancied
discovery having some time previous got abroad among them, though indeed not
credited then, this had in some small measure prepared them for the event. It
took off the extreme edge of their wonder; and so what with all this and
Stubb's confident way of accounting for their appearance, they were for the
time freed from superstitious surmisings; though the affair still left abundant
room for all manner of wild conjectures as to dark Ahab's precise agency in the
matter from the beginning. For me, I silently recalled the mysterious shadows I
had seen creeping on board the Pequod during the dim Nantucket dawn, as well as
the enigmatical hintings of the unaccountable Elijah.
Meantime,
Ahab, out of hearing of his officers, having sided the furthest to windward,
was still ranging ahead of the other boats; a circumstance bespeaking how
potent a crew was pulling him. Those tiger yellow creatures of his seemed all
steel and whalebone; like five trip-hammers they rose and fell with regular
strokes of strength, which periodically started the boat along the water like a
horizontal burst boiler out of a Mississippi steamer. As for Fedallah, who was
seen pulling the harpooneer oar, he had thrown aside his black jacket, and
displayed his naked chest with the whole part of his body above the gunwale,
clearly cut against the alternating depressions of the watery horizon; while at
the other end of the boat Ahab, with one arm, like a fencer's, thrown half
backward into the air, as if to counterbalance any tendency to trip; Ahab was
seen steadily managing his steering oar as in a thousand boat lowerings ere the
White Whale had torn him. All at once the outstretched arm gave a peculiar
motion and then remained fixed, while the boat's five oars were seen
simultaneously peaked. Boat and crew sat motionless on the sea. Instantly the
three spread boats in the rear paused on their way. The whales had irregularly
settled bodily down into the blue, thus giving no distantly discernible token
of the movement, though from his closer vicinity Ahab had observed it.
“Every
man look out along his oars!” cried Starbuck. “Thou, Queequeg, stand up!”
Nimbly
springing up on the triangular raised box in the bow, the savage stood erect
there, and with intensely eager eyes gazed off towards the spot where the chase
had last been descried. Likewise upon the extreme stern of the boat where it
was also triangularly platformed level with the gunwale, Starbuck himself was
seen coolly and adroitly balancing himself to the jerking tossings of his chip
of a craft, and silently eyeing the vast blue eye of the sea.
Not
very far distant Flask's boat was also lying breathlessly still; its commander
recklessly standing upon the top of the loggerhead, a stout sort of post rooted
in the keel, and rising some two feet above the level of the stern platform. It
is used for catching turns with the whale line. Its top is not more spacious
than the palm of a man's hand, and standing upon such a base as that, Flask
seemed perched at the mast-head of some ship which had sunk to all but her
trucks. But little King-Post was small and short, and at the same time little
King-Post was full of a large and tall ambition, so that this loggerhead
stand-point of his did by no means satisfy King-Post.
“I
can't see three seas off; tip us up an oar there, and let me on to that.”
Upon
this, Daggoo, with either hand upon the gunwale to steady his way, swiftly slid
aft, and then erecting himself volunteered his lofty shoulders for a pedestal.
“Good
a mast-head as any, sir. Will you mount?”
“That
I will, and thank ye very much, my fine fellow; only I wish you fifty feet
taller.”
Whereupon
planting his feet firmly against two opposite planks of the boat, the gigantic
negro, stooping a little, presented his flat palm to Flask's foot, and then
putting Flask's hand on his hearse-plumed head and bidding him spring as he
himself should toss, with one dexterous fling landed the little man high and
dry on his shoulders. And here was Flask now standing, Daggoo with one lifted
arm furnishing him with a breastband to lean against and steady himself by.
At
any time it is a strange sight to the tyro to see with what wondrous habitude
of unconscious skill the whaleman will maintain an erect posture in his boat,
even when pitched about by the most riotously perverse and cross-running seas.
Still more strange to see him giddily perched upon the loggerhead itself, under
such circumstances. But the sight of little Flask mounted upon gigantic Daggoo
was yet more curious; for sustaining himself with a cool, indifferent, easy,
unthought of, barbaric majesty, the noble negro to every roll of the sea
harmoniously rolled his fine form. On his broad back, flaxen-haired Flask
seemed a snow-flake. The bearer looked nobler than the rider. Though truly
vivacious, tumultuous, ostentatious little Flask would now and then stamp with
impatience; but not one added heave did he thereby give to the negro's lordly
chest. So have I seen Passion and Vanity stamping the living magnanimous earth,
but the earth did not alter her tides and her seasons for that.
Meanwhile
Stubb, the third mate, betrayed no such far-gazing solicitudes. The whales
might have made one of their regular soundings, not a temporary dive from mere
fright; and if that were the case, Stubb, as his wont in such cases, it seems,
was resolved to solace the languishing interval with his pipe. He withdrew it
from his hatband, where he always wore it aslant like a feather. He loaded it,
and rammed home the loading with his thumb-end; but hardly had he ignited his
match across the rough sandpaper of his hand, when Tashtego, his harpooneer,
whose eyes had been setting to windward like two fixed stars, suddenly dropped
like light from his erect attitude to his seat, crying out in a quick phrensy
of hurry, “Down, down all, and give way!—there they are!”
To
a landsman, no whale, nor any sign of a herring, would have been visible at
that moment; nothing but a troubled bit of greenish white water, and thin
scattered puffs of vapor hovering over it, and suffusingly blowing off to
leeward, like the confused scud from white rolling billows. The air around
suddenly vibrated and tingled, as it were, like the air over intensely heated
plates of iron. Beneath this atmospheric waving and curling, and partially
beneath a thin layer of water, also, the whales were swimming. Seen in advance
of all the other indications, the puffs of vapor they spouted, seemed their
forerunning couriers and detached flying outriders.
All
four boats were now in keen pursuit of that one spot of troubled water and air.
But it bade fair to outstrip them; it flew on and on, as a mass of
interblending bubbles borne down a rapid stream from the hills.
“Pull,
pull, my good boys,” said Starbuck, in the lowest possible but intensest
concentrated whisper to his men; while the sharp fixed glance from his eyes
darted straight ahead of the bow, almost seemed as two visible needles in two
unerring binnacle compasses. He did not say much to his crew, though, nor did
his crew say anything to him. Only the silence of the boat was at intervals
startlingly pierced by one of his peculiar whispers, now harsh with command,
now soft with entreaty.
How
different the loud little King-Post. “Sing out and say something, my hearties.
Roar and pull, my thunderbolts! Beach me, beach me on their black backs, boys;
only do that for me, and I'll sign over to you my Martha's Vineyard plantation,
boys; including wife and children, boys. Lay me on—lay me on! O Lord, Lord! but
I shall go stark, staring mad! See! see that white water!” And so shouting, he
pulled his hat from his head, and stamped up and down on it; then picking it
up, flirted it far off upon the sea; and finally fell to rearing and plunging
in the boat's stern like a crazed colt from the prairie.
“Look
at that chap now,” philosophically drawled Stubb, who, with his unlighted short
pipe, mechanically retained between his teeth, at a short distance, followed
after—“He's got fits, that Flask has. Fits? yes, give him fits—that's the very
word—pitch fits into 'em. Merrily, merrily, hearts-alive. Pudding for supper,
you know;—merry's the word. Pull, babes—pull, sucklings—pull, all. But what the
devil are you hurrying about? Softly, softly, and steadily, my men. Only pull,
and keep pulling; nothing more. Crack all your backbones, and bite your knives
in two—that's all. Take it easy—why don't ye take it easy, I say, and burst all
your livers and lungs!”
But
what it was that inscrutable Ahab said to that tiger-yellow crew of his—these were
words best omitted here; for you live under the blessed light of the
evangelical land. Only the infidel sharks in the audacious seas may give ear to
such words, when, with tornado brow, and eyes of red murder, and foam-glued
lips, Ahab leaped after his prey.
Meanwhile,
all the boats tore on. The repeated specific allusions of Flask to “that
whale,” as he called the fictitious monster which he declared to be incessantly
tantalizing his boat's bow with its tail—these allusions of his were at times
so vivid and life-like, that they would cause some one or two of his men to
snatch a fearful look over the shoulder. But this was against all rule; for the
oarsmen must put out their eyes, and ram a skewer through their necks; usage
pronouncing that they must have no organs but ears, and no limbs but arms, in
these critical moments.
It
was a sight full of quick wonder and awe! The vast swells of the omnipotent
sea; the surging, hollow roar they made, as they rolled along the eight
gunwales, like gigantic bowls in a boundless bowling-green; the brief suspended
agony of the boat, as it would tip for an instant on the knife-like edge of the
sharper waves, that almost seemed threatening to cut it in two; the sudden
profound dip into the watery glens and hollows; the keen spurrings and goadings
to gain the top of the opposite hill; the headlong, sled-like slide down its
other side;—all these, with the cries of the headsmen and harpooneers, and the
shuddering gasps of the oarsmen, with the wondrous sight of the ivory Pequod
bearing down upon her boats with outstretched sails, like a wild hen after her
screaming brood;—all this was thrilling.
Not
the raw recruit, marching from the bosom of his wife into the fever heat of his
first battle; not the dead man's ghost encountering the first unknown phantom
in the other world;—neither of these can feel stranger and stronger emotions
than that man does, who for the first time finds himself pulling into the
charmed, churned circle of the hunted sperm whale.
The
dancing white water made by the chase was now becoming more and more visible,
owing to the increasing darkness of the dun cloud-shadows flung upon the sea.
The jets of vapor no longer blended, but tilted everywhere to right and left;
the whales seemed separating their wakes. The boats were pulled more apart;
Starbuck giving chase to three whales running dead to leeward. Our sail was now
set, and, with the still rising wind, we rushed along; the boat going with such
madness through the water, that the lee oars could scarcely be worked rapidly
enough to escape being torn from the row-locks.
Soon
we were running through a suffusing wide veil of mist; neither ship nor boat to
be seen.
“Give
way, men,” whispered Starbuck, drawing still further aft the sheet of his sail;
“there is time to kill a fish yet before the squall comes. There's white water
again!—close to! Spring!”
Soon
after, two cries in quick succession on each side of us denoted that the other
boats had got fast; but hardly were they overheard, when with a lightning-like
hurtling whisper Starbuck said: “Stand up!” and Queequeg, harpoon in hand,
sprang to his feet.
Though
not one of the oarsmen was then facing the life and death peril so close to
them ahead, yet with their eyes on the intense countenance of the mate in the
stern of the boat, they knew that the imminent instant had come; they heard,
too, an enormous wallowing sound as of fifty elephants stirring in their
litter. Meanwhile the boat was still booming through the mist, the waves
curling and hissing around us like the erected crests of enraged serpents.
“That's
his hump. There, there, give it to him!” whispered Starbuck.
A
short rushing sound leaped out of the boat; it was the darted iron of Queequeg.
Then all in one welded commotion came an invisible push from astern, while
forward the boat seemed striking on a ledge; the sail collapsed and exploded; a
gush of scalding vapor shot up near by; something rolled and tumbled like an
earthquake beneath us. The whole crew were half suffocated as they were tossed
helter-skelter into the white curdling cream of the squall. Squall, whale, and
harpoon had all blended together; and the whale, merely grazed by the iron,
escaped.
Though
completely swamped, the boat was nearly unharmed. Swimming round it we picked
up the floating oars, and lashing them across the gunwale, tumbled back to our
places. There we sat up to our knees in the sea, the water covering every rib
and plank, so that to our downward gazing eyes the suspended craft seemed a
coral boat grown up to us from the bottom of the ocean.
The
wind increased to a howl; the waves dashed their bucklers together; the whole
squall roared, forked, and crackled around us like a white fire upon the
prairie, in which, unconsumed, we were burning; immortal in these jaws of
death! In vain we hailed the other boats; as well roar to the live coals down
the chimney of a flaming furnace as hail those boats in that storm. Meanwhile
the driving scud, rack, and mist, grew darker with the shadows of night; no
sign of the ship could be seen. The rising sea forbade all attempts to bale out
the boat. The oars were useless as propellers, performing now the office of
life-preservers. So, cutting the lashing of the waterproof match keg, after
many failures Starbuck contrived to ignite the lamp in the lantern; then
stretching it on a waif pole, handed it to Queequeg as the standard-bearer of
this forlorn hope. There, then, he sat, holding up that imbecile candle in the
heart of that almighty forlornness. There, then, he sat, the sign and symbol of
a man without faith, hopelessly holding up hope in the midst of despair.
Wet,
drenched through, and shivering cold, despairing of ship or boat, we lifted up
our eyes as the dawn came on. The mist still spread over the sea, the empty
lantern lay crushed in the bottom of the boat. Suddenly Queequeg started to his
feet, hollowing his hand to his ear. We all heard a faint creaking, as of ropes
and yards hitherto muffled by the storm. The sound came nearer and nearer; the
thick mists were dimly parted by a huge, vague form. Affrighted, we all sprang
into the sea as the ship at last loomed into view, bearing right down upon us
within a distance of not much more than its length.
Floating
on the waves we saw the abandoned boat, as for one instant it tossed and gaped
beneath the ship's bows like a chip at the base of a cataract; and then the
vast hull rolled over it, and it was seen no more till it came up weltering
astern. Again we swam for it, were dashed against it by the seas, and were at
last taken up and safely landed on board. Ere the squall came close to, the
other boats had cut loose from their fish and returned to the ship in good
time. The ship had given us up, but was still cruising, if haply it might light
upon some token of our perishing,—an oar or a lance pole.
CHAPTER
49. The Hyena.
There
are certain queer times and occasions in this strange mixed affair we call life
when a man takes this whole universe for a vast practical joke, though the wit
thereof he but dimly discerns, and more than suspects that the joke is at
nobody's expense but his own. However, nothing dispirits, and nothing seems
worth while disputing. He bolts down all events, all creeds, and beliefs, and
persuasions, all hard things visible and invisible, never mind how knobby; as
an ostrich of potent digestion gobbles down bullets and gun flints. And as for
small difficulties and worryings, prospects of sudden disaster, peril of life
and limb; all these, and death itself, seem to him only sly, good-natured hits,
and jolly punches in the side bestowed by the unseen and unaccountable old
joker. That odd sort of wayward mood I am speaking of, comes over a man only in
some time of extreme tribulation; it comes in the very midst of his
earnestness, so that what just before might have seemed to him a thing most
momentous, now seems but a part of the general joke. There is nothing like the
perils of whaling to breed this free and easy sort of genial, desperado
philosophy; and with it I now regarded this whole voyage of the Pequod, and the
great White Whale its object.
“Queequeg,”
said I, when they had dragged me, the last man, to the deck, and I was still
shaking myself in my jacket to fling off the water; “Queequeg, my fine friend,
does this sort of thing often happen?” Without much emotion, though soaked
through just like me, he gave me to understand that such things did often
happen.
“Mr.
Stubb,” said I, turning to that worthy, who, buttoned up in his oil-jacket, was
now calmly smoking his pipe in the rain; “Mr. Stubb, I think I have heard you
say that of all whalemen you ever met, our chief mate, Mr. Starbuck, is by far
the most careful and prudent. I suppose then, that going plump on a flying
whale with your sail set in a foggy squall is the height of a whaleman's
discretion?”
“Certain.
I've lowered for whales from a leaking ship in a gale off Cape Horn.”
“Mr.
Flask,” said I, turning to little King-Post, who was standing close by; “you
are experienced in these things, and I am not. Will you tell me whether it is
an unalterable law in this fishery, Mr. Flask, for an oarsman to break his own
back pulling himself back-foremost into death's jaws?”
“Can't
you twist that smaller?” said Flask. “Yes, that's the law. I should like to see
a boat's crew backing water up to a whale face foremost. Ha, ha! the whale
would give them squint for squint, mind that!”
Here
then, from three impartial witnesses, I had a deliberate statement of the
entire case. Considering, therefore, that squalls and capsizings in the water
and consequent bivouacks on the deep, were matters of common occurrence in this
kind of life; considering that at the superlatively critical instant of going
on to the whale I must resign my life into the hands of him who steered the
boat—oftentimes a fellow who at that very moment is in his impetuousness upon
the point of scuttling the craft with his own frantic stampings; considering
that the particular disaster to our own particular boat was chiefly to be
imputed to Starbuck's driving on to his whale almost in the teeth of a squall,
and considering that Starbuck, notwithstanding, was famous for his great
heedfulness in the fishery; considering that I belonged to this uncommonly
prudent Starbuck's boat; and finally considering in what a devil's chase I was
implicated, touching the White Whale: taking all things together, I say, I
thought I might as well go below and make a rough draft of my will. “Queequeg,”
said I, “come along, you shall be my lawyer, executor, and legatee.”
It
may seem strange that of all men sailors should be tinkering at their last
wills and testaments, but there are no people in the world more fond of that
diversion. This was the fourth time in my nautical life that I had done the
same thing. After the ceremony was concluded upon the present occasion, I felt
all the easier; a stone was rolled away from my heart. Besides, all the days I
should now live would be as good as the days that Lazarus lived after his
resurrection; a supplementary clean gain of so many months or weeks as the case
might be. I survived myself; my death and burial were locked up in my chest. I
looked round me tranquilly and contentedly, like a quiet ghost with a clean
conscience sitting inside the bars of a snug family vault.
Now
then, thought I, unconsciously rolling up the sleeves of my frock, here goes
for a cool, collected dive at death and destruction, and the devil fetch the
hindmost.
CHAPTER
50. Ahab's Boat and Crew. Fedallah.
“Who
would have thought it, Flask!” cried Stubb; “if I had but one leg you would not
catch me in a boat, unless maybe to stop the plug-hole with my timber toe. Oh!
he's a wonderful old man!”
“I
don't think it so strange, after all, on that account,” said Flask. “If his leg
were off at the hip, now, it would be a different thing. That would disable
him; but he has one knee, and good part of the other left, you know.”
“I
don't know that, my little man; I never yet saw him kneel.”
Among
whale-wise people it has often been argued whether, considering the paramount
importance of his life to the success of the voyage, it is right for a whaling
captain to jeopardize that life in the active perils of the chase. So
Tamerlane's soldiers often argued with tears in their eyes, whether that
invaluable life of his ought to be carried into the thickest of the fight.
But
with Ahab the question assumed a modified aspect. Considering that with two
legs man is but a hobbling wight in all times of danger; considering that the
pursuit of whales is always under great and extraordinary difficulties; that
every individual moment, indeed, then comprises a peril; under these
circumstances is it wise for any maimed man to enter a whale-boat in the hunt?
As a general thing, the joint-owners of the Pequod must have plainly thought
not.
Ahab
well knew that although his friends at home would think little of his entering
a boat in certain comparatively harmless vicissitudes of the chase, for the
sake of being near the scene of action and giving his orders in person, yet for
Captain Ahab to have a boat actually apportioned to him as a regular headsman
in the hunt—above all for Captain Ahab to be supplied with five extra men, as
that same boat's crew, he well knew that such generous conceits never entered
the heads of the owners of the Pequod. Therefore he had not solicited a boat's
crew from them, nor had he in any way hinted his desires on that head.
Nevertheless he had taken private measures of his own touching all that matter.
Until Cabaco's published discovery, the sailors had little foreseen it, though
to be sure when, after being a little while out of port, all hands had
concluded the customary business of fitting the whaleboats for service; when
some time after this Ahab was now and then found bestirring himself in the
matter of making thole-pins with his own hands for what was thought to be one
of the spare boats, and even solicitously cutting the small wooden skewers,
which when the line is running out are pinned over the groove in the bow: when
all this was observed in him, and particularly his solicitude in having an
extra coat of sheathing in the bottom of the boat, as if to make it better
withstand the pointed pressure of his ivory limb; and also the anxiety he
evinced in exactly shaping the thigh board, or clumsy cleat, as it is sometimes
called, the horizontal piece in the boat's bow for bracing the knee against in
darting or stabbing at the whale; when it was observed how often he stood up in
that boat with his solitary knee fixed in the semi-circular depression in the
cleat, and with the carpenter's chisel gouged out a little here and
straightened it a little there; all these things, I say, had awakened much interest
and curiosity at the time. But almost everybody supposed that this particular
preparative heedfulness in Ahab must only be with a view to the ultimate chase
of Moby Dick; for he had already revealed his intention to hunt that mortal
monster in person. But such a supposition did by no means involve the remotest
suspicion as to any boat's crew being assigned to that boat.
Now,
with the subordinate phantoms, what wonder remained soon waned away; for in a
whaler wonders soon wane. Besides, now and then such unaccountable odds and
ends of strange nations come up from the unknown nooks and ash-holes of the
earth to man these floating outlaws of whalers; and the ships themselves often
pick up such queer castaway creatures found tossing about the open sea on
planks, bits of wreck, oars, whaleboats, canoes, blown-off Japanese junks, and
what not; that Beelzebub himself might climb up the side and step down into the
cabin to chat with the captain, and it would not create any unsubduable
excitement in the forecastle.
But
be all this as it may, certain it is that while the subordinate phantoms soon
found their place among the crew, though still as it were somehow distinct from
them, yet that hair-turbaned Fedallah remained a muffled mystery to the last.
Whence he came in a mannerly world like this, by what sort of unaccountable tie
he soon evinced himself to be linked with Ahab's peculiar fortunes; nay, so far
as to have some sort of a half-hinted influence; Heaven knows, but it might
have been even authority over him; all this none knew. But one cannot sustain
an indifferent air concerning Fedallah. He was such a creature as civilized,
domestic people in the temperate zone only see in their dreams, and that but
dimly; but the like of whom now and then glide among the unchanging Asiatic
communities, especially the Oriental isles to the east of the continent—those
insulated, immemorial, unalterable countries, which even in these modern days
still preserve much of the ghostly aboriginalness of earth's primal generations,
when the memory of the first man was a distinct recollection, and all men his
descendants, unknowing whence he came, eyed each other as real phantoms, and
asked of the sun and the moon why they were created and to what end; when
though, according to Genesis, the angels indeed consorted with the daughters of
men, the devils also, add the uncanonical Rabbins, indulged in mundane amours.
CHAPTER
51. The Spirit-Spout.
Days,
weeks passed, and under easy sail, the ivory Pequod had slowly swept across
four several cruising-grounds; that off the Azores; off the Cape de Verdes; on
the Plate (so called), being off the mouth of the Rio de la Plata; and the
Carrol Ground, an unstaked, watery locality, southerly from St. Helena.
It
was while gliding through these latter waters that one serene and moonlight
night, when all the waves rolled by like scrolls of silver; and, by their soft,
suffusing seethings, made what seemed a silvery silence, not a solitude; on
such a silent night a silvery jet was seen far in advance of the white bubbles
at the bow. Lit up by the moon, it looked celestial; seemed some plumed and
glittering god uprising from the sea. Fedallah first descried this jet. For of
these moonlight nights, it was his wont to mount to the main-mast head, and
stand a look-out there, with the same precision as if it had been day. And yet,
though herds of whales were seen by night, not one whaleman in a hundred would
venture a lowering for them. You may think with what emotions, then, the seamen
beheld this old Oriental perched aloft at such unusual hours; his turban and
the moon, companions in one sky. But when, after spending his uniform interval
there for several successive nights without uttering a single sound; when,
after all this silence, his unearthly voice was heard announcing that silvery,
moon-lit jet, every reclining mariner started to his feet as if some winged
spirit had lighted in the rigging, and hailed the mortal crew. “There she
blows!” Had the trump of judgment blown, they could not have quivered more; yet
still they felt no terror; rather pleasure. For though it was a most unwonted
hour, yet so impressive was the cry, and so deliriously exciting, that almost
every soul on board instinctively desired a lowering.
Walking
the deck with quick, side-lunging strides, Ahab commanded the t'gallant sails
and royals to be set, and every stunsail spread. The best man in the ship must
take the helm. Then, with every mast-head manned, the piled-up craft rolled
down before the wind. The strange, upheaving, lifting tendency of the taffrail
breeze filling the hollows of so many sails, made the buoyant, hovering deck to
feel like air beneath the feet; while still she rushed along, as if two
antagonistic influences were struggling in her—one to mount direct to heaven,
the other to drive yawingly to some horizontal goal. And had you watched Ahab's
face that night, you would have thought that in him also two different things
were warring. While his one live leg made lively echoes along the deck, every
stroke of his dead limb sounded like a coffin-tap. On life and death this old
man walked. But though the ship so swiftly sped, and though from every eye,
like arrows, the eager glances shot, yet the silvery jet was no more seen that
night. Every sailor swore he saw it once, but not a second time.
This
midnight-spout had almost grown a forgotten thing, when, some days after, lo!
at the same silent hour, it was again announced: again it was descried by all;
but upon making sail to overtake it, once more it disappeared as if it had
never been. And so it served us night after night, till no one heeded it but to
wonder at it. Mysteriously jetted into the clear moonlight, or starlight, as
the case might be; disappearing again for one whole day, or two days, or three;
and somehow seeming at every distinct repetition to be advancing still further
and further in our van, this solitary jet seemed for ever alluring us on.
Nor
with the immemorial superstition of their race, and in accordance with the
preternaturalness, as it seemed, which in many things invested the Pequod, were
there wanting some of the seamen who swore that whenever and wherever descried;
at however remote times, or in however far apart latitudes and longitudes, that
unnearable spout was cast by one self-same whale; and that whale, Moby Dick.
For a time, there reigned, too, a sense of peculiar dread at this flitting
apparition, as if it were treacherously beckoning us on and on, in order that
the monster might turn round upon us, and rend us at last in the remotest and
most savage seas.
These
temporary apprehensions, so vague but so awful, derived a wondrous potency from
the contrasting serenity of the weather, in which, beneath all its blue
blandness, some thought there lurked a devilish charm, as for days and days we
voyaged along, through seas so wearily, lonesomely mild, that all space, in
repugnance to our vengeful errand, seemed vacating itself of life before our
urn-like prow.
But,
at last, when turning to the eastward, the Cape winds began howling around us,
and we rose and fell upon the long, troubled seas that are there; when the
ivory-tusked Pequod sharply bowed to the blast, and gored the dark waves in her
madness, till, like showers of silver chips, the foam-flakes flew over her
bulwarks; then all this desolate vacuity of life went away, but gave place to
sights more dismal than before.
Close
to our bows, strange forms in the water darted hither and thither before us;
while thick in our rear flew the inscrutable sea-ravens. And every morning,
perched on our stays, rows of these birds were seen; and spite of our hootings,
for a long time obstinately clung to the hemp, as though they deemed our ship
some drifting, uninhabited craft; a thing appointed to desolation, and
therefore fit roosting-place for their homeless selves. And heaved and heaved,
still unrestingly heaved the black sea, as if its vast tides were a conscience;
and the great mundane soul were in anguish and remorse for the long sin and
suffering it had bred.
Cape
of Good Hope, do they call ye? Rather Cape Tormentoso, as called of yore; for
long allured by the perfidious silences that before had attended us, we found
ourselves launched into this tormented sea, where guilty beings transformed
into those fowls and these fish, seemed condemned to swim on everlastingly
without any haven in store, or beat that black air without any horizon. But
calm, snow-white, and unvarying; still directing its fountain of feathers to
the sky; still beckoning us on from before, the solitary jet would at times be
descried.
During
all this blackness of the elements, Ahab, though assuming for the time the
almost continual command of the drenched and dangerous deck, manifested the
gloomiest reserve; and more seldom than ever addressed his mates. In
tempestuous times like these, after everything above and aloft has been
secured, nothing more can be done but passively to await the issue of the gale.
Then Captain and crew become practical fatalists. So, with his ivory leg
inserted into its accustomed hole, and with one hand firmly grasping a shroud,
Ahab for hours and hours would stand gazing dead to windward, while an
occasional squall of sleet or snow would all but congeal his very eyelashes
together. Meantime, the crew driven from the forward part of the ship by the
perilous seas that burstingly broke over its bows, stood in a line along the
bulwarks in the waist; and the better to guard against the leaping waves, each
man had slipped himself into a sort of bowline secured to the rail, in which he
swung as in a loosened belt. Few or no words were spoken; and the silent ship,
as if manned by painted sailors in wax, day after day tore on through all the
swift madness and gladness of the demoniac waves. By night the same muteness of
humanity before the shrieks of the ocean prevailed; still in silence the men
swung in the bowlines; still wordless Ahab stood up to the blast. Even when
wearied nature seemed demanding repose he would not seek that repose in his
hammock. Never could Starbuck forget the old man's aspect, when one night going
down into the cabin to mark how the barometer stood, he saw him with closed
eyes sitting straight in his floor-screwed chair; the rain and half-melted
sleet of the storm from which he had some time before emerged, still slowly
dripping from the unremoved hat and coat. On the table beside him lay unrolled
one of those charts of tides and currents which have previously been spoken of.
His lantern swung from his tightly clenched hand. Though the body was erect,
the head was thrown back so that the closed eyes were pointed towards the
needle of the tell-tale that swung from a beam in the ceiling.*
*The
cabin-compass is called the tell-tale, because without going to the compass at
the helm, the Captain, while below, can inform himself of the course of the
ship.
Terrible
old man! thought Starbuck with a shudder, sleeping in this gale, still thou
steadfastly eyest thy purpose.
CHAPTER
52. The Albatross.
South-eastward
from the Cape, off the distant Crozetts, a good cruising ground for Right
Whalemen, a sail loomed ahead, the Goney (Albatross) by name. As she slowly
drew nigh, from my lofty perch at the fore-mast-head, I had a good view of that
sight so remarkable to a tyro in the far ocean fisheries—a whaler at sea, and
long absent from home.
As
if the waves had been fullers, this craft was bleached like the skeleton of a
stranded walrus. All down her sides, this spectral appearance was traced with
long channels of reddened rust, while all her spars and her rigging were like
the thick branches of trees furred over with hoar-frost. Only her lower sails
were set. A wild sight it was to see her long-bearded look-outs at those three
mast-heads. They seemed clad in the skins of beasts, so torn and bepatched the
raiment that had survived nearly four years of cruising. Standing in iron hoops
nailed to the mast, they swayed and swung over a fathomless sea; and though,
when the ship slowly glided close under our stern, we six men in the air came
so nigh to each other that we might almost have leaped from the mast-heads of
one ship to those of the other; yet, those forlorn-looking fishermen, mildly
eyeing us as they passed, said not one word to our own look-outs, while the
quarter-deck hail was being heard from below.
“Ship
ahoy! Have ye seen the White Whale?”
But
as the strange captain, leaning over the pallid bulwarks, was in the act of
putting his trumpet to his mouth, it somehow fell from his hand into the sea;
and the wind now rising amain, he in vain strove to make himself heard without
it. Meantime his ship was still increasing the distance between. While in
various silent ways the seamen of the Pequod were evincing their observance of
this ominous incident at the first mere mention of the White Whale's name to
another ship, Ahab for a moment paused; it almost seemed as though he would
have lowered a boat to board the stranger, had not the threatening wind
forbade. But taking advantage of his windward position, he again seized his
trumpet, and knowing by her aspect that the stranger vessel was a Nantucketer
and shortly bound home, he loudly hailed—“Ahoy there! This is the Pequod, bound
round the world! Tell them to address all future letters to the Pacific ocean!
and this time three years, if I am not at home, tell them to address them to
——”
At
that moment the two wakes were fairly crossed, and instantly, then, in
accordance with their singular ways, shoals of small harmless fish, that for
some days before had been placidly swimming by our side, darted away with what
seemed shuddering fins, and ranged themselves fore and aft with the stranger's
flanks. Though in the course of his continual voyagings Ahab must often before
have noticed a similar sight, yet, to any monomaniac man, the veriest trifles
capriciously carry meanings.
“Swim
away from me, do ye?” murmured Ahab, gazing over into the water. There seemed
but little in the words, but the tone conveyed more of deep helpless sadness
than the insane old man had ever before evinced. But turning to the steersman,
who thus far had been holding the ship in the wind to diminish her headway, he
cried out in his old lion voice,—“Up helm! Keep her off round the world!”
Round
the world! There is much in that sound to inspire proud feelings; but whereto
does all that circumnavigation conduct? Only through numberless perils to the
very point whence we started, where those that we left behind secure, were all
the time before us.
Were
this world an endless plain, and by sailing eastward we could for ever reach
new distances, and discover sights more sweet and strange than any Cyclades or
Islands of King Solomon, then there were promise in the voyage. But in pursuit
of those far mysteries we dream of, or in tormented chase of that demon phantom
that, some time or other, swims before all human hearts; while chasing such
over this round globe, they either lead us on in barren mazes or midway leave
us whelmed.
CHAPTER
53. The Gam.
The
ostensible reason why Ahab did not go on board of the whaler we had spoken was
this: the wind and sea betokened storms. But even had this not been the case,
he would not after all, perhaps, have boarded her—judging by his subsequent
conduct on similar occasions—if so it had been that, by the process of hailing,
he had obtained a negative answer to the question he put. For, as it eventually
turned out, he cared not to consort, even for five minutes, with any stranger
captain, except he could contribute some of that information he so absorbingly
sought. But all this might remain inadequately estimated, were not something
said here of the peculiar usages of whaling-vessels when meeting each other in
foreign seas, and especially on a common cruising-ground.
If
two strangers crossing the Pine Barrens in New York State, or the equally
desolate Salisbury Plain in England; if casually encountering each other in
such inhospitable wilds, these twain, for the life of them, cannot well avoid a
mutual salutation; and stopping for a moment to interchange the news; and,
perhaps, sitting down for a while and resting in concert: then, how much more
natural that upon the illimitable Pine Barrens and Salisbury Plains of the sea,
two whaling vessels descrying each other at the ends of the earth—off lone
Fanning's Island, or the far away King's Mills; how much more natural, I say,
that under such circumstances these ships should not only interchange hails,
but come into still closer, more friendly and sociable contact. And especially
would this seem to be a matter of course, in the case of vessels owned in one
seaport, and whose captains, officers, and not a few of the men are personally
known to each other; and consequently, have all sorts of dear domestic things
to talk about.
For
the long absent ship, the outward-bounder, perhaps, has letters on board; at
any rate, she will be sure to let her have some papers of a date a year or two
later than the last one on her blurred and thumb-worn files. And in return for
that courtesy, the outward-bound ship would receive the latest whaling
intelligence from the cruising-ground to which she may be destined, a thing of
the utmost importance to her. And in degree, all this will hold true concerning
whaling vessels crossing each other's track on the cruising-ground itself, even
though they are equally long absent from home. For one of them may have
received a transfer of letters from some third, and now far remote vessel; and
some of those letters may be for the people of the ship she now meets. Besides,
they would exchange the whaling news, and have an agreeable chat. For not only
would they meet with all the sympathies of sailors, but likewise with all the
peculiar congenialities arising from a common pursuit and mutually shared
privations and perils.
Nor
would difference of country make any very essential difference; that is, so
long as both parties speak one language, as is the case with Americans and
English. Though, to be sure, from the small number of English whalers, such
meetings do not very often occur, and when they do occur there is too apt to be
a sort of shyness between them; for your Englishman is rather reserved, and
your Yankee, he does not fancy that sort of thing in anybody but himself.
Besides, the English whalers sometimes affect a kind of metropolitan
superiority over the American whalers; regarding the long, lean Nantucketer,
with his nondescript provincialisms, as a sort of sea-peasant. But where this
superiority in the English whalemen does really consist, it would be hard to
say, seeing that the Yankees in one day, collectively, kill more whales than
all the English, collectively, in ten years. But this is a harmless little
foible in the English whale-hunters, which the Nantucketer does not take much
to heart; probably, because he knows that he has a few foibles himself.
So,
then, we see that of all ships separately sailing the sea, the whalers have
most reason to be sociable—and they are so. Whereas, some merchant ships
crossing each other's wake in the mid-Atlantic, will oftentimes pass on without
so much as a single word of recognition, mutually cutting each other on the
high seas, like a brace of dandies in Broadway; and all the time indulging,
perhaps, in finical criticism upon each other's rig. As for Men-of-War, when
they chance to meet at sea, they first go through such a string of silly
bowings and scrapings, such a ducking of ensigns, that there does not seem to
be much right-down hearty good-will and brotherly love about it at all. As
touching Slave-ships meeting, why, they are in such a prodigious hurry, they
run away from each other as soon as possible. And as for Pirates, when they
chance to cross each other's cross-bones, the first hail is—“How many
skulls?”—the same way that whalers hail—“How many barrels?” And that question
once answered, pirates straightway steer apart, for they are infernal villains
on both sides, and don't like to see overmuch of each other's villanous
likenesses.
But
look at the godly, honest, unostentatious, hospitable, sociable, free-and-easy
whaler! What does the whaler do when she meets another whaler in any sort of
decent weather? She has a “Gam,” a thing so utterly unknown to all other ships
that they never heard of the name even; and if by chance they should hear of
it, they only grin at it, and repeat gamesome stuff about “spouters” and
“blubber-boilers,” and such like pretty exclamations. Why it is that all
Merchant-seamen, and also all Pirates and Man-of-War's men, and Slave-ship
sailors, cherish such a scornful feeling towards Whale-ships; this is a
question it would be hard to answer. Because, in the case of pirates, say, I
should like to know whether that profession of theirs has any peculiar glory
about it. It sometimes ends in uncommon elevation, indeed; but only at the
gallows. And besides, when a man is elevated in that odd fashion, he has no
proper foundation for his superior altitude. Hence, I conclude, that in
boasting himself to be high lifted above a whaleman, in that assertion the
pirate has no solid basis to stand on.
But
what is a Gam? You might wear out your index-finger running up and down the
columns of dictionaries, and never find the word. Dr. Johnson never attained to
that erudition; Noah Webster's ark does not hold it. Nevertheless, this same
expressive word has now for many years been in constant use among some fifteen
thousand true born Yankees. Certainly, it needs a definition, and should be
incorporated into the Lexicon. With that view, let me learnedly define it.
GAM.
NOUN—A social meeting of two (or more) Whaleships, generally on a
cruising-ground; when, after exchanging hails, they exchange visits by boats'
crews: the two captains remaining, for the time, on board of one ship, and the
two chief mates on the other.
There
is another little item about Gamming which must not be forgotten here. All
professions have their own little peculiarities of detail; so has the whale
fishery. In a pirate, man-of-war, or slave ship, when the captain is rowed
anywhere in his boat, he always sits in the stern sheets on a comfortable,
sometimes cushioned seat there, and often steers himself with a pretty little
milliner's tiller decorated with gay cords and ribbons. But the whale-boat has
no seat astern, no sofa of that sort whatever, and no tiller at all. High times
indeed, if whaling captains were wheeled about the water on castors like gouty
old aldermen in patent chairs. And as for a tiller, the whale-boat never admits
of any such effeminacy; and therefore as in gamming a complete boat's crew must
leave the ship, and hence as the boat steerer or harpooneer is of the number,
that subordinate is the steersman upon the occasion, and the captain, having no
place to sit in, is pulled off to his visit all standing like a pine tree. And
often you will notice that being conscious of the eyes of the whole visible
world resting on him from the sides of the two ships, this standing captain is
all alive to the importance of sustaining his dignity by maintaining his legs.
Nor is this any very easy matter; for in his rear is the immense projecting
steering oar hitting him now and then in the small of his back, the after-oar
reciprocating by rapping his knees in front. He is thus completely wedged
before and behind, and can only expand himself sideways by settling down on his
stretched legs; but a sudden, violent pitch of the boat will often go far to
topple him, because length of foundation is nothing without corresponding
breadth. Merely make a spread angle of two poles, and you cannot stand them up.
Then, again, it would never do in plain sight of the world's riveted eyes, it
would never do, I say, for this straddling captain to be seen steadying himself
the slightest particle by catching hold of anything with his hands; indeed, as
token of his entire, buoyant self-command, he generally carries his hands in
his trowsers' pockets; but perhaps being generally very large, heavy hands, he
carries them there for ballast. Nevertheless there have occurred instances,
well authenticated ones too, where the captain has been known for an uncommonly
critical moment or two, in a sudden squall say—to seize hold of the nearest
oarsman's hair, and hold on there like grim death.
CHAPTER
54. The Town-Ho's Story.
(As
told at the Golden Inn.)
The
Cape of Good Hope, and all the watery region round about there, is much like
some noted four corners of a great highway, where you meet more travellers than
in any other part.
It
was not very long after speaking the Goney that another homeward-bound
whaleman, the Town-Ho,* was encountered. She was manned almost wholly by
Polynesians. In the short gam that ensued she gave us strong news of Moby Dick.
To some the general interest in the White Whale was now wildly heightened by a
circumstance of the Town-Ho's story, which seemed obscurely to involve with the
whale a certain wondrous, inverted visitation of one of those so called
judgments of God which at times are said to overtake some men. This latter
circumstance, with its own particular accompaniments, forming what may be
called the secret part of the tragedy about to be narrated, never reached the
ears of Captain Ahab or his mates. For that secret part of the story was
unknown to the captain of the Town-Ho himself. It was the private property of
three confederate white seamen of that ship, one of whom, it seems,
communicated it to Tashtego with Romish injunctions of secrecy, but the
following night Tashtego rambled in his sleep, and revealed so much of it in
that way, that when he was wakened he could not well withhold the rest.
Nevertheless, so potent an influence did this thing have on those seamen in the
Pequod who came to the full knowledge of it, and by such a strange delicacy, to
call it so, were they governed in this matter, that they kept the secret among
themselves so that it never transpired abaft the Pequod's main-mast.
Interweaving in its proper place this darker thread with the story as publicly
narrated on the ship, the whole of this strange affair I now proceed to put on
lasting record.
*The
ancient whale-cry upon first sighting a whale from the mast-head, still used by
whalemen in hunting the famous Gallipagos terrapin.
For
my humor's sake, I shall preserve the style in which I once narrated it at
Lima, to a lounging circle of my Spanish friends, one saint's eve, smoking upon
the thick-gilt tiled piazza of the Golden Inn. Of those fine cavaliers, the
young Dons, Pedro and Sebastian, were on the closer terms with me; and hence
the interluding questions they occasionally put, and which are duly answered at
the time.
“Some
two years prior to my first learning the events which I am about rehearsing to
you, gentlemen, the Town-Ho, Sperm Whaler of Nantucket, was cruising in your
Pacific here, not very many days' sail eastward from the eaves of this good
Golden Inn. She was somewhere to the northward of the Line. One morning upon
handling the pumps, according to daily usage, it was observed that she made
more water in her hold than common. They supposed a sword-fish had stabbed her,
gentlemen. But the captain, having some unusual reason for believing that rare
good luck awaited him in those latitudes; and therefore being very averse to
quit them, and the leak not being then considered at all dangerous, though,
indeed, they could not find it after searching the hold as low down as was
possible in rather heavy weather, the ship still continued her cruisings, the
mariners working at the pumps at wide and easy intervals; but no good luck
came; more days went by, and not only was the leak yet undiscovered, but it
sensibly increased. So much so, that now taking some alarm, the captain, making
all sail, stood away for the nearest harbor among the islands, there to have
his hull hove out and repaired.
“Though
no small passage was before her, yet, if the commonest chance favoured, he did
not at all fear that his ship would founder by the way, because his pumps were
of the best, and being periodically relieved at them, those six-and-thirty men
of his could easily keep the ship free; never mind if the leak should double on
her. In truth, well nigh the whole of this passage being attended by very
prosperous breezes, the Town-Ho had all but certainly arrived in perfect safety
at her port without the occurrence of the least fatality, had it not been for
the brutal overbearing of Radney, the mate, a Vineyarder, and the bitterly
provoked vengeance of Steelkilt, a Lakeman and desperado from Buffalo.
“'Lakeman!—Buffalo!
Pray, what is a Lakeman, and where is Buffalo?' said Don Sebastian, rising in
his swinging mat of grass.
“On
the eastern shore of our Lake Erie, Don; but—I crave your courtesy—may be, you
shall soon hear further of all that. Now, gentlemen, in square-sail brigs and
three-masted ships, well-nigh as large and stout as any that ever sailed out of
your old Callao to far Manilla; this Lakeman, in the land-locked heart of our
America, had yet been nurtured by all those agrarian freebooting impressions
popularly connected with the open ocean. For in their interflowing aggregate,
those grand fresh-water seas of ours,—Erie, and Ontario, and Huron, and
Superior, and Michigan,—possess an ocean-like expansiveness, with many of the
ocean's noblest traits; with many of its rimmed varieties of races and of
climes. They contain round archipelagoes of romantic isles, even as the
Polynesian waters do; in large part, are shored by two great contrasting
nations, as the Atlantic is; they furnish long maritime approaches to our
numerous territorial colonies from the East, dotted all round their banks; here
and there are frowned upon by batteries, and by the goat-like craggy guns of
lofty Mackinaw; they have heard the fleet thunderings of naval victories; at
intervals, they yield their beaches to wild barbarians, whose red painted faces
flash from out their peltry wigwams; for leagues and leagues are flanked by
ancient and unentered forests, where the gaunt pines stand like serried lines
of kings in Gothic genealogies; those same woods harboring wild Afric beasts of
prey, and silken creatures whose exported furs give robes to Tartar Emperors;
they mirror the paved capitals of Buffalo and Cleveland, as well as Winnebago
villages; they float alike the full-rigged merchant ship, the armed cruiser of
the State, the steamer, and the beech canoe; they are swept by Borean and
dismasting blasts as direful as any that lash the salted wave; they know what
shipwrecks are, for out of sight of land, however inland, they have drowned
full many a midnight ship with all its shrieking crew. Thus, gentlemen, though
an inlander, Steelkilt was wild-ocean born, and wild-ocean nurtured; as much of
an audacious mariner as any. And for Radney, though in his infancy he may have
laid him down on the lone Nantucket beach, to nurse at his maternal sea; though
in after life he had long followed our austere Atlantic and your contemplative
Pacific; yet was he quite as vengeful and full of social quarrel as the
backwoods seaman, fresh from the latitudes of buck-horn handled Bowie-knives.
Yet was this Nantucketer a man with some good-hearted traits; and this Lakeman,
a mariner, who though a sort of devil indeed, might yet by inflexible firmness,
only tempered by that common decency of human recognition which is the meanest
slave's right; thus treated, this Steelkilt had long been retained harmless and
docile. At all events, he had proved so thus far; but Radney was doomed and
made mad, and Steelkilt—but, gentlemen, you shall hear.
“It
was not more than a day or two at the furthest after pointing her prow for her
island haven, that the Town-Ho's leak seemed again increasing, but only so as
to require an hour or more at the pumps every day. You must know that in a
settled and civilized ocean like our Atlantic, for example, some skippers think
little of pumping their whole way across it; though of a still, sleepy night,
should the officer of the deck happen to forget his duty in that respect, the
probability would be that he and his shipmates would never again remember it,
on account of all hands gently subsiding to the bottom. Nor in the solitary and
savage seas far from you to the westward, gentlemen, is it altogether unusual
for ships to keep clanging at their pump-handles in full chorus even for a
voyage of considerable length; that is, if it lie along a tolerably accessible
coast, or if any other reasonable retreat is afforded them. It is only when a
leaky vessel is in some very out of the way part of those waters, some really
landless latitude, that her captain begins to feel a little anxious.
“Much
this way had it been with the Town-Ho; so when her leak was found gaining once
more, there was in truth some small concern manifested by several of her
company; especially by Radney the mate. He commanded the upper sails to be well
hoisted, sheeted home anew, and every way expanded to the breeze. Now this
Radney, I suppose, was as little of a coward, and as little inclined to any
sort of nervous apprehensiveness touching his own person as any fearless,
unthinking creature on land or on sea that you can conveniently imagine,
gentlemen. Therefore when he betrayed this solicitude about the safety of the
ship, some of the seamen declared that it was only on account of his being a
part owner in her. So when they were working that evening at the pumps, there
was on this head no small gamesomeness slily going on among them, as they stood
with their feet continually overflowed by the rippling clear water; clear as
any mountain spring, gentlemen—that bubbling from the pumps ran across the
deck, and poured itself out in steady spouts at the lee scupper-holes.
“Now,
as you well know, it is not seldom the case in this conventional world of
ours—watery or otherwise; that when a person placed in command over his
fellow-men finds one of them to be very significantly his superior in general
pride of manhood, straightway against that man he conceives an unconquerable
dislike and bitterness; and if he have a chance he will pull down and pulverize
that subaltern's tower, and make a little heap of dust of it. Be this conceit
of mine as it may, gentlemen, at all events Steelkilt was a tall and noble animal
with a head like a Roman, and a flowing golden beard like the tasseled housings
of your last viceroy's snorting charger; and a brain, and a heart, and a soul
in him, gentlemen, which had made Steelkilt Charlemagne, had he been born son
to Charlemagne's father. But Radney, the mate, was ugly as a mule; yet as
hardy, as stubborn, as malicious. He did not love Steelkilt, and Steelkilt knew
it.
“Espying
the mate drawing near as he was toiling at the pump with the rest, the Lakeman
affected not to notice him, but unawed, went on with his gay banterings.
“'Aye,
aye, my merry lads, it's a lively leak this; hold a cannikin, one of ye, and
let's have a taste. By the Lord, it's worth bottling! I tell ye what, men, old
Rad's investment must go for it! he had best cut away his part of the hull and
tow it home. The fact is, boys, that sword-fish only began the job; he's come
back again with a gang of ship-carpenters, saw-fish, and file-fish, and what
not; and the whole posse of 'em are now hard at work cutting and slashing at
the bottom; making improvements, I suppose. If old Rad were here now, I'd tell
him to jump overboard and scatter 'em. They're playing the devil with his
estate, I can tell him. But he's a simple old soul,—Rad, and a beauty too.
Boys, they say the rest of his property is invested in looking-glasses. I
wonder if he'd give a poor devil like me the model of his nose.'
“'Damn
your eyes! what's that pump stopping for?' roared Radney, pretending not to
have heard the sailors' talk. 'Thunder away at it!'
“'Aye,
aye, sir,' said Steelkilt, merry as a cricket. 'Lively, boys, lively, now!' And
with that the pump clanged like fifty fire-engines; the men tossed their hats
off to it, and ere long that peculiar gasping of the lungs was heard which
denotes the fullest tension of life's utmost energies.
“Quitting
the pump at last, with the rest of his band, the Lakeman went forward all
panting, and sat himself down on the windlass; his face fiery red, his eyes
bloodshot, and wiping the profuse sweat from his brow. Now what cozening fiend
it was, gentlemen, that possessed Radney to meddle with such a man in that
corporeally exasperated state, I know not; but so it happened. Intolerably
striding along the deck, the mate commanded him to get a broom and sweep down
the planks, and also a shovel, and remove some offensive matters consequent
upon allowing a pig to run at large.
“Now,
gentlemen, sweeping a ship's deck at sea is a piece of household work which in
all times but raging gales is regularly attended to every evening; it has been
known to be done in the case of ships actually foundering at the time. Such,
gentlemen, is the inflexibility of sea-usages and the instinctive love of
neatness in seamen; some of whom would not willingly drown without first washing
their faces. But in all vessels this broom business is the prescriptive
province of the boys, if boys there be aboard. Besides, it was the stronger men
in the Town-Ho that had been divided into gangs, taking turns at the pumps; and
being the most athletic seaman of them all, Steelkilt had been regularly
assigned captain of one of the gangs; consequently he should have been freed
from any trivial business not connected with truly nautical duties, such being
the case with his comrades. I mention all these particulars so that you may
understand exactly how this affair stood between the two men.
“But
there was more than this: the order about the shovel was almost as plainly
meant to sting and insult Steelkilt, as though Radney had spat in his face. Any
man who has gone sailor in a whale-ship will understand this; and all this and
doubtless much more, the Lakeman fully comprehended when the mate uttered his
command. But as he sat still for a moment, and as he steadfastly looked into
the mate's malignant eye and perceived the stacks of powder-casks heaped up in
him and the slow-match silently burning along towards them; as he instinctively
saw all this, that strange forbearance and unwillingness to stir up the deeper
passionateness in any already ireful being—a repugnance most felt, when felt at
all, by really valiant men even when aggrieved—this nameless phantom feeling,
gentlemen, stole over Steelkilt.
“Therefore,
in his ordinary tone, only a little broken by the bodily exhaustion he was
temporarily in, he answered him saying that sweeping the deck was not his
business, and he would not do it. And then, without at all alluding to the
shovel, he pointed to three lads as the customary sweepers; who, not being
billeted at the pumps, had done little or nothing all day. To this, Radney
replied with an oath, in a most domineering and outrageous manner
unconditionally reiterating his command; meanwhile advancing upon the still
seated Lakeman, with an uplifted cooper's club hammer which he had snatched
from a cask near by.
“Heated
and irritated as he was by his spasmodic toil at the pumps, for all his first
nameless feeling of forbearance the sweating Steelkilt could but ill brook this
bearing in the mate; but somehow still smothering the conflagration within him,
without speaking he remained doggedly rooted to his seat, till at last the
incensed Radney shook the hammer within a few inches of his face, furiously
commanding him to do his bidding.
“Steelkilt
rose, and slowly retreating round the windlass, steadily followed by the mate
with his menacing hammer, deliberately repeated his intention not to obey.
Seeing, however, that his forbearance had not the slightest effect, by an awful
and unspeakable intimation with his twisted hand he warned off the foolish and
infatuated man; but it was to no purpose. And in this way the two went once
slowly round the windlass; when, resolved at last no longer to retreat,
bethinking him that he had now forborne as much as comported with his humor,
the Lakeman paused on the hatches and thus spoke to the officer:
“'Mr.
Radney, I will not obey you. Take that hammer away, or look to yourself.' But
the predestinated mate coming still closer to him, where the Lakeman stood
fixed, now shook the heavy hammer within an inch of his teeth; meanwhile
repeating a string of insufferable maledictions. Retreating not the thousandth
part of an inch; stabbing him in the eye with the unflinching poniard of his
glance, Steelkilt, clenching his right hand behind him and creepingly drawing
it back, told his persecutor that if the hammer but grazed his cheek he
(Steelkilt) would murder him. But, gentlemen, the fool had been branded for the
slaughter by the gods. Immediately the hammer touched the cheek; the next
instant the lower jaw of the mate was stove in his head; he fell on the hatch
spouting blood like a whale.
“Ere
the cry could go aft Steelkilt was shaking one of the backstays leading far
aloft to where two of his comrades were standing their mastheads. They were
both Canallers.
“'Canallers!'
cried Don Pedro. 'We have seen many whale-ships in our harbours, but never
heard of your Canallers. Pardon: who and what are they?'
“'Canallers,
Don, are the boatmen belonging to our grand Erie Canal. You must have heard of
it.'
“'Nay,
Senor; hereabouts in this dull, warm, most lazy, and hereditary land, we know
but little of your vigorous North.'
“'Aye?
Well then, Don, refill my cup. Your chicha's very fine; and ere proceeding
further I will tell ye what our Canallers are; for such information may throw
side-light upon my story.'
“For
three hundred and sixty miles, gentlemen, through the entire breadth of the
state of New York; through numerous populous cities and most thriving villages;
through long, dismal, uninhabited swamps, and affluent, cultivated fields,
unrivalled for fertility; by billiard-room and bar-room; through the
holy-of-holies of great forests; on Roman arches over Indian rivers; through
sun and shade; by happy hearts or broken; through all the wide contrasting
scenery of those noble Mohawk counties; and especially, by rows of snow-white
chapels, whose spires stand almost like milestones, flows one continual stream
of Venetianly corrupt and often lawless life. There's your true Ashantee,
gentlemen; there howl your pagans; where you ever find them, next door to you; under
the long-flung shadow, and the snug patronising lee of churches. For by some
curious fatality, as it is often noted of your metropolitan freebooters that
they ever encamp around the halls of justice, so sinners, gentlemen, most
abound in holiest vicinities.
“'Is
that a friar passing?' said Don Pedro, looking downwards into the crowded
plazza, with humorous concern.
“'Well
for our northern friend, Dame Isabella's Inquisition wanes in Lima,' laughed
Don Sebastian. 'Proceed, Senor.'
“'A
moment! Pardon!' cried another of the company. 'In the name of all us Limeese,
I but desire to express to you, sir sailor, that we have by no means overlooked
your delicacy in not substituting present Lima for distant Venice in your
corrupt comparison. Oh! do not bow and look surprised; you know the proverb all
along this coast—“Corrupt as Lima.” It but bears out your saying, too; churches
more plentiful than billiard-tables, and for ever open—and “Corrupt as Lima.”
So, too, Venice; I have been there; the holy city of the blessed evangelist,
St. Mark!—St. Dominic, purge it! Your cup! Thanks: here I refill; now, you pour
out again.'
“Freely
depicted in his own vocation, gentlemen, the Canaller would make a fine
dramatic hero, so abundantly and picturesquely wicked is he. Like Mark Antony,
for days and days along his green-turfed, flowery Nile, he indolently floats,
openly toying with his red-cheeked Cleopatra, ripening his apricot thigh upon
the sunny deck. But ashore, all this effeminacy is dashed. The brigandish guise
which the Canaller so proudly sports; his slouched and gaily-ribboned hat
betoken his grand features. A terror to the smiling innocence of the villages
through which he floats; his swart visage and bold swagger are not unshunned in
cities. Once a vagabond on his own canal, I have received good turns from one
of these Canallers; I thank him heartily; would fain be not ungrateful; but it
is often one of the prime redeeming qualities of your man of violence, that at
times he has as stiff an arm to back a poor stranger in a strait, as to plunder
a wealthy one. In sum, gentlemen, what the wildness of this canal life is, is
emphatically evinced by this; that our wild whale-fishery contains so many of
its most finished graduates, and that scarce any race of mankind, except Sydney
men, are so much distrusted by our whaling captains. Nor does it at all
diminish the curiousness of this matter, that to many thousands of our rural
boys and young men born along its line, the probationary life of the Grand
Canal furnishes the sole transition between quietly reaping in a Christian
corn-field, and recklessly ploughing the waters of the most barbaric seas.
“'I
see! I see!' impetuously exclaimed Don Pedro, spilling his chicha upon his
silvery ruffles. 'No need to travel! The world's one Lima. I had thought, now,
that at your temperate North the generations were cold and holy as the
hills.—But the story.'
“I
left off, gentlemen, where the Lakeman shook the backstay. Hardly had he done
so, when he was surrounded by the three junior mates and the four harpooneers,
who all crowded him to the deck. But sliding down the ropes like baleful
comets, the two Canallers rushed into the uproar, and sought to drag their man
out of it towards the forecastle. Others of the sailors joined with them in
this attempt, and a twisted turmoil ensued; while standing out of harm's way,
the valiant captain danced up and down with a whale-pike, calling upon his
officers to manhandle that atrocious scoundrel, and smoke him along to the
quarter-deck. At intervals, he ran close up to the revolving border of the
confusion, and prying into the heart of it with his pike, sought to prick out
the object of his resentment. But Steelkilt and his desperadoes were too much
for them all; they succeeded in gaining the forecastle deck, where, hastily
slewing about three or four large casks in a line with the windlass, these
sea-Parisians entrenched themselves behind the barricade.
“'Come
out of that, ye pirates!' roared the captain, now menacing them with a pistol
in each hand, just brought to him by the steward. 'Come out of that, ye
cut-throats!'
“Steelkilt
leaped on the barricade, and striding up and down there, defied the worst the
pistols could do; but gave the captain to understand distinctly, that his
(Steelkilt's) death would be the signal for a murderous mutiny on the part of
all hands. Fearing in his heart lest this might prove but too true, the captain
a little desisted, but still commanded the insurgents instantly to return to
their duty.
“'Will
you promise not to touch us, if we do?' demanded their ringleader.
“'Turn
to! turn to!—I make no promise;—to your duty! Do you want to sink the ship, by
knocking off at a time like this? Turn to!' and he once more raised a pistol.
“'Sink
the ship?' cried Steelkilt. 'Aye, let her sink. Not a man of us turns to,
unless you swear not to raise a rope-yarn against us. What say ye, men?'
turning to his comrades. A fierce cheer was their response.
“The
Lakeman now patrolled the barricade, all the while keeping his eye on the
Captain, and jerking out such sentences as these:—'It's not our fault; we didn't
want it; I told him to take his hammer away; it was boy's business; he might
have known me before this; I told him not to prick the buffalo; I believe I
have broken a finger here against his cursed jaw; ain't those mincing knives
down in the forecastle there, men? look to those handspikes, my hearties.
Captain, by God, look to yourself; say the word; don't be a fool; forget it
all; we are ready to turn to; treat us decently, and we're your men; but we
won't be flogged.'
“'Turn
to! I make no promises, turn to, I say!'
“'Look
ye, now,' cried the Lakeman, flinging out his arm towards him, 'there are a few
of us here (and I am one of them) who have shipped for the cruise, d'ye see;
now as you well know, sir, we can claim our discharge as soon as the anchor is
down; so we don't want a row; it's not our interest; we want to be peaceable;
we are ready to work, but we won't be flogged.'
“'Turn
to!' roared the Captain.
“Steelkilt
glanced round him a moment, and then said:—'I tell you what it is now, Captain,
rather than kill ye, and be hung for such a shabby rascal, we won't lift a hand
against ye unless ye attack us; but till you say the word about not flogging
us, we don't do a hand's turn.'
“'Down
into the forecastle then, down with ye, I'll keep ye there till ye're sick of
it. Down ye go.'
“'Shall
we?' cried the ringleader to his men. Most of them were against it; but at
length, in obedience to Steelkilt, they preceded him down into their dark den,
growlingly disappearing, like bears into a cave.
“As
the Lakeman's bare head was just level with the planks, the Captain and his
posse leaped the barricade, and rapidly drawing over the slide of the scuttle,
planted their group of hands upon it, and loudly called for the steward to
bring the heavy brass padlock belonging to the companionway. Then opening the
slide a little, the Captain whispered something down the crack, closed it, and
turned the key upon them—ten in number—leaving on deck some twenty or more, who
thus far had remained neutral.
“All
night a wide-awake watch was kept by all the officers, forward and aft,
especially about the forecastle scuttle and fore hatchway; at which last place
it was feared the insurgents might emerge, after breaking through the bulkhead
below. But the hours of darkness passed in peace; the men who still remained at
their duty toiling hard at the pumps, whose clinking and clanking at intervals
through the dreary night dismally resounded through the ship.
“At
sunrise the Captain went forward, and knocking on the deck, summoned the
prisoners to work; but with a yell they refused. Water was then lowered down to
them, and a couple of handfuls of biscuit were tossed after it; when again
turning the key upon them and pocketing it, the Captain returned to the
quarter-deck. Twice every day for three days this was repeated; but on the
fourth morning a confused wrangling, and then a scuffling was heard, as the
customary summons was delivered; and suddenly four men burst up from the
forecastle, saying they were ready to turn to. The fetid closeness of the air,
and a famishing diet, united perhaps to some fears of ultimate retribution, had
constrained them to surrender at discretion. Emboldened by this, the Captain
reiterated his demand to the rest, but Steelkilt shouted up to him a terrific
hint to stop his babbling and betake himself where he belonged. On the fifth
morning three others of the mutineers bolted up into the air from the desperate
arms below that sought to restrain them. Only three were left.
“'Better
turn to, now?' said the Captain with a heartless jeer.
“'Shut
us up again, will ye!' cried Steelkilt.
“'Oh!
certainly,' said the Captain, and the key clicked.
“It
was at this point, gentlemen, that enraged by the defection of seven of his former
associates, and stung by the mocking voice that had last hailed him, and
maddened by his long entombment in a place as black as the bowels of despair;
it was then that Steelkilt proposed to the two Canallers, thus far apparently
of one mind with him, to burst out of their hole at the next summoning of the
garrison; and armed with their keen mincing knives (long, crescentic, heavy
implements with a handle at each end) run amuck from the bowsprit to the
taffrail; and if by any devilishness of desperation possible, seize the ship.
For himself, he would do this, he said, whether they joined him or not. That
was the last night he should spend in that den. But the scheme met with no
opposition on the part of the other two; they swore they were ready for that,
or for any other mad thing, for anything in short but a surrender. And what was
more, they each insisted upon being the first man on deck, when the time to
make the rush should come. But to this their leader as fiercely objected,
reserving that priority for himself; particularly as his two comrades would not
yield, the one to the other, in the matter; and both of them could not be
first, for the ladder would but admit one man at a time. And here, gentlemen,
the foul play of these miscreants must come out.
“Upon
hearing the frantic project of their leader, each in his own separate soul had
suddenly lighted, it would seem, upon the same piece of treachery, namely: to
be foremost in breaking out, in order to be the first of the three, though the
last of the ten, to surrender; and thereby secure whatever small chance of
pardon such conduct might merit. But when Steelkilt made known his
determination still to lead them to the last, they in some way, by some subtle
chemistry of villany, mixed their before secret treacheries together; and when
their leader fell into a doze, verbally opened their souls to each other in
three sentences; and bound the sleeper with cords, and gagged him with cords;
and shrieked out for the Captain at midnight.
“Thinking
murder at hand, and smelling in the dark for the blood, he and all his armed
mates and harpooneers rushed for the forecastle. In a few minutes the scuttle
was opened, and, bound hand and foot, the still struggling ringleader was
shoved up into the air by his perfidious allies, who at once claimed the honor
of securing a man who had been fully ripe for murder. But all these were
collared, and dragged along the deck like dead cattle; and, side by side, were
seized up into the mizzen rigging, like three quarters of meat, and there they
hung till morning. 'Damn ye,' cried the Captain, pacing to and fro before them,
'the vultures would not touch ye, ye villains!'
“At
sunrise he summoned all hands; and separating those who had rebelled from those
who had taken no part in the mutiny, he told the former that he had a good mind
to flog them all round—thought, upon the whole, he would do so—he ought
to—justice demanded it; but for the present, considering their timely
surrender, he would let them go with a reprimand, which he accordingly
administered in the vernacular.
“'But
as for you, ye carrion rogues,' turning to the three men in the rigging—'for
you, I mean to mince ye up for the try-pots;' and, seizing a rope, he applied
it with all his might to the backs of the two traitors, till they yelled no
more, but lifelessly hung their heads sideways, as the two crucified thieves
are drawn.
“'My
wrist is sprained with ye!' he cried, at last; 'but there is still rope enough
left for you, my fine bantam, that wouldn't give up. Take that gag from his
mouth, and let us hear what he can say for himself.'
“For
a moment the exhausted mutineer made a tremulous motion of his cramped jaws,
and then painfully twisting round his head, said in a sort of hiss, 'What I say
is this—and mind it well—if you flog me, I murder you!'
“'Say
ye so? then see how ye frighten me'—and the Captain drew off with the rope to
strike.
“'Best
not,' hissed the Lakeman.
“'But
I must,'—and the rope was once more drawn back for the stroke.
“Steelkilt
here hissed out something, inaudible to all but the Captain; who, to the
amazement of all hands, started back, paced the deck rapidly two or three
times, and then suddenly throwing down his rope, said, 'I won't do it—let him
go—cut him down: d'ye hear?'
“But
as the junior mates were hurrying to execute the order, a pale man, with a
bandaged head, arrested them—Radney the chief mate. Ever since the blow, he had
lain in his berth; but that morning, hearing the tumult on the deck, he had
crept out, and thus far had watched the whole scene. Such was the state of his
mouth, that he could hardly speak; but mumbling something about his being
willing and able to do what the captain dared not attempt, he snatched the rope
and advanced to his pinioned foe.
“'You
are a coward!' hissed the Lakeman.
“'So
I am, but take that.' The mate was in the very act of striking, when another
hiss stayed his uplifted arm. He paused: and then pausing no more, made good
his word, spite of Steelkilt's threat, whatever that might have been. The three
men were then cut down, all hands were turned to, and, sullenly worked by the
moody seamen, the iron pumps clanged as before.
“Just
after dark that day, when one watch had retired below, a clamor was heard in
the forecastle; and the two trembling traitors running up, besieged the cabin
door, saying they durst not consort with the crew. Entreaties, cuffs, and kicks
could not drive them back, so at their own instance they were put down in the
ship's run for salvation. Still, no sign of mutiny reappeared among the rest.
On the contrary, it seemed, that mainly at Steelkilt's instigation, they had
resolved to maintain the strictest peacefulness, obey all orders to the last,
and, when the ship reached port, desert her in a body. But in order to insure
the speediest end to the voyage, they all agreed to another thing—namely, not
to sing out for whales, in case any should be discovered. For, spite of her
leak, and spite of all her other perils, the Town-Ho still maintained her
mast-heads, and her captain was just as willing to lower for a fish that
moment, as on the day his craft first struck the cruising ground; and Radney
the mate was quite as ready to change his berth for a boat, and with his
bandaged mouth seek to gag in death the vital jaw of the whale.
“But
though the Lakeman had induced the seamen to adopt this sort of passiveness in
their conduct, he kept his own counsel (at least till all was over) concerning
his own proper and private revenge upon the man who had stung him in the ventricles
of his heart. He was in Radney the chief mate's watch; and as if the infatuated
man sought to run more than half way to meet his doom, after the scene at the
rigging, he insisted, against the express counsel of the captain, upon resuming
the head of his watch at night. Upon this, and one or two other circumstances,
Steelkilt systematically built the plan of his revenge.
“During
the night, Radney had an unseamanlike way of sitting on the bulwarks of the
quarter-deck, and leaning his arm upon the gunwale of the boat which was
hoisted up there, a little above the ship's side. In this attitude, it was well
known, he sometimes dozed. There was a considerable vacancy between the boat
and the ship, and down between this was the sea. Steelkilt calculated his time,
and found that his next trick at the helm would come round at two o'clock, in
the morning of the third day from that in which he had been betrayed. At his
leisure, he employed the interval in braiding something very carefully in his
watches below.
“'What
are you making there?' said a shipmate.
“'What
do you think? what does it look like?'
“'Like
a lanyard for your bag; but it's an odd one, seems to me.'
“'Yes,
rather oddish,' said the Lakeman, holding it at arm's length before him; 'but I
think it will answer. Shipmate, I haven't enough twine,—have you any?'
“But
there was none in the forecastle.
“'Then
I must get some from old Rad;' and he rose to go aft.
“'You
don't mean to go a begging to him!' said a sailor.
“'Why
not? Do you think he won't do me a turn, when it's to help himself in the end,
shipmate?' and going to the mate, he looked at him quietly, and asked him for
some twine to mend his hammock. It was given him—neither twine nor lanyard were
seen again; but the next night an iron ball, closely netted, partly rolled from
the pocket of the Lakeman's monkey jacket, as he was tucking the coat into his
hammock for a pillow. Twenty-four hours after, his trick at the silent
helm—nigh to the man who was apt to doze over the grave always ready dug to the
seaman's hand—that fatal hour was then to come; and in the fore-ordaining soul
of Steelkilt, the mate was already stark and stretched as a corpse, with his
forehead crushed in.
“But,
gentlemen, a fool saved the would-be murderer from the bloody deed he had
planned. Yet complete revenge he had, and without being the avenger. For by a
mysterious fatality, Heaven itself seemed to step in to take out of his hands
into its own the damning thing he would have done.
“It
was just between daybreak and sunrise of the morning of the second day, when
they were washing down the decks, that a stupid Teneriffe man, drawing water in
the main-chains, all at once shouted out, 'There she rolls! there she rolls!'
Jesu, what a whale! It was Moby Dick.
“'Moby
Dick!' cried Don Sebastian; 'St. Dominic! Sir sailor, but do whales have
christenings? Whom call you Moby Dick?'
“'A
very white, and famous, and most deadly immortal monster, Don;—but that would
be too long a story.'
“'How?
how?' cried all the young Spaniards, crowding.
“'Nay,
Dons, Dons—nay, nay! I cannot rehearse that now. Let me get more into the air,
Sirs.'
“'The
chicha! the chicha!' cried Don Pedro; 'our vigorous friend looks faint;—fill up
his empty glass!'
“No
need, gentlemen; one moment, and I proceed.—Now, gentlemen, so suddenly
perceiving the snowy whale within fifty yards of the ship—forgetful of the
compact among the crew—in the excitement of the moment, the Teneriffe man had
instinctively and involuntarily lifted his voice for the monster, though for
some little time past it had been plainly beheld from the three sullen
mast-heads. All was now a phrensy. 'The White Whale—the White Whale!' was the
cry from captain, mates, and harpooneers, who, undeterred by fearful rumours,
were all anxious to capture so famous and precious a fish; while the dogged
crew eyed askance, and with curses, the appalling beauty of the vast milky
mass, that lit up by a horizontal spangling sun, shifted and glistened like a
living opal in the blue morning sea. Gentlemen, a strange fatality pervades the
whole career of these events, as if verily mapped out before the world itself
was charted. The mutineer was the bowsman of the mate, and when fast to a fish,
it was his duty to sit next him, while Radney stood up with his lance in the
prow, and haul in or slacken the line, at the word of command. Moreover, when
the four boats were lowered, the mate's got the start; and none howled more
fiercely with delight than did Steelkilt, as he strained at his oar. After a
stiff pull, their harpooneer got fast, and, spear in hand, Radney sprang to the
bow. He was always a furious man, it seems, in a boat. And now his bandaged cry
was, to beach him on the whale's topmost back. Nothing loath, his bowsman
hauled him up and up, through a blinding foam that blent two whitenesses
together; till of a sudden the boat struck as against a sunken ledge, and
keeling over, spilled out the standing mate. That instant, as he fell on the
whale's slippery back, the boat righted, and was dashed aside by the swell,
while Radney was tossed over into the sea, on the other flank of the whale. He
struck out through the spray, and, for an instant, was dimly seen through that
veil, wildly seeking to remove himself from the eye of Moby Dick. But the whale
rushed round in a sudden maelstrom; seized the swimmer between his jaws; and
rearing high up with him, plunged headlong again, and went down.
“Meantime,
at the first tap of the boat's bottom, the Lakeman had slackened the line, so
as to drop astern from the whirlpool; calmly looking on, he thought his own
thoughts. But a sudden, terrific, downward jerking of the boat, quickly brought
his knife to the line. He cut it; and the whale was free. But, at some
distance, Moby Dick rose again, with some tatters of Radney's red woollen
shirt, caught in the teeth that had destroyed him. All four boats gave chase
again; but the whale eluded them, and finally wholly disappeared.
“In
good time, the Town-Ho reached her port—a savage, solitary place—where no
civilized creature resided. There, headed by the Lakeman, all but five or six
of the foremastmen deliberately deserted among the palms; eventually, as it
turned out, seizing a large double war-canoe of the savages, and setting sail
for some other harbor.
“The
ship's company being reduced to but a handful, the captain called upon the
Islanders to assist him in the laborious business of heaving down the ship to
stop the leak. But to such unresting vigilance over their dangerous allies was
this small band of whites necessitated, both by night and by day, and so
extreme was the hard work they underwent, that upon the vessel being ready
again for sea, they were in such a weakened condition that the captain durst
not put off with them in so heavy a vessel. After taking counsel with his
officers, he anchored the ship as far off shore as possible; loaded and ran out
his two cannon from the bows; stacked his muskets on the poop; and warning the
Islanders not to approach the ship at their peril, took one man with him, and
setting the sail of his best whale-boat, steered straight before the wind for
Tahiti, five hundred miles distant, to procure a reinforcement to his crew.
“On
the fourth day of the sail, a large canoe was descried, which seemed to have
touched at a low isle of corals. He steered away from it; but the savage craft
bore down on him; and soon the voice of Steelkilt hailed him to heave to, or he
would run him under water. The captain presented a pistol. With one foot on
each prow of the yoked war-canoes, the Lakeman laughed him to scorn; assuring
him that if the pistol so much as clicked in the lock, he would bury him in
bubbles and foam.
“'What
do you want of me?' cried the captain.
“'Where
are you bound? and for what are you bound?' demanded Steelkilt; 'no lies.'
“'I
am bound to Tahiti for more men.'
“'Very
good. Let me board you a moment—I come in peace.' With that he leaped from the
canoe, swam to the boat; and climbing the gunwale, stood face to face with the
captain.
“'Cross
your arms, sir; throw back your head. Now, repeat after me. As soon as Steelkilt
leaves me, I swear to beach this boat on yonder island, and remain there six
days. If I do not, may lightnings strike me!'
“'A
pretty scholar,' laughed the Lakeman. 'Adios, Senor!' and leaping into the sea,
he swam back to his comrades.
“Watching
the boat till it was fairly beached, and drawn up to the roots of the cocoa-nut
trees, Steelkilt made sail again, and in due time arrived at Tahiti, his own
place of destination. There, luck befriended him; two ships were about to sail
for France, and were providentially in want of precisely that number of men
which the sailor headed. They embarked; and so for ever got the start of their
former captain, had he been at all minded to work them legal retribution.
“Some
ten days after the French ships sailed, the whale-boat arrived, and the captain
was forced to enlist some of the more civilized Tahitians, who had been
somewhat used to the sea. Chartering a small native schooner, he returned with
them to his vessel; and finding all right there, again resumed his cruisings.
“Where
Steelkilt now is, gentlemen, none know; but upon the island of Nantucket, the
widow of Radney still turns to the sea which refuses to give up its dead; still
in dreams sees the awful white whale that destroyed him. * * * *
“'Are
you through?' said Don Sebastian, quietly.
“'I
am, Don.'
“'Then
I entreat you, tell me if to the best of your own convictions, this your story
is in substance really true? It is so passing wonderful! Did you get it from an
unquestionable source? Bear with me if I seem to press.'
“'Also
bear with all of us, sir sailor; for we all join in Don Sebastian's suit,'
cried the company, with exceeding interest.
“'Is
there a copy of the Holy Evangelists in the Golden Inn, gentlemen?'
“'Nay,'
said Don Sebastian; 'but I know a worthy priest near by, who will quickly
procure one for me. I go for it; but are you well advised? this may grow too
serious.'
“'Will
you be so good as to bring the priest also, Don?'
“'Though
there are no Auto-da-Fés in Lima now,' said one of the company to another; 'I
fear our sailor friend runs risk of the archiepiscopacy. Let us withdraw more
out of the moonlight. I see no need of this.'
“'Excuse
me for running after you, Don Sebastian; but may I also beg that you will be
particular in procuring the largest sized Evangelists you can.'
*
* * * * *
“'This
is the priest, he brings you the Evangelists,' said Don Sebastian, gravely,
returning with a tall and solemn figure.
“'Let
me remove my hat. Now, venerable priest, further into the light, and hold the
Holy Book before me that I may touch it.
“'So
help me Heaven, and on my honor the story I have told ye, gentlemen, is in
substance and its great items, true. I know it to be true; it happened on this
ball; I trod the ship; I knew the crew; I have seen and talked with Steelkilt
since the death of Radney.'”
CHAPTER
55. Of the Monstrous Pictures of Whales.
I
shall ere long paint to you as well as one can without canvas, something like
the true form of the whale as he actually appears to the eye of the whaleman
when in his own absolute body the whale is moored alongside the whale-ship so
that he can be fairly stepped upon there. It may be worth while, therefore,
previously to advert to those curious imaginary portraits of him which even
down to the present day confidently challenge the faith of the landsman. It is
time to set the world right in this matter, by proving such pictures of the
whale all wrong.
It
may be that the primal source of all those pictorial delusions will be found
among the oldest Hindoo, Egyptian, and Grecian sculptures. For ever since those
inventive but unscrupulous times when on the marble panellings of temples, the
pedestals of statues, and on shields, medallions, cups, and coins, the dolphin
was drawn in scales of chain-armor like Saladin's, and a helmeted head like St.
George's; ever since then has something of the same sort of license prevailed,
not only in most popular pictures of the whale, but in many scientific
presentations of him.
Now,
by all odds, the most ancient extant portrait anyways purporting to be the
whale's, is to be found in the famous cavern-pagoda of Elephanta, in India. The
Brahmins maintain that in the almost endless sculptures of that immemorial
pagoda, all the trades and pursuits, every conceivable avocation of man, were
prefigured ages before any of them actually came into being. No wonder then,
that in some sort our noble profession of whaling should have been there shadowed
forth. The Hindoo whale referred to, occurs in a separate department of the
wall, depicting the incarnation of Vishnu in the form of leviathan, learnedly
known as the Matse Avatar. But though this sculpture is half man and half
whale, so as only to give the tail of the latter, yet that small section of him
is all wrong. It looks more like the tapering tail of an anaconda, than the
broad palms of the true whale's majestic flukes.
But
go to the old Galleries, and look now at a great Christian painter's portrait
of this fish; for he succeeds no better than the antediluvian Hindoo. It is
Guido's picture of Perseus rescuing Andromeda from the sea-monster or whale.
Where did Guido get the model of such a strange creature as that? Nor does
Hogarth, in painting the same scene in his own “Perseus Descending,” make out
one whit better. The huge corpulence of that Hogarthian monster undulates on
the surface, scarcely drawing one inch of water. It has a sort of howdah on its
back, and its distended tusked mouth into which the billows are rolling, might
be taken for the Traitors' Gate leading from the Thames by water into the
Tower. Then, there are the Prodromus whales of old Scotch Sibbald, and Jonah's
whale, as depicted in the prints of old Bibles and the cuts of old primers.
What shall be said of these? As for the book-binder's whale winding like a
vine-stalk round the stock of a descending anchor—as stamped and gilded on the
backs and title-pages of many books both old and new—that is a very picturesque
but purely fabulous creature, imitated, I take it, from the like figures on
antique vases. Though universally denominated a dolphin, I nevertheless call
this book-binder's fish an attempt at a whale; because it was so intended when
the device was first introduced. It was introduced by an old Italian publisher
somewhere about the 15th century, during the Revival of Learning; and in those
days, and even down to a comparatively late period, dolphins were popularly
supposed to be a species of the Leviathan.
In
the vignettes and other embellishments of some ancient books you will at times
meet with very curious touches at the whale, where all manner of spouts, jets
d'eau, hot springs and cold, Saratoga and Baden-Baden, come bubbling up from
his unexhausted brain. In the title-page of the original edition of the
“Advancement of Learning” you will find some curious whales.
But
quitting all these unprofessional attempts, let us glance at those pictures of
leviathan purporting to be sober, scientific delineations, by those who know.
In old Harris's collection of voyages there are some plates of whales extracted
from a Dutch book of voyages, A.D. 1671, entitled “A Whaling Voyage to
Spitzbergen in the ship Jonas in the Whale, Peter Peterson of Friesland,
master.” In one of those plates the whales, like great rafts of logs, are
represented lying among ice-isles, with white bears running over their living
backs. In another plate, the prodigious blunder is made of representing the
whale with perpendicular flukes.
Then
again, there is an imposing quarto, written by one Captain Colnett, a Post
Captain in the English navy, entitled “A Voyage round Cape Horn into the South
Seas, for the purpose of extending the Spermaceti Whale Fisheries.” In this
book is an outline purporting to be a “Picture of a Physeter or Spermaceti
whale, drawn by scale from one killed on the coast of Mexico, August, 1793, and
hoisted on deck.” I doubt not the captain had this veracious picture taken for
the benefit of his marines. To mention but one thing about it, let me say that
it has an eye which applied, according to the accompanying scale, to a full
grown sperm whale, would make the eye of that whale a bow-window some five feet
long. Ah, my gallant captain, why did ye not give us Jonah looking out of that
eye!
Nor
are the most conscientious compilations of Natural History for the benefit of
the young and tender, free from the same heinousness of mistake. Look at that
popular work “Goldsmith's Animated Nature.” In the abridged London edition of
1807, there are plates of an alleged “whale” and a “narwhale.” I do not wish to
seem inelegant, but this unsightly whale looks much like an amputated sow; and,
as for the narwhale, one glimpse at it is enough to amaze one, that in this
nineteenth century such a hippogriff could be palmed for genuine upon any
intelligent public of schoolboys.
Then,
again, in 1825, Bernard Germain, Count de Lacépède, a great naturalist,
published a scientific systemized whale book, wherein are several pictures of
the different species of the Leviathan. All these are not only incorrect, but
the picture of the Mysticetus or Greenland whale (that is to say, the Right
whale), even Scoresby, a long experienced man as touching that species,
declares not to have its counterpart in nature.
But
the placing of the cap-sheaf to all this blundering business was reserved for
the scientific Frederick Cuvier, brother to the famous Baron. In 1836, he
published a Natural History of Whales, in which he gives what he calls a
picture of the Sperm Whale. Before showing that picture to any Nantucketer, you
had best provide for your summary retreat from Nantucket. In a word, Frederick
Cuvier's Sperm Whale is not a Sperm Whale, but a squash. Of course, he never
had the benefit of a whaling voyage (such men seldom have), but whence he
derived that picture, who can tell? Perhaps he got it as his scientific predecessor
in the same field, Desmarest, got one of his authentic abortions; that is, from
a Chinese drawing. And what sort of lively lads with the pencil those Chinese
are, many queer cups and saucers inform us.
As
for the sign-painters' whales seen in the streets hanging over the shops of
oil-dealers, what shall be said of them? They are generally Richard III.
whales, with dromedary humps, and very savage; breakfasting on three or four
sailor tarts, that is whaleboats full of mariners: their deformities floundering
in seas of blood and blue paint.
But
these manifold mistakes in depicting the whale are not so very surprising after
all. Consider! Most of the scientific drawings have been taken from the
stranded fish; and these are about as correct as a drawing of a wrecked ship,
with broken back, would correctly represent the noble animal itself in all its
undashed pride of hull and spars. Though elephants have stood for their
full-lengths, the living Leviathan has never yet fairly floated himself for his
portrait. The living whale, in his full majesty and significance, is only to be
seen at sea in unfathomable waters; and afloat the vast bulk of him is out of
sight, like a launched line-of-battle ship; and out of that element it is a
thing eternally impossible for mortal man to hoist him bodily into the air, so
as to preserve all his mighty swells and undulations. And, not to speak of the
highly presumable difference of contour between a young sucking whale and a
full-grown Platonian Leviathan; yet, even in the case of one of those young
sucking whales hoisted to a ship's deck, such is then the outlandish, eel-like,
limbered, varying shape of him, that his precise expression the devil himself
could not catch.
But
it may be fancied, that from the naked skeleton of the stranded whale, accurate
hints may be derived touching his true form. Not at all. For it is one of the
more curious things about this Leviathan, that his skeleton gives very little
idea of his general shape. Though Jeremy Bentham's skeleton, which hangs for
candelabra in the library of one of his executors, correctly conveys the idea
of a burly-browed utilitarian old gentleman, with all Jeremy's other leading
personal characteristics; yet nothing of this kind could be inferred from any
leviathan's articulated bones. In fact, as the great Hunter says, the mere
skeleton of the whale bears the same relation to the fully invested and padded
animal as the insect does to the chrysalis that so roundingly envelopes it.
This peculiarity is strikingly evinced in the head, as in some part of this
book will be incidentally shown. It is also very curiously displayed in the
side fin, the bones of which almost exactly answer to the bones of the human
hand, minus only the thumb. This fin has four regular bone-fingers, the index,
middle, ring, and little finger. But all these are permanently lodged in their
fleshy covering, as the human fingers in an artificial covering. “However
recklessly the whale may sometimes serve us,” said humorous Stubb one day, “he
can never be truly said to handle us without mittens.”
For
all these reasons, then, any way you may look at it, you must needs conclude
that the great Leviathan is that one creature in the world which must remain
unpainted to the last. True, one portrait may hit the mark much nearer than
another, but none can hit it with any very considerable degree of exactness. So
there is no earthly way of finding out precisely what the whale really looks
like. And the only mode in which you can derive even a tolerable idea of his
living contour, is by going a whaling yourself; but by so doing, you run no
small risk of being eternally stove and sunk by him. Wherefore, it seems to me
you had best not be too fastidious in your curiosity touching this Leviathan.
CHAPTER
56. Of the Less Erroneous Pictures of Whales, and the True Pictures of Whaling
Scenes.
In
connexion with the monstrous pictures of whales, I am strongly tempted here to
enter upon those still more monstrous stories of them which are to be found in
certain books, both ancient and modern, especially in Pliny, Purchas, Hackluyt,
Harris, Cuvier, etc. But I pass that matter by.
I
know of only four published outlines of the great Sperm Whale; Colnett's,
Huggins's, Frederick Cuvier's, and Beale's. In the previous chapter Colnett and
Cuvier have been referred to. Huggins's is far better than theirs; but, by
great odds, Beale's is the best. All Beale's drawings of this whale are good,
excepting the middle figure in the picture of three whales in various
attitudes, capping his second chapter. His frontispiece, boats attacking Sperm
Whales, though no doubt calculated to excite the civil scepticism of some
parlor men, is admirably correct and life-like in its general effect. Some of
the Sperm Whale drawings in J. Ross Browne are pretty correct in contour; but
they are wretchedly engraved. That is not his fault though.
Of
the Right Whale, the best outline pictures are in Scoresby; but they are drawn
on too small a scale to convey a desirable impression. He has but one picture
of whaling scenes, and this is a sad deficiency, because it is by such pictures
only, when at all well done, that you can derive anything like a truthful idea
of the living whale as seen by his living hunters.
But,
taken for all in all, by far the finest, though in some details not the most
correct, presentations of whales and whaling scenes to be anywhere found, are
two large French engravings, well executed, and taken from paintings by one
Garnery. Respectively, they represent attacks on the Sperm and Right Whale. In
the first engraving a noble Sperm Whale is depicted in full majesty of might, just
risen beneath the boat from the profundities of the ocean, and bearing high in
the air upon his back the terrific wreck of the stoven planks. The prow of the
boat is partially unbroken, and is drawn just balancing upon the monster's
spine; and standing in that prow, for that one single incomputable flash of
time, you behold an oarsman, half shrouded by the incensed boiling spout of the
whale, and in the act of leaping, as if from a precipice. The action of the
whole thing is wonderfully good and true. The half-emptied line-tub floats on
the whitened sea; the wooden poles of the spilled harpoons obliquely bob in it;
the heads of the swimming crew are scattered about the whale in contrasting
expressions of affright; while in the black stormy distance the ship is bearing
down upon the scene. Serious fault might be found with the anatomical details
of this whale, but let that pass; since, for the life of me, I could not draw
so good a one.
In
the second engraving, the boat is in the act of drawing alongside the barnacled
flank of a large running Right Whale, that rolls his black weedy bulk in the
sea like some mossy rock-slide from the Patagonian cliffs. His jets are erect,
full, and black like soot; so that from so abounding a smoke in the chimney,
you would think there must be a brave supper cooking in the great bowels below.
Sea fowls are pecking at the small crabs, shell-fish, and other sea candies and
maccaroni, which the Right Whale sometimes carries on his pestilent back. And
all the while the thick-lipped leviathan is rushing through the deep, leaving
tons of tumultuous white curds in his wake, and causing the slight boat to rock
in the swells like a skiff caught nigh the paddle-wheels of an ocean steamer.
Thus, the foreground is all raging commotion; but behind, in admirable artistic
contrast, is the glassy level of a sea becalmed, the drooping unstarched sails
of the powerless ship, and the inert mass of a dead whale, a conquered
fortress, with the flag of capture lazily hanging from the whale-pole inserted
into his spout-hole.
Who
Garnery the painter is, or was, I know not. But my life for it he was either
practically conversant with his subject, or else marvellously tutored by some
experienced whaleman. The French are the lads for painting action. Go and gaze
upon all the paintings of Europe, and where will you find such a gallery of
living and breathing commotion on canvas, as in that triumphal hall at
Versailles; where the beholder fights his way, pell-mell, through the
consecutive great battles of France; where every sword seems a flash of the
Northern Lights, and the successive armed kings and Emperors dash by, like a
charge of crowned centaurs? Not wholly unworthy of a place in that gallery, are
these sea battle-pieces of Garnery.
The
natural aptitude of the French for seizing the picturesqueness of things seems
to be peculiarly evinced in what paintings and engravings they have of their
whaling scenes. With not one tenth of England's experience in the fishery, and
not the thousandth part of that of the Americans, they have nevertheless
furnished both nations with the only finished sketches at all capable of
conveying the real spirit of the whale hunt. For the most part, the English and
American whale draughtsmen seem entirely content with presenting the mechanical
outline of things, such as the vacant profile of the whale; which, so far as
picturesqueness of effect is concerned, is about tantamount to sketching the
profile of a pyramid. Even Scoresby, the justly renowned Right whaleman, after
giving us a stiff full length of the Greenland whale, and three or four
delicate miniatures of narwhales and porpoises, treats us to a series of
classical engravings of boat hooks, chopping knives, and grapnels; and with the
microscopic diligence of a Leuwenhoeck submits to the inspection of a shivering
world ninety-six fac-similes of magnified Arctic snow crystals. I mean no
disparagement to the excellent voyager (I honor him for a veteran), but in so
important a matter it was certainly an oversight not to have procured for every
crystal a sworn affidavit taken before a Greenland Justice of the Peace.
In
addition to those fine engravings from Garnery, there are two other French
engravings worthy of note, by some one who subscribes himself “H. Durand.” One
of them, though not precisely adapted to our present purpose, nevertheless
deserves mention on other accounts. It is a quiet noon-scene among the isles of
the Pacific; a French whaler anchored, inshore, in a calm, and lazily taking
water on board; the loosened sails of the ship, and the long leaves of the
palms in the background, both drooping together in the breezeless air. The
effect is very fine, when considered with reference to its presenting the hardy
fishermen under one of their few aspects of oriental repose. The other
engraving is quite a different affair: the ship hove-to upon the open sea, and
in the very heart of the Leviathanic life, with a Right Whale alongside; the
vessel (in the act of cutting-in) hove over to the monster as if to a quay; and
a boat, hurriedly pushing off from this scene of activity, is about giving
chase to whales in the distance. The harpoons and lances lie levelled for use;
three oarsmen are just setting the mast in its hole; while from a sudden roll
of the sea, the little craft stands half-erect out of the water, like a rearing
horse. From the ship, the smoke of the torments of the boiling whale is going
up like the smoke over a village of smithies; and to windward, a black cloud,
rising up with earnest of squalls and rains, seems to quicken the activity of
the excited seamen.
CHAPTER
57. Of Whales in Paint; in Teeth; in Wood; in Sheet-Iron; in Stone; in
Mountains; in Stars.
On
Tower-hill, as you go down to the London docks, you may have seen a crippled
beggar (or kedger, as the sailors say) holding a painted board before him,
representing the tragic scene in which he lost his leg. There are three whales
and three boats; and one of the boats (presumed to contain the missing leg in
all its original integrity) is being crunched by the jaws of the foremost
whale. Any time these ten years, they tell me, has that man held up that
picture, and exhibited that stump to an incredulous world. But the time of his
justification has now come. His three whales are as good whales as were ever
published in Wapping, at any rate; and his stump as unquestionable a stump as
any you will find in the western clearings. But, though for ever mounted on
that stump, never a stump-speech does the poor whaleman make; but, with
downcast eyes, stands ruefully contemplating his own amputation.
Throughout
the Pacific, and also in Nantucket, and New Bedford, and Sag Harbor, you will
come across lively sketches of whales and whaling-scenes, graven by the
fishermen themselves on Sperm Whale-teeth, or ladies' busks wrought out of the
Right Whale-bone, and other like skrimshander articles, as the whalemen call
the numerous little ingenious contrivances they elaborately carve out of the
rough material, in their hours of ocean leisure. Some of them have little boxes
of dentistical-looking implements, specially intended for the skrimshandering
business. But, in general, they toil with their jack-knives alone; and, with
that almost omnipotent tool of the sailor, they will turn you out anything you
please, in the way of a mariner's fancy.
Long
exile from Christendom and civilization inevitably restores a man to that
condition in which God placed him, i.e. what is called savagery. Your true
whale-hunter is as much a savage as an Iroquois. I myself am a savage, owning
no allegiance but to the King of the Cannibals; and ready at any moment to
rebel against him.
Now,
one of the peculiar characteristics of the savage in his domestic hours, is his
wonderful patience of industry. An ancient Hawaiian war-club or spear-paddle,
in its full multiplicity and elaboration of carving, is as great a trophy of
human perseverance as a Latin lexicon. For, with but a bit of broken sea-shell
or a shark's tooth, that miraculous intricacy of wooden net-work has been
achieved; and it has cost steady years of steady application.
As
with the Hawaiian savage, so with the white sailor-savage. With the same
marvellous patience, and with the same single shark's tooth, of his one poor
jack-knife, he will carve you a bit of bone sculpture, not quite as
workmanlike, but as close packed in its maziness of design, as the Greek
savage, Achilles's shield; and full of barbaric spirit and suggestiveness, as
the prints of that fine old Dutch savage, Albert Durer.
Wooden
whales, or whales cut in profile out of the small dark slabs of the noble South
Sea war-wood, are frequently met with in the forecastles of American whalers.
Some of them are done with much accuracy.
At
some old gable-roofed country houses you will see brass whales hung by the tail
for knockers to the road-side door. When the porter is sleepy, the anvil-headed
whale would be best. But these knocking whales are seldom remarkable as
faithful essays. On the spires of some old-fashioned churches you will see
sheet-iron whales placed there for weather-cocks; but they are so elevated, and
besides that are to all intents and purposes so labelled with “Hands off!” you
cannot examine them closely enough to decide upon their merit.
In
bony, ribby regions of the earth, where at the base of high broken cliffs
masses of rock lie strewn in fantastic groupings upon the plain, you will often
discover images as of the petrified forms of the Leviathan partly merged in
grass, which of a windy day breaks against them in a surf of green surges.
Then,
again, in mountainous countries where the traveller is continually girdled by
amphitheatrical heights; here and there from some lucky point of view you will
catch passing glimpses of the profiles of whales defined along the undulating
ridges. But you must be a thorough whaleman, to see these sights; and not only
that, but if you wish to return to such a sight again, you must be sure and
take the exact intersecting latitude and longitude of your first stand-point,
else so chance-like are such observations of the hills, that your precise,
previous stand-point would require a laborious re-discovery; like the Soloma
Islands, which still remain incognita, though once high-ruffed Mendanna trod
them and old Figuera chronicled them.
Nor
when expandingly lifted by your subject, can you fail to trace out great whales
in the starry heavens, and boats in pursuit of them; as when long filled with
thoughts of war the Eastern nations saw armies locked in battle among the
clouds. Thus at the North have I chased Leviathan round and round the Pole with
the revolutions of the bright points that first defined him to me. And beneath
the effulgent Antarctic skies I have boarded the Argo-Navis, and joined the
chase against the starry Cetus far beyond the utmost stretch of Hydrus and the
Flying Fish.
With
a frigate's anchors for my bridle-bitts and fasces of harpoons for spurs, would
I could mount that whale and leap the topmost skies, to see whether the fabled
heavens with all their countless tents really lie encamped beyond my mortal
sight!
CHAPTER
58. Brit.
Steering
north-eastward from the Crozetts, we fell in with vast meadows of brit, the
minute, yellow substance, upon which the Right Whale largely feeds. For leagues
and leagues it undulated round us, so that we seemed to be sailing through
boundless fields of ripe and golden wheat.
On
the second day, numbers of Right Whales were seen, who, secure from the attack
of a Sperm Whaler like the Pequod, with open jaws sluggishly swam through the
brit, which, adhering to the fringing fibres of that wondrous Venetian blind in
their mouths, was in that manner separated from the water that escaped at the
lip.
As
morning mowers, who side by side slowly and seethingly advance their scythes through
the long wet grass of marshy meads; even so these monsters swam, making a
strange, grassy, cutting sound; and leaving behind them endless swaths of blue
upon the yellow sea.*
*That
part of the sea known among whalemen as the “Brazil Banks” does not bear that
name as the Banks of Newfoundland do, because of there being shallows and
soundings there, but because of this remarkable meadow-like appearance, caused
by the vast drifts of brit continually floating in those latitudes, where the
Right Whale is often chased.
But
it was only the sound they made as they parted the brit which at all reminded
one of mowers. Seen from the mast-heads, especially when they paused and were
stationary for a while, their vast black forms looked more like lifeless masses
of rock than anything else. And as in the great hunting countries of India, the
stranger at a distance will sometimes pass on the plains recumbent elephants
without knowing them to be such, taking them for bare, blackened elevations of
the soil; even so, often, with him, who for the first time beholds this species
of the leviathans of the sea. And even when recognised at last, their immense
magnitude renders it very hard really to believe that such bulky masses of
overgrowth can possibly be instinct, in all parts, with the same sort of life
that lives in a dog or a horse.
Indeed,
in other respects, you can hardly regard any creatures of the deep with the
same feelings that you do those of the shore. For though some old naturalists
have maintained that all creatures of the land are of their kind in the sea;
and though taking a broad general view of the thing, this may very well be; yet
coming to specialties, where, for example, does the ocean furnish any fish that
in disposition answers to the sagacious kindness of the dog? The accursed shark
alone can in any generic respect be said to bear comparative analogy to him.
But
though, to landsmen in general, the native inhabitants of the seas have ever
been regarded with emotions unspeakably unsocial and repelling; though we know
the sea to be an everlasting terra incognita, so that Columbus sailed over
numberless unknown worlds to discover his one superficial western one; though,
by vast odds, the most terrific of all mortal disasters have immemorially and
indiscriminately befallen tens and hundreds of thousands of those who have gone
upon the waters; though but a moment's consideration will teach, that however
baby man may brag of his science and skill, and however much, in a flattering
future, that science and skill may augment; yet for ever and for ever, to the
crack of doom, the sea will insult and murder him, and pulverize the
stateliest, stiffest frigate he can make; nevertheless, by the continual
repetition of these very impressions, man has lost that sense of the full
awfulness of the sea which aboriginally belongs to it.
The
first boat we read of, floated on an ocean, that with Portuguese vengeance had
whelmed a whole world without leaving so much as a widow. That same ocean rolls
now; that same ocean destroyed the wrecked ships of last year. Yea, foolish
mortals, Noah's flood is not yet subsided; two thirds of the fair world it yet
covers.
Wherein
differ the sea and the land, that a miracle upon one is not a miracle upon the
other? Preternatural terrors rested upon the Hebrews, when under the feet of
Korah and his company the live ground opened and swallowed them up for ever;
yet not a modern sun ever sets, but in precisely the same manner the live sea
swallows up ships and crews.
But
not only is the sea such a foe to man who is an alien to it, but it is also a
fiend to its own off-spring; worse than the Persian host who murdered his own
guests; sparing not the creatures which itself hath spawned. Like a savage
tigress that tossing in the jungle overlays her own cubs, so the sea dashes
even the mightiest whales against the rocks, and leaves them there side by side
with the split wrecks of ships. No mercy, no power but its own controls it.
Panting and snorting like a mad battle steed that has lost its rider, the
masterless ocean overruns the globe.
Consider
the subtleness of the sea; how its most dreaded creatures glide under water,
unapparent for the most part, and treacherously hidden beneath the loveliest
tints of azure. Consider also the devilish brilliance and beauty of many of its
most remorseless tribes, as the dainty embellished shape of many species of
sharks. Consider, once more, the universal cannibalism of the sea; all whose
creatures prey upon each other, carrying on eternal war since the world began.
Consider
all this; and then turn to this green, gentle, and most docile earth; consider
them both, the sea and the land; and do you not find a strange analogy to
something in yourself? For as this appalling ocean surrounds the verdant land,
so in the soul of man there lies one insular Tahiti, full of peace and joy, but
encompassed by all the horrors of the half known life. God keep thee! Push not
off from that isle, thou canst never return!
CHAPTER
59. Squid.
Slowly
wading through the meadows of brit, the Pequod still held on her way
north-eastward towards the island of Java; a gentle air impelling her keel, so
that in the surrounding serenity her three tall tapering masts mildly waved to
that languid breeze, as three mild palms on a plain. And still, at wide
intervals in the silvery night, the lonely, alluring jet would be seen.
But
one transparent blue morning, when a stillness almost preternatural spread over
the sea, however unattended with any stagnant calm; when the long burnished
sun-glade on the waters seemed a golden finger laid across them, enjoining some
secrecy; when the slippered waves whispered together as they softly ran on; in
this profound hush of the visible sphere a strange spectre was seen by Daggoo
from the main-mast-head.
In
the distance, a great white mass lazily rose, and rising higher and higher, and
disentangling itself from the azure, at last gleamed before our prow like a
snow-slide, new slid from the hills. Thus glistening for a moment, as slowly it
subsided, and sank. Then once more arose, and silently gleamed. It seemed not a
whale; and yet is this Moby Dick? thought Daggoo. Again the phantom went down,
but on re-appearing once more, with a stiletto-like cry that startled every man
from his nod, the negro yelled out—“There! there again! there she breaches!
right ahead! The White Whale, the White Whale!”
Upon
this, the seamen rushed to the yard-arms, as in swarming-time the bees rush to
the boughs. Bare-headed in the sultry sun, Ahab stood on the bowsprit, and with
one hand pushed far behind in readiness to wave his orders to the helmsman,
cast his eager glance in the direction indicated aloft by the outstretched
motionless arm of Daggoo.
Whether
the flitting attendance of the one still and solitary jet had gradually worked
upon Ahab, so that he was now prepared to connect the ideas of mildness and
repose with the first sight of the particular whale he pursued; however this
was, or whether his eagerness betrayed him; whichever way it might have been,
no sooner did he distinctly perceive the white mass, than with a quick
intensity he instantly gave orders for lowering.
The
four boats were soon on the water; Ahab's in advance, and all swiftly pulling
towards their prey. Soon it went down, and while, with oars suspended, we were
awaiting its reappearance, lo! in the same spot where it sank, once more it
slowly rose. Almost forgetting for the moment all thoughts of Moby Dick, we now
gazed at the most wondrous phenomenon which the secret seas have hitherto
revealed to mankind. A vast pulpy mass, furlongs in length and breadth, of a
glancing cream-colour, lay floating on the water, innumerable long arms
radiating from its centre, and curling and twisting like a nest of anacondas,
as if blindly to clutch at any hapless object within reach. No perceptible face
or front did it have; no conceivable token of either sensation or instinct; but
undulated there on the billows, an unearthly, formless, chance-like apparition
of life.
As
with a low sucking sound it slowly disappeared again, Starbuck still gazing at
the agitated waters where it had sunk, with a wild voice exclaimed—“Almost
rather had I seen Moby Dick and fought him, than to have seen thee, thou white
ghost!”
“What
was it, Sir?” said Flask.
“The
great live squid, which, they say, few whale-ships ever beheld, and returned to
their ports to tell of it.”
But
Ahab said nothing; turning his boat, he sailed back to the vessel; the rest as
silently following.
Whatever
superstitions the sperm whalemen in general have connected with the sight of
this object, certain it is, that a glimpse of it being so very unusual, that
circumstance has gone far to invest it with portentousness. So rarely is it beheld,
that though one and all of them declare it to be the largest animated thing in
the ocean, yet very few of them have any but the most vague ideas concerning
its true nature and form; notwithstanding, they believe it to furnish to the
sperm whale his only food. For though other species of whales find their food
above water, and may be seen by man in the act of feeding, the spermaceti whale
obtains his whole food in unknown zones below the surface; and only by
inference is it that any one can tell of what, precisely, that food consists.
At times, when closely pursued, he will disgorge what are supposed to be the
detached arms of the squid; some of them thus exhibited exceeding twenty and
thirty feet in length. They fancy that the monster to which these arms belonged
ordinarily clings by them to the bed of the ocean; and that the sperm whale,
unlike other species, is supplied with teeth in order to attack and tear it.
There
seems some ground to imagine that the great Kraken of Bishop Pontoppodan may
ultimately resolve itself into Squid. The manner in which the Bishop describes
it, as alternately rising and sinking, with some other particulars he narrates,
in all this the two correspond. But much abatement is necessary with respect to
the incredible bulk he assigns it.
By
some naturalists who have vaguely heard rumors of the mysterious creature, here
spoken of, it is included among the class of cuttle-fish, to which, indeed, in
certain external respects it would seem to belong, but only as the Anak of the
tribe.
CHAPTER
60. The Line.
With
reference to the whaling scene shortly to be described, as well as for the
better understanding of all similar scenes elsewhere presented, I have here to
speak of the magical, sometimes horrible whale-line.
The
line originally used in the fishery was of the best hemp, slightly vapored with
tar, not impregnated with it, as in the case of ordinary ropes; for while tar,
as ordinarily used, makes the hemp more pliable to the rope-maker, and also
renders the rope itself more convenient to the sailor for common ship use; yet,
not only would the ordinary quantity too much stiffen the whale-line for the
close coiling to which it must be subjected; but as most seamen are beginning
to learn, tar in general by no means adds to the rope's durability or strength,
however much it may give it compactness and gloss.
Of
late years the Manilla rope has in the American fishery almost entirely
superseded hemp as a material for whale-lines; for, though not so durable as
hemp, it is stronger, and far more soft and elastic; and I will add (since
there is an æsthetics in all things), is much more handsome and becoming to the
boat, than hemp. Hemp is a dusky, dark fellow, a sort of Indian; but Manilla is
as a golden-haired Circassian to behold.
The
whale-line is only two-thirds of an inch in thickness. At first sight, you would
not think it so strong as it really is. By experiment its one and fifty yarns
will each suspend a weight of one hundred and twenty pounds; so that the whole
rope will bear a strain nearly equal to three tons. In length, the common sperm
whale-line measures something over two hundred fathoms. Towards the stern of
the boat it is spirally coiled away in the tub, not like the worm-pipe of a
still though, but so as to form one round, cheese-shaped mass of densely bedded
“sheaves,” or layers of concentric spiralizations, without any hollow but the
“heart,” or minute vertical tube formed at the axis of the cheese. As the least
tangle or kink in the coiling would, in running out, infallibly take somebody's
arm, leg, or entire body off, the utmost precaution is used in stowing the line
in its tub. Some harpooneers will consume almost an entire morning in this
business, carrying the line high aloft and then reeving it downwards through a
block towards the tub, so as in the act of coiling to free it from all possible
wrinkles and twists.
In
the English boats two tubs are used instead of one; the same line being
continuously coiled in both tubs. There is some advantage in this; because
these twin-tubs being so small they fit more readily into the boat, and do not
strain it so much; whereas, the American tub, nearly three feet in diameter and
of proportionate depth, makes a rather bulky freight for a craft whose planks
are but one half-inch in thickness; for the bottom of the whale-boat is like
critical ice, which will bear up a considerable distributed weight, but not
very much of a concentrated one. When the painted canvas cover is clapped on
the American line-tub, the boat looks as if it were pulling off with a
prodigious great wedding-cake to present to the whales.
Both
ends of the line are exposed; the lower end terminating in an eye-splice or
loop coming up from the bottom against the side of the tub, and hanging over
its edge completely disengaged from everything. This arrangement of the lower
end is necessary on two accounts. First: In order to facilitate the fastening
to it of an additional line from a neighboring boat, in case the stricken whale
should sound so deep as to threaten to carry off the entire line originally
attached to the harpoon. In these instances, the whale of course is shifted
like a mug of ale, as it were, from the one boat to the other; though the first
boat always hovers at hand to assist its consort. Second: This arrangement is
indispensable for common safety's sake; for were the lower end of the line in
any way attached to the boat, and were the whale then to run the line out to
the end almost in a single, smoking minute as he sometimes does, he would not
stop there, for the doomed boat would infallibly be dragged down after him into
the profundity of the sea; and in that case no town-crier would ever find her
again.
Before
lowering the boat for the chase, the upper end of the line is taken aft from
the tub, and passing round the loggerhead there, is again carried forward the
entire length of the boat, resting crosswise upon the loom or handle of every
man's oar, so that it jogs against his wrist in rowing; and also passing
between the men, as they alternately sit at the opposite gunwales, to the
leaded chocks or grooves in the extreme pointed prow of the boat, where a
wooden pin or skewer the size of a common quill, prevents it from slipping out.
From the chocks it hangs in a slight festoon over the bows, and is then passed
inside the boat again; and some ten or twenty fathoms (called box-line) being
coiled upon the box in the bows, it continues its way to the gunwale still a
little further aft, and is then attached to the short-warp—the rope which is
immediately connected with the harpoon; but previous to that connexion, the
short-warp goes through sundry mystifications too tedious to detail.
Thus
the whale-line folds the whole boat in its complicated coils, twisting and
writhing around it in almost every direction. All the oarsmen are involved in
its perilous contortions; so that to the timid eye of the landsman, they seem
as Indian jugglers, with the deadliest snakes sportively festooning their
limbs. Nor can any son of mortal woman, for the first time, seat himself amid
those hempen intricacies, and while straining his utmost at the oar, bethink
him that at any unknown instant the harpoon may be darted, and all these
horrible contortions be put in play like ringed lightnings; he cannot be thus
circumstanced without a shudder that makes the very marrow in his bones to
quiver in him like a shaken jelly. Yet habit—strange thing! what cannot habit
accomplish?—Gayer sallies, more merry mirth, better jokes, and brighter
repartees, you never heard over your mahogany, than you will hear over the
half-inch white cedar of the whale-boat, when thus hung in hangman's nooses;
and, like the six burghers of Calais before King Edward, the six men composing
the crew pull into the jaws of death, with a halter around every neck, as you
may say.
Perhaps
a very little thought will now enable you to account for those repeated whaling
disasters—some few of which are casually chronicled—of this man or that man
being taken out of the boat by the line, and lost. For, when the line is
darting out, to be seated then in the boat, is like being seated in the midst of
the manifold whizzings of a steam-engine in full play, when every flying beam,
and shaft, and wheel, is grazing you. It is worse; for you cannot sit
motionless in the heart of these perils, because the boat is rocking like a
cradle, and you are pitched one way and the other, without the slightest
warning; and only by a certain self-adjusting buoyancy and simultaneousness of
volition and action, can you escape being made a Mazeppa of, and run away with
where the all-seeing sun himself could never pierce you out.
Again:
as the profound calm which only apparently precedes and prophesies of the
storm, is perhaps more awful than the storm itself; for, indeed, the calm is
but the wrapper and envelope of the storm; and contains it in itself, as the
seemingly harmless rifle holds the fatal powder, and the ball, and the
explosion; so the graceful repose of the line, as it silently serpentines about
the oarsmen before being brought into actual play—this is a thing which carries
more of true terror than any other aspect of this dangerous affair. But why say
more? All men live enveloped in whale-lines. All are born with halters round
their necks; but it is only when caught in the swift, sudden turn of death,
that mortals realize the silent, subtle, ever-present perils of life. And if
you be a philosopher, though seated in the whale-boat, you would not at heart
feel one whit more of terror, than though seated before your evening fire with
a poker, and not a harpoon, by your side.
CHAPTER
61. Stubb Kills a Whale.
If
to Starbuck the apparition of the Squid was a thing of portents, to Queequeg it
was quite a different object.
“When
you see him 'quid,” said the savage, honing his harpoon in the bow of his
hoisted boat, “then you quick see him 'parm whale.”
The
next day was exceedingly still and sultry, and with nothing special to engage
them, the Pequod's crew could hardly resist the spell of sleep induced by such
a vacant sea. For this part of the Indian Ocean through which we then were
voyaging is not what whalemen call a lively ground; that is, it affords fewer
glimpses of porpoises, dolphins, flying-fish, and other vivacious denizens of
more stirring waters, than those off the Rio de la Plata, or the in-shore
ground off Peru.
It
was my turn to stand at the foremast-head; and with my shoulders leaning
against the slackened royal shrouds, to and fro I idly swayed in what seemed an
enchanted air. No resolution could withstand it; in that dreamy mood losing all
consciousness, at last my soul went out of my body; though my body still
continued to sway as a pendulum will, long after the power which first moved it
is withdrawn.
Ere
forgetfulness altogether came over me, I had noticed that the seamen at the
main and mizzen-mast-heads were already drowsy. So that at last all three of us
lifelessly swung from the spars, and for every swing that we made there was a
nod from below from the slumbering helmsman. The waves, too, nodded their
indolent crests; and across the wide trance of the sea, east nodded to west,
and the sun over all.
Suddenly
bubbles seemed bursting beneath my closed eyes; like vices my hands grasped the
shrouds; some invisible, gracious agency preserved me; with a shock I came back
to life. And lo! close under our lee, not forty fathoms off, a gigantic Sperm
Whale lay rolling in the water like the capsized hull of a frigate, his broad,
glossy back, of an Ethiopian hue, glistening in the sun's rays like a mirror.
But lazily undulating in the trough of the sea, and ever and anon tranquilly
spouting his vapory jet, the whale looked like a portly burgher smoking his
pipe of a warm afternoon. But that pipe, poor whale, was thy last. As if struck
by some enchanter's wand, the sleepy ship and every sleeper in it all at once started
into wakefulness; and more than a score of voices from all parts of the vessel,
simultaneously with the three notes from aloft, shouted forth the accustomed
cry, as the great fish slowly and regularly spouted the sparkling brine into
the air.
“Clear
away the boats! Luff!” cried Ahab. And obeying his own order, he dashed the
helm down before the helmsman could handle the spokes.
The
sudden exclamations of the crew must have alarmed the whale; and ere the boats
were down, majestically turning, he swam away to the leeward, but with such a
steady tranquillity, and making so few ripples as he swam, that thinking after
all he might not as yet be alarmed, Ahab gave orders that not an oar should be
used, and no man must speak but in whispers. So seated like Ontario Indians on
the gunwales of the boats, we swiftly but silently paddled along; the calm not
admitting of the noiseless sails being set. Presently, as we thus glided in
chase, the monster perpendicularly flitted his tail forty feet into the air, and
then sank out of sight like a tower swallowed up.
“There
go flukes!” was the cry, an announcement immediately followed by Stubb's
producing his match and igniting his pipe, for now a respite was granted. After
the full interval of his sounding had elapsed, the whale rose again, and being
now in advance of the smoker's boat, and much nearer to it than to any of the
others, Stubb counted upon the honor of the capture. It was obvious, now, that
the whale had at length become aware of his pursuers. All silence of
cautiousness was therefore no longer of use. Paddles were dropped, and oars
came loudly into play. And still puffing at his pipe, Stubb cheered on his crew
to the assault.
Yes,
a mighty change had come over the fish. All alive to his jeopardy, he was going
“head out”; that part obliquely projecting from the mad yeast which he brewed.*
*It
will be seen in some other place of what a very light substance the entire
interior of the sperm whale's enormous head consists. Though apparently the
most massive, it is by far the most buoyant part about him. So that with ease
he elevates it in the air, and invariably does so when going at his utmost
speed. Besides, such is the breadth of the upper part of the front of his head,
and such the tapering cut-water formation of the lower part, that by obliquely
elevating his head, he thereby may be said to transform himself from a
bluff-bowed sluggish galliot into a sharppointed New York pilot-boat.
“Start
her, start her, my men! Don't hurry yourselves; take plenty of time—but start
her; start her like thunder-claps, that's all,” cried Stubb, spluttering out
the smoke as he spoke. “Start her, now; give 'em the long and strong stroke,
Tashtego. Start her, Tash, my boy—start her, all; but keep cool, keep
cool—cucumbers is the word—easy, easy—only start her like grim death and
grinning devils, and raise the buried dead perpendicular out of their graves,
boys—that's all. Start her!”
“Woo-hoo!
Wa-hee!” screamed the Gay-Header in reply, raising some old war-whoop to the skies;
as every oarsman in the strained boat involuntarily bounced forward with the
one tremendous leading stroke which the eager Indian gave.
But
his wild screams were answered by others quite as wild. “Kee-hee! Kee-hee!”
yelled Daggoo, straining forwards and backwards on his seat, like a pacing
tiger in his cage.
“Ka-la!
Koo-loo!” howled Queequeg, as if smacking his lips over a mouthful of
Grenadier's steak. And thus with oars and yells the keels cut the sea.
Meanwhile, Stubb retaining his place in the van, still encouraged his men to
the onset, all the while puffing the smoke from his mouth. Like desperadoes
they tugged and they strained, till the welcome cry was heard—“Stand up,
Tashtego!—give it to him!” The harpoon was hurled. “Stern all!” The oarsmen
backed water; the same moment something went hot and hissing along every one of
their wrists. It was the magical line. An instant before, Stubb had swiftly
caught two additional turns with it round the loggerhead, whence, by reason of
its increased rapid circlings, a hempen blue smoke now jetted up and mingled
with the steady fumes from his pipe. As the line passed round and round the
loggerhead; so also, just before reaching that point, it blisteringly passed
through and through both of Stubb's hands, from which the hand-cloths, or
squares of quilted canvas sometimes worn at these times, had accidentally
dropped. It was like holding an enemy's sharp two-edged sword by the blade, and
that enemy all the time striving to wrest it out of your clutch.
“Wet
the line! wet the line!” cried Stubb to the tub oarsman (him seated by the tub)
who, snatching off his hat, dashed sea-water into it.* More turns were taken,
so that the line began holding its place. The boat now flew through the boiling
water like a shark all fins. Stubb and Tashtego here changed places—stem for
stern—a staggering business truly in that rocking commotion.
*Partly
to show the indispensableness of this act, it may here be stated, that, in the
old Dutch fishery, a mop was used to dash the running line with water; in many
other ships, a wooden piggin, or bailer, is set apart for that purpose. Your
hat, however, is the most convenient.
From
the vibrating line extending the entire length of the upper part of the boat,
and from its now being more tight than a harpstring, you would have thought the
craft had two keels—one cleaving the water, the other the air—as the boat
churned on through both opposing elements at once. A continual cascade played
at the bows; a ceaseless whirling eddy in her wake; and, at the slightest
motion from within, even but of a little finger, the vibrating, cracking craft
canted over her spasmodic gunwale into the sea. Thus they rushed; each man with
might and main clinging to his seat, to prevent being tossed to the foam; and
the tall form of Tashtego at the steering oar crouching almost double, in order
to bring down his centre of gravity. Whole Atlantics and Pacifics seemed passed
as they shot on their way, till at length the whale somewhat slackened his
flight.
“Haul
in—haul in!” cried Stubb to the bowsman! and, facing round towards the whale,
all hands began pulling the boat up to him, while yet the boat was being towed
on. Soon ranging up by his flank, Stubb, firmly planting his knee in the clumsy
cleat, darted dart after dart into the flying fish; at the word of command, the
boat alternately sterning out of the way of the whale's horrible wallow, and
then ranging up for another fling.
The
red tide now poured from all sides of the monster like brooks down a hill. His
tormented body rolled not in brine but in blood, which bubbled and seethed for
furlongs behind in their wake. The slanting sun playing upon this crimson pond
in the sea, sent back its reflection into every face, so that they all glowed
to each other like red men. And all the while, jet after jet of white smoke was
agonizingly shot from the spiracle of the whale, and vehement puff after puff
from the mouth of the excited headsman; as at every dart, hauling in upon his
crooked lance (by the line attached to it), Stubb straightened it again and
again, by a few rapid blows against the gunwale, then again and again sent it
into the whale.
“Pull
up—pull up!” he now cried to the bowsman, as the waning whale relaxed in his
wrath. “Pull up!—close to!” and the boat ranged along the fish's flank. When
reaching far over the bow, Stubb slowly churned his long sharp lance into the
fish, and kept it there, carefully churning and churning, as if cautiously
seeking to feel after some gold watch that the whale might have swallowed, and
which he was fearful of breaking ere he could hook it out. But that gold watch
he sought was the innermost life of the fish. And now it is struck; for,
starting from his trance into that unspeakable thing called his “flurry,” the
monster horribly wallowed in his blood, overwrapped himself in impenetrable,
mad, boiling spray, so that the imperilled craft, instantly dropping astern,
had much ado blindly to struggle out from that phrensied twilight into the
clear air of the day.
And
now abating in his flurry, the whale once more rolled out into view; surging
from side to side; spasmodically dilating and contracting his spout-hole, with
sharp, cracking, agonized respirations. At last, gush after gush of clotted red
gore, as if it had been the purple lees of red wine, shot into the frighted
air; and falling back again, ran dripping down his motionless flanks into the
sea. His heart had burst!
“He's
dead, Mr. Stubb,” said Daggoo.
“Yes;
both pipes smoked out!” and withdrawing his own from his mouth, Stubb scattered
the dead ashes over the water; and, for a moment, stood thoughtfully eyeing the
vast corpse he had made.
CHAPTER
62. The Dart.
A
word concerning an incident in the last chapter.
According
to the invariable usage of the fishery, the whale-boat pushes off from the
ship, with the headsman or whale-killer as temporary steersman, and the
harpooneer or whale-fastener pulling the foremost oar, the one known as the
harpooneer-oar. Now it needs a strong, nervous arm to strike the first iron
into the fish; for often, in what is called a long dart, the heavy implement
has to be flung to the distance of twenty or thirty feet. But however prolonged
and exhausting the chase, the harpooneer is expected to pull his oar meanwhile
to the uttermost; indeed, he is expected to set an example of superhuman
activity to the rest, not only by incredible rowing, but by repeated loud and
intrepid exclamations; and what it is to keep shouting at the top of one's
compass, while all the other muscles are strained and half started—what that is
none know but those who have tried it. For one, I cannot bawl very heartily and
work very recklessly at one and the same time. In this straining, bawling
state, then, with his back to the fish, all at once the exhausted harpooneer
hears the exciting cry—“Stand up, and give it to him!” He now has to drop and
secure his oar, turn round on his centre half way, seize his harpoon from the
crotch, and with what little strength may remain, he essays to pitch it somehow
into the whale. No wonder, taking the whole fleet of whalemen in a body, that
out of fifty fair chances for a dart, not five are successful; no wonder that
so many hapless harpooneers are madly cursed and disrated; no wonder that some
of them actually burst their blood-vessels in the boat; no wonder that some
sperm whalemen are absent four years with four barrels; no wonder that to many
ship owners, whaling is but a losing concern; for it is the harpooneer that
makes the voyage, and if you take the breath out of his body how can you expect
to find it there when most wanted!
Again,
if the dart be successful, then at the second critical instant, that is, when
the whale starts to run, the boatheader and harpooneer likewise start to
running fore and aft, to the imminent jeopardy of themselves and every one
else. It is then they change places; and the headsman, the chief officer of the
little craft, takes his proper station in the bows of the boat.
Now,
I care not who maintains the contrary, but all this is both foolish and
unnecessary. The headsman should stay in the bows from first to last; he should
both dart the harpoon and the lance, and no rowing whatever should be expected
of him, except under circumstances obvious to any fisherman. I know that this
would sometimes involve a slight loss of speed in the chase; but long
experience in various whalemen of more than one nation has convinced me that in
the vast majority of failures in the fishery, it has not by any means been so
much the speed of the whale as the before described exhaustion of the
harpooneer that has caused them.
To
insure the greatest efficiency in the dart, the harpooneers of this world must
start to their feet from out of idleness, and not from out of toil.
CHAPTER
63. The Crotch.
Out
of the trunk, the branches grow; out of them, the twigs. So, in productive
subjects, grow the chapters.
The
crotch alluded to on a previous page deserves independent mention. It is a
notched stick of a peculiar form, some two feet in length, which is
perpendicularly inserted into the starboard gunwale near the bow, for the
purpose of furnishing a rest for the wooden extremity of the harpoon, whose
other naked, barbed end slopingly projects from the prow. Thereby the weapon is
instantly at hand to its hurler, who snatches it up as readily from its rest as
a backwoodsman swings his rifle from the wall. It is customary to have two
harpoons reposing in the crotch, respectively called the first and second
irons.
But
these two harpoons, each by its own cord, are both connected with the line; the
object being this: to dart them both, if possible, one instantly after the
other into the same whale; so that if, in the coming drag, one should draw out,
the other may still retain a hold. It is a doubling of the chances. But it very
often happens that owing to the instantaneous, violent, convulsive running of
the whale upon receiving the first iron, it becomes impossible for the
harpooneer, however lightning-like in his movements, to pitch the second iron
into him. Nevertheless, as the second iron is already connected with the line, and
the line is running, hence that weapon must, at all events, be anticipatingly
tossed out of the boat, somehow and somewhere; else the most terrible jeopardy
would involve all hands. Tumbled into the water, it accordingly is in such
cases; the spare coils of box line (mentioned in a preceding chapter) making
this feat, in most instances, prudently practicable. But this critical act is
not always unattended with the saddest and most fatal casualties.
Furthermore:
you must know that when the second iron is thrown overboard, it thenceforth
becomes a dangling, sharp-edged terror, skittishly curvetting about both boat
and whale, entangling the lines, or cutting them, and making a prodigious
sensation in all directions. Nor, in general, is it possible to secure it again
until the whale is fairly captured and a corpse.
Consider,
now, how it must be in the case of four boats all engaging one unusually
strong, active, and knowing whale; when owing to these qualities in him, as
well as to the thousand concurring accidents of such an audacious enterprise,
eight or ten loose second irons may be simultaneously dangling about him. For,
of course, each boat is supplied with several harpoons to bend on to the line
should the first one be ineffectually darted without recovery. All these
particulars are faithfully narrated here, as they will not fail to elucidate
several most important, however intricate passages, in scenes hereafter to be
painted.
CHAPTER
64. Stubb's Supper.
Stubb's
whale had been killed some distance from the ship. It was a calm; so, forming a
tandem of three boats, we commenced the slow business of towing the trophy to
the Pequod. And now, as we eighteen men with our thirty-six arms, and one
hundred and eighty thumbs and fingers, slowly toiled hour after hour upon that
inert, sluggish corpse in the sea; and it seemed hardly to budge at all, except
at long intervals; good evidence was hereby furnished of the enormousness of
the mass we moved. For, upon the great canal of Hang-Ho, or whatever they call
it, in China, four or five laborers on the foot-path will draw a bulky
freighted junk at the rate of a mile an hour; but this grand argosy we towed
heavily forged along, as if laden with pig-lead in bulk.
Darkness
came on; but three lights up and down in the Pequod's main-rigging dimly guided
our way; till drawing nearer we saw Ahab dropping one of several more lanterns
over the bulwarks. Vacantly eyeing the heaving whale for a moment, he issued
the usual orders for securing it for the night, and then handing his lantern to
a seaman, went his way into the cabin, and did not come forward again until
morning.
Though,
in overseeing the pursuit of this whale, Captain Ahab had evinced his customary
activity, to call it so; yet now that the creature was dead, some vague
dissatisfaction, or impatience, or despair, seemed working in him; as if the
sight of that dead body reminded him that Moby Dick was yet to be slain; and
though a thousand other whales were brought to his ship, all that would not one
jot advance his grand, monomaniac object. Very soon you would have thought from
the sound on the Pequod's decks, that all hands were preparing to cast anchor
in the deep; for heavy chains are being dragged along the deck, and thrust
rattling out of the port-holes. But by those clanking links, the vast corpse
itself, not the ship, is to be moored. Tied by the head to the stern, and by
the tail to the bows, the whale now lies with its black hull close to the
vessel's and seen through the darkness of the night, which obscured the spars
and rigging aloft, the two—ship and whale, seemed yoked together like colossal
bullocks, whereof one reclines while the other remains standing.*
*A
little item may as well be related here. The strongest and most reliable hold
which the ship has upon the whale when moored alongside, is by the flukes or
tail; and as from its greater density that part is relatively heavier than any
other (excepting the side-fins), its flexibility even in death, causes it to
sink low beneath the surface; so that with the hand you cannot get at it from
the boat, in order to put the chain round it. But this difficulty is
ingeniously overcome: a small, strong line is prepared with a wooden float at
its outer end, and a weight in its middle, while the other end is secured to
the ship. By adroit management the wooden float is made to rise on the other
side of the mass, so that now having girdled the whale, the chain is readily
made to follow suit; and being slipped along the body, is at last locked fast
round the smallest part of the tail, at the point of junction with its broad
flukes or lobes.
If
moody Ahab was now all quiescence, at least so far as could be known on deck,
Stubb, his second mate, flushed with conquest, betrayed an unusual but still
good-natured excitement. Such an unwonted bustle was he in that the staid
Starbuck, his official superior, quietly resigned to him for the time the sole
management of affairs. One small, helping cause of all this liveliness in
Stubb, was soon made strangely manifest. Stubb was a high liver; he was
somewhat intemperately fond of the whale as a flavorish thing to his palate.
“A
steak, a steak, ere I sleep! You, Daggoo! overboard you go, and cut me one from
his small!”
Here
be it known, that though these wild fishermen do not, as a general thing, and
according to the great military maxim, make the enemy defray the current expenses
of the war (at least before realizing the proceeds of the voyage), yet now and
then you find some of these Nantucketers who have a genuine relish for that
particular part of the Sperm Whale designated by Stubb; comprising the tapering
extremity of the body.
About
midnight that steak was cut and cooked; and lighted by two lanterns of sperm
oil, Stubb stoutly stood up to his spermaceti supper at the capstan-head, as if
that capstan were a sideboard. Nor was Stubb the only banqueter on whale's
flesh that night. Mingling their mumblings with his own mastications, thousands
on thousands of sharks, swarming round the dead leviathan, smackingly feasted
on its fatness. The few sleepers below in their bunks were often startled by
the sharp slapping of their tails against the hull, within a few inches of the
sleepers' hearts. Peering over the side you could just see them (as before you
heard them) wallowing in the sullen, black waters, and turning over on their
backs as they scooped out huge globular pieces of the whale of the bigness of a
human head. This particular feat of the shark seems all but miraculous. How at
such an apparently unassailable surface, they contrive to gouge out such
symmetrical mouthfuls, remains a part of the universal problem of all things.
The mark they thus leave on the whale, may best be likened to the hollow made
by a carpenter in countersinking for a screw.
Though
amid all the smoking horror and diabolism of a sea-fight, sharks will be seen
longingly gazing up to the ship's decks, like hungry dogs round a table where
red meat is being carved, ready to bolt down every killed man that is tossed to
them; and though, while the valiant butchers over the deck-table are thus
cannibally carving each other's live meat with carving-knives all gilded and
tasselled, the sharks, also, with their jewel-hilted mouths, are quarrelsomely
carving away under the table at the dead meat; and though, were you to turn the
whole affair upside down, it would still be pretty much the same thing, that is
to say, a shocking sharkish business enough for all parties; and though sharks
also are the invariable outriders of all slave ships crossing the Atlantic,
systematically trotting alongside, to be handy in case a parcel is to be
carried anywhere, or a dead slave to be decently buried; and though one or two
other like instances might be set down, touching the set terms, places, and
occasions, when sharks do most socially congregate, and most hilariously feast;
yet is there no conceivable time or occasion when you will find them in such
countless numbers, and in gayer or more jovial spirits, than around a dead
sperm whale, moored by night to a whaleship at sea. If you have never seen that
sight, then suspend your decision about the propriety of devil-worship, and the
expediency of conciliating the devil.
But,
as yet, Stubb heeded not the mumblings of the banquet that was going on so nigh
him, no more than the sharks heeded the smacking of his own epicurean lips.
“Cook,
cook!—where's that old Fleece?” he cried at length, widening his legs still
further, as if to form a more secure base for his supper; and, at the same time
darting his fork into the dish, as if stabbing with his lance; “cook, you
cook!—sail this way, cook!”
The
old black, not in any very high glee at having been previously roused from his
warm hammock at a most unseasonable hour, came shambling along from his galley,
for, like many old blacks, there was something the matter with his knee-pans,
which he did not keep well scoured like his other pans; this old Fleece, as
they called him, came shuffling and limping along, assisting his step with his
tongs, which, after a clumsy fashion, were made of straightened iron hoops;
this old Ebony floundered along, and in obedience to the word of command, came
to a dead stop on the opposite side of Stubb's sideboard; when, with both hands
folded before him, and resting on his two-legged cane, he bowed his arched back
still further over, at the same time sideways inclining his head, so as to
bring his best ear into play.
“Cook,”
said Stubb, rapidly lifting a rather reddish morsel to his mouth, “don't you
think this steak is rather overdone? You've been beating this steak too much,
cook; it's too tender. Don't I always say that to be good, a whale-steak must
be tough? There are those sharks now over the side, don't you see they prefer
it tough and rare? What a shindy they are kicking up! Cook, go and talk to 'em;
tell 'em they are welcome to help themselves civilly, and in moderation, but
they must keep quiet. Blast me, if I can hear my own voice. Away, cook, and
deliver my message. Here, take this lantern,” snatching one from his sideboard;
“now then, go and preach to 'em!”
Sullenly
taking the offered lantern, old Fleece limped across the deck to the bulwarks;
and then, with one hand dropping his light low over the sea, so as to get a
good view of his congregation, with the other hand he solemnly flourished his
tongs, and leaning far over the side in a mumbling voice began addressing the
sharks, while Stubb, softly crawling behind, overheard all that was said.
“Fellow-critters:
I'se ordered here to say dat you must stop dat dam noise dare. You hear? Stop
dat dam smackin' ob de lip! Massa Stubb say dat you can fill your dam bellies
up to de hatchings, but by Gor! you must stop dat dam racket!”
“Cook,”
here interposed Stubb, accompanying the word with a sudden slap on the
shoulder,—“Cook! why, damn your eyes, you mustn't swear that way when you're
preaching. That's no way to convert sinners, cook!”
“Who
dat? Den preach to him yourself,” sullenly turning to go.
“No,
cook; go on, go on.”
“Well,
den, Belubed fellow-critters:”—
“Right!”
exclaimed Stubb, approvingly, “coax 'em to it; try that,” and Fleece continued.
“Do
you is all sharks, and by natur wery woracious, yet I zay to you,
fellow-critters, dat dat woraciousness—'top dat dam slappin' ob de tail! How
you tink to hear, 'spose you keep up such a dam slappin' and bitin' dare?”
“Cook,”
cried Stubb, collaring him, “I won't have that swearing. Talk to 'em
gentlemanly.”
Once
more the sermon proceeded.
“Your
woraciousness, fellow-critters, I don't blame ye so much for; dat is natur, and
can't be helped; but to gobern dat wicked natur, dat is de pint. You is sharks,
sartin; but if you gobern de shark in you, why den you be angel; for all angel
is not'ing more dan de shark well goberned. Now, look here, bred'ren, just try
wonst to be cibil, a helping yourselbs from dat whale. Don't be tearin' de
blubber out your neighbour's mout, I say. Is not one shark dood right as toder
to dat whale? And, by Gor, none on you has de right to dat whale; dat whale
belong to some one else. I know some o' you has berry brig mout, brigger dan
oders; but den de brig mouts sometimes has de small bellies; so dat de brigness
of de mout is not to swaller wid, but to bit off de blubber for de small fry ob
sharks, dat can't get into de scrouge to help demselves.”
“Well
done, old Fleece!” cried Stubb, “that's Christianity; go on.”
“No
use goin' on; de dam willains will keep a scougin' and slappin' each oder,
Massa Stubb; dey don't hear one word; no use a-preachin' to such dam g'uttons
as you call 'em, till dare bellies is full, and dare bellies is bottomless; and
when dey do get 'em full, dey wont hear you den; for den dey sink in de sea, go
fast to sleep on de coral, and can't hear not'ing at all, no more, for eber and
eber.”
“Upon
my soul, I am about of the same opinion; so give the benediction, Fleece, and
I'll away to my supper.”
Upon
this, Fleece, holding both hands over the fishy mob, raised his shrill voice,
and cried—
“Cussed
fellow-critters! Kick up de damndest row as ever you can; fill your dam'
bellies 'till dey bust—and den die.”
“Now,
cook,” said Stubb, resuming his supper at the capstan; “stand just where you
stood before, there, over against me, and pay particular attention.”
“All
dention,” said Fleece, again stooping over upon his tongs in the desired
position.
“Well,”
said Stubb, helping himself freely meanwhile; “I shall now go back to the
subject of this steak. In the first place, how old are you, cook?”
“What
dat do wid de 'teak,” said the old black, testily.
“Silence!
How old are you, cook?”
“'Bout
ninety, dey say,” he gloomily muttered.
“And
you have lived in this world hard upon one hundred years, cook, and don't know
yet how to cook a whale-steak?” rapidly bolting another mouthful at the last
word, so that morsel seemed a continuation of the question. “Where were you
born, cook?”
“'Hind
de hatchway, in ferry-boat, goin' ober de Roanoke.”
“Born
in a ferry-boat! That's queer, too. But I want to know what country you were
born in, cook!”
“Didn't
I say de Roanoke country?” he cried sharply.
“No,
you didn't, cook; but I'll tell you what I'm coming to, cook. You must go home
and be born over again; you don't know how to cook a whale-steak yet.”
“Bress
my soul, if I cook noder one,” he growled, angrily, turning round to depart.
“Come
back, cook;—here, hand me those tongs;—now take that bit of steak there, and
tell me if you think that steak cooked as it should be? Take it, I say”—holding
the tongs towards him—“take it, and taste it.”
Faintly
smacking his withered lips over it for a moment, the old negro muttered, “Best
cooked 'teak I eber taste; joosy, berry joosy.”
“Cook,”
said Stubb, squaring himself once more; “do you belong to the church?”
“Passed
one once in Cape-Down,” said the old man sullenly.
“And
you have once in your life passed a holy church in Cape-Town, where you
doubtless overheard a holy parson addressing his hearers as his beloved
fellow-creatures, have you, cook! And yet you come here, and tell me such a
dreadful lie as you did just now, eh?” said Stubb. “Where do you expect to go
to, cook?”
“Go
to bed berry soon,” he mumbled, half-turning as he spoke.
“Avast!
heave to! I mean when you die, cook. It's an awful question. Now what's your
answer?”
“When
dis old brack man dies,” said the negro slowly, changing his whole air and
demeanor, “he hisself won't go nowhere; but some bressed angel will come and
fetch him.”
“Fetch
him? How? In a coach and four, as they fetched Elijah? And fetch him where?”
“Up
dere,” said Fleece, holding his tongs straight over his head, and keeping it
there very solemnly.
“So,
then, you expect to go up into our main-top, do you, cook, when you are dead?
But don't you know the higher you climb, the colder it gets? Main-top, eh?”
“Didn't
say dat t'all,” said Fleece, again in the sulks.
“You
said up there, didn't you? and now look yourself, and see where your tongs are
pointing. But, perhaps you expect to get into heaven by crawling through the
lubber's hole, cook; but, no, no, cook, you don't get there, except you go the
regular way, round by the rigging. It's a ticklish business, but must be done,
or else it's no go. But none of us are in heaven yet. Drop your tongs, cook,
and hear my orders. Do ye hear? Hold your hat in one hand, and clap t'other
a'top of your heart, when I'm giving my orders, cook. What! that your heart,
there?—that's your gizzard! Aloft! aloft!—that's it—now you have it. Hold it
there now, and pay attention.”
“All
'dention,” said the old black, with both hands placed as desired, vainly
wriggling his grizzled head, as if to get both ears in front at one and the
same time.
“Well
then, cook, you see this whale-steak of yours was so very bad, that I have put
it out of sight as soon as possible; you see that, don't you? Well, for the future,
when you cook another whale-steak for my private table here, the capstan, I'll
tell you what to do so as not to spoil it by overdoing. Hold the steak in one
hand, and show a live coal to it with the other; that done, dish it; d'ye hear?
And now to-morrow, cook, when we are cutting in the fish, be sure you stand by
to get the tips of his fins; have them put in pickle. As for the ends of the
flukes, have them soused, cook. There, now ye may go.”
But
Fleece had hardly got three paces off, when he was recalled.
“Cook,
give me cutlets for supper to-morrow night in the mid-watch. D'ye hear? away
you sail, then.—Halloa! stop! make a bow before you go.—Avast heaving again!
Whale-balls for breakfast—don't forget.”
“Wish,
by gor! whale eat him, 'stead of him eat whale. I'm bressed if he ain't more of
shark dan Massa Shark hisself,” muttered the old man, limping away; with which
sage ejaculation he went to his hammock.
CHAPTER
65. The Whale as a Dish.
That
mortal man should feed upon the creature that feeds his lamp, and, like Stubb,
eat him by his own light, as you may say; this seems so outlandish a thing that
one must needs go a little into the history and philosophy of it.
It
is upon record, that three centuries ago the tongue of the Right Whale was
esteemed a great delicacy in France, and commanded large prices there. Also,
that in Henry VIIIth's time, a certain cook of the court obtained a handsome
reward for inventing an admirable sauce to be eaten with barbacued porpoises,
which, you remember, are a species of whale. Porpoises, indeed, are to this day
considered fine eating. The meat is made into balls about the size of billiard
balls, and being well seasoned and spiced might be taken for turtle-balls or
veal balls. The old monks of Dunfermline were very fond of them. They had a
great porpoise grant from the crown.
The
fact is, that among his hunters at least, the whale would by all hands be
considered a noble dish, were there not so much of him; but when you come to
sit down before a meat-pie nearly one hundred feet long, it takes away your
appetite. Only the most unprejudiced of men like Stubb, nowadays partake of
cooked whales; but the Esquimaux are not so fastidious. We all know how they
live upon whales, and have rare old vintages of prime old train oil. Zogranda,
one of their most famous doctors, recommends strips of blubber for infants, as
being exceedingly juicy and nourishing. And this reminds me that certain
Englishmen, who long ago were accidentally left in Greenland by a whaling
vessel—that these men actually lived for several months on the mouldy scraps of
whales which had been left ashore after trying out the blubber. Among the Dutch
whalemen these scraps are called “fritters”; which, indeed, they greatly
resemble, being brown and crisp, and smelling something like old Amsterdam
housewives' dough-nuts or oly-cooks, when fresh. They have such an eatable look
that the most self-denying stranger can hardly keep his hands off.
But
what further depreciates the whale as a civilized dish, is his exceeding
richness. He is the great prize ox of the sea, too fat to be delicately good.
Look at his hump, which would be as fine eating as the buffalo's (which is
esteemed a rare dish), were it not such a solid pyramid of fat. But the
spermaceti itself, how bland and creamy that is; like the transparent,
half-jellied, white meat of a cocoanut in the third month of its growth, yet
far too rich to supply a substitute for butter. Nevertheless, many whalemen
have a method of absorbing it into some other substance, and then partaking of
it. In the long try watches of the night it is a common thing for the seamen to
dip their ship-biscuit into the huge oil-pots and let them fry there awhile.
Many a good supper have I thus made.
In
the case of a small Sperm Whale the brains are accounted a fine dish. The
casket of the skull is broken into with an axe, and the two plump, whitish
lobes being withdrawn (precisely resembling two large puddings), they are then
mixed with flour, and cooked into a most delectable mess, in flavor somewhat
resembling calves' head, which is quite a dish among some epicures; and every
one knows that some young bucks among the epicures, by continually dining upon
calves' brains, by and by get to have a little brains of their own, so as to be
able to tell a calf's head from their own heads; which, indeed, requires
uncommon discrimination. And that is the reason why a young buck with an
intelligent looking calf's head before him, is somehow one of the saddest
sights you can see. The head looks a sort of reproachfully at him, with an “Et
tu Brute!” expression.
It
is not, perhaps, entirely because the whale is so excessively unctuous that
landsmen seem to regard the eating of him with abhorrence; that appears to
result, in some way, from the consideration before mentioned:i.e. that a man
should eat a newly murdered thing of the sea, and eat it too by its own light.
But no doubt the first man that ever murdered an ox was regarded as a murderer;
perhaps he was hung; and if he had been put on his trial by oxen, he certainly
would have been; and he certainly deserved it if any murderer does. Go to the
meat-market of a Saturday night and see the crowds of live bipeds staring up at
the long rows of dead quadrupeds. Does not that sight take a tooth out of the
cannibal's jaw? Cannibals? who is not a cannibal? I tell you it will be more
tolerable for the Fejee that salted down a lean missionary in his cellar
against a coming famine; it will be more tolerable for that provident Fejee, I
say, in the day of judgment, than for thee, civilized and enlightened gourmand,
who nailest geese to the ground and feastest on their bloated livers in thy
paté-de-foie-gras.
But
Stubb, he eats the whale by its own light, does he? and that is adding insult
to injury, is it? Look at your knife-handle, there, my civilized and
enlightened gourmand dining off that roast beef, what is that handle made
of?—what but the bones of the brother of the very ox you are eating? And what do
you pick your teeth with, after devouring that fat goose? With a feather of the
same fowl. And with what quill did the Secretary of the Society for the
Suppression of Cruelty to Ganders formally indite his circulars? It is only
within the last month or two that that society passed a resolution to patronize
nothing but steel pens.
CHAPTER
66. The Shark Massacre.
When
in the Southern Fishery, a captured Sperm Whale, after long and weary toil, is
brought alongside late at night, it is not, as a general thing at least,
customary to proceed at once to the business of cutting him in. For that
business is an exceedingly laborious one; is not very soon completed; and
requires all hands to set about it. Therefore, the common usage is to take in
all sail; lash the helm a'lee; and then send every one below to his hammock
till daylight, with the reservation that, until that time, anchor-watches shall
be kept; that is, two and two for an hour, each couple, the crew in rotation
shall mount the deck to see that all goes well.
But
sometimes, especially upon the Line in the Pacific, this plan will not answer
at all; because such incalculable hosts of sharks gather round the moored
carcase, that were he left so for six hours, say, on a stretch, little more
than the skeleton would be visible by morning. In most other parts of the
ocean, however, where these fish do not so largely abound, their wondrous
voracity can be at times considerably diminished, by vigorously stirring them
up with sharp whaling-spades, a procedure notwithstanding, which, in some
instances, only seems to tickle them into still greater activity. But it was
not thus in the present case with the Pequod's sharks; though, to be sure, any
man unaccustomed to such sights, to have looked over her side that night, would
have almost thought the whole round sea was one huge cheese, and those sharks
the maggots in it.
Nevertheless,
upon Stubb setting the anchor-watch after his supper was concluded; and when,
accordingly, Queequeg and a forecastle seaman came on deck, no small excitement
was created among the sharks; for immediately suspending the cutting stages
over the side, and lowering three lanterns, so that they cast long gleams of
light over the turbid sea, these two mariners, darting their long
whaling-spades, kept up an incessant murdering of the sharks,* by striking the
keen steel deep into their skulls, seemingly their only vital part. But in the
foamy confusion of their mixed and struggling hosts, the marksmen could not
always hit their mark; and this brought about new revelations of the incredible
ferocity of the foe. They viciously snapped, not only at each other's
disembowelments, but like flexible bows, bent round, and bit their own; till
those entrails seemed swallowed over and over again by the same mouth, to be
oppositely voided by the gaping wound. Nor was this all. It was unsafe to
meddle with the corpses and ghosts of these creatures. A sort of generic or
Pantheistic vitality seemed to lurk in their very joints and bones, after what
might be called the individual life had departed. Killed and hoisted on deck
for the sake of his skin, one of these sharks almost took poor Queequeg's hand
off, when he tried to shut down the dead lid of his murderous jaw.
*The
whaling-spade used for cutting-in is made of the very best steel; is about the
bigness of a man's spread hand; and in general shape, corresponds to the garden
implement after which it is named; only its sides are perfectly flat, and its
upper end considerably narrower than the lower. This weapon is always kept as
sharp as possible; and when being used is occasionally honed, just like a
razor. In its socket, a stiff pole, from twenty to thirty feet long, is
inserted for a handle.
“Queequeg
no care what god made him shark,” said the savage, agonizingly lifting his hand
up and down; “wedder Fejee god or Nantucket god; but de god wat made shark must
be one dam Ingin.”
CHAPTER
67. Cutting In.
It
was a Saturday night, and such a Sabbath as followed! Ex officio professors of
Sabbath breaking are all whalemen. The ivory Pequod was turned into what seemed
a shamble; every sailor a butcher. You would have thought we were offering up
ten thousand red oxen to the sea gods.
In
the first place, the enormous cutting tackles, among other ponderous things
comprising a cluster of blocks generally painted green, and which no single man
can possibly lift—this vast bunch of grapes was swayed up to the main-top and
firmly lashed to the lower mast-head, the strongest point anywhere above a
ship's deck. The end of the hawser-like rope winding through these intricacies,
was then conducted to the windlass, and the huge lower block of the tackles was
swung over the whale; to this block the great blubber hook, weighing some one
hundred pounds, was attached. And now suspended in stages over the side,
Starbuck and Stubb, the mates, armed with their long spades, began cutting a
hole in the body for the insertion of the hook just above the nearest of the
two side-fins. This done, a broad, semicircular line is cut round the hole, the
hook is inserted, and the main body of the crew striking up a wild chorus, now
commence heaving in one dense crowd at the windlass. When instantly, the entire
ship careens over on her side; every bolt in her starts like the nail-heads of
an old house in frosty weather; she trembles, quivers, and nods her frighted
mast-heads to the sky. More and more she leans over to the whale, while every
gasping heave of the windlass is answered by a helping heave from the billows;
till at last, a swift, startling snap is heard; with a great swash the ship
rolls upwards and backwards from the whale, and the triumphant tackle rises
into sight dragging after it the disengaged semicircular end of the first strip
of blubber. Now as the blubber envelopes the whale precisely as the rind does
an orange, so is it stripped off from the body precisely as an orange is sometimes
stripped by spiralizing it. For the strain constantly kept up by the windlass
continually keeps the whale rolling over and over in the water, and as the
blubber in one strip uniformly peels off along the line called the “scarf,”
simultaneously cut by the spades of Starbuck and Stubb, the mates; and just as
fast as it is thus peeled off, and indeed by that very act itself, it is all
the time being hoisted higher and higher aloft till its upper end grazes the
main-top; the men at the windlass then cease heaving, and for a moment or two
the prodigious blood-dripping mass sways to and fro as if let down from the
sky, and every one present must take good heed to dodge it when it swings, else
it may box his ears and pitch him headlong overboard.
One
of the attending harpooneers now advances with a long, keen weapon called a
boarding-sword, and watching his chance he dexterously slices out a
considerable hole in the lower part of the swaying mass. Into this hole, the
end of the second alternating great tackle is then hooked so as to retain a
hold upon the blubber, in order to prepare for what follows. Whereupon, this
accomplished swordsman, warning all hands to stand off, once more makes a
scientific dash at the mass, and with a few sidelong, desperate, lunging slicings,
severs it completely in twain; so that while the short lower part is still
fast, the long upper strip, called a blanket-piece, swings clear, and is all
ready for lowering. The heavers forward now resume their song, and while the
one tackle is peeling and hoisting a second strip from the whale, the other is
slowly slackened away, and down goes the first strip through the main hatchway
right beneath, into an unfurnished parlor called the blubber-room. Into this
twilight apartment sundry nimble hands keep coiling away the long blanket-piece
as if it were a great live mass of plaited serpents. And thus the work
proceeds; the two tackles hoisting and lowering simultaneously; both whale and
windlass heaving, the heavers singing, the blubber-room gentlemen coiling, the
mates scarfing, the ship straining, and all hands swearing occasionally, by way
of assuaging the general friction.
CHAPTER
68. The Blanket.
I
have given no small attention to that not unvexed subject, the skin of the
whale. I have had controversies about it with experienced whalemen afloat, and
learned naturalists ashore. My original opinion remains unchanged; but it is
only an opinion.
The
question is, what and where is the skin of the whale? Already you know what his
blubber is. That blubber is something of the consistence of firm, close-grained
beef, but tougher, more elastic and compact, and ranges from eight or ten to
twelve and fifteen inches in thickness.
Now,
however preposterous it may at first seem to talk of any creature's skin as
being of that sort of consistence and thickness, yet in point of fact these are
no arguments against such a presumption; because you cannot raise any other
dense enveloping layer from the whale's body but that same blubber; and the
outermost enveloping layer of any animal, if reasonably dense, what can that be
but the skin? True, from the unmarred dead body of the whale, you may scrape
off with your hand an infinitely thin, transparent substance, somewhat
resembling the thinnest shreds of isinglass, only it is almost as flexible and
soft as satin; that is, previous to being dried, when it not only contracts and
thickens, but becomes rather hard and brittle. I have several such dried bits,
which I use for marks in my whale-books. It is transparent, as I said before;
and being laid upon the printed page, I have sometimes pleased myself with
fancying it exerted a magnifying influence. At any rate, it is pleasant to read
about whales through their own spectacles, as you may say. But what I am
driving at here is this. That same infinitely thin, isinglass substance, which,
I admit, invests the entire body of the whale, is not so much to be regarded as
the skin of the creature, as the skin of the skin, so to speak; for it were
simply ridiculous to say, that the proper skin of the tremendous whale is
thinner and more tender than the skin of a new-born child. But no more of this.
Assuming
the blubber to be the skin of the whale; then, when this skin, as in the case
of a very large Sperm Whale, will yield the bulk of one hundred barrels of oil;
and, when it is considered that, in quantity, or rather weight, that oil, in
its expressed state, is only three fourths, and not the entire substance of the
coat; some idea may hence be had of the enormousness of that animated mass, a
mere part of whose mere integument yields such a lake of liquid as that.
Reckoning ten barrels to the ton, you have ten tons for the net weight of only
three quarters of the stuff of the whale's skin.
In
life, the visible surface of the Sperm Whale is not the least among the many
marvels he presents. Almost invariably it is all over obliquely crossed and
re-crossed with numberless straight marks in thick array, something like those
in the finest Italian line engravings. But these marks do not seem to be
impressed upon the isinglass substance above mentioned, but seem to be seen
through it, as if they were engraved upon the body itself. Nor is this all. In
some instances, to the quick, observant eye, those linear marks, as in a
veritable engraving, but afford the ground for far other delineations. These
are hieroglyphical; that is, if you call those mysterious cyphers on the walls
of pyramids hieroglyphics, then that is the proper word to use in the present
connexion. By my retentive memory of the hieroglyphics upon one Sperm Whale in
particular, I was much struck with a plate representing the old Indian
characters chiselled on the famous hieroglyphic palisades on the banks of the
Upper Mississippi. Like those mystic rocks, too, the mystic-marked whale
remains undecipherable. This allusion to the Indian rocks reminds me of another
thing. Besides all the other phenomena which the exterior of the Sperm Whale
presents, he not seldom displays the back, and more especially his flanks,
effaced in great part of the regular linear appearance, by reason of numerous
rude scratches, altogether of an irregular, random aspect. I should say that
those New England rocks on the sea-coast, which Agassiz imagines to bear the
marks of violent scraping contact with vast floating icebergs—I should say,
that those rocks must not a little resemble the Sperm Whale in this particular.
It also seems to me that such scratches in the whale are probably made by
hostile contact with other whales; for I have most remarked them in the large,
full-grown bulls of the species.
A
word or two more concerning this matter of the skin or blubber of the whale. It
has already been said, that it is stript from him in long pieces, called
blanket-pieces. Like most sea-terms, this one is very happy and significant.
For the whale is indeed wrapt up in his blubber as in a real blanket or
counterpane; or, still better, an Indian poncho slipt over his head, and
skirting his extremity. It is by reason of this cosy blanketing of his body,
that the whale is enabled to keep himself comfortable in all weathers, in all
seas, times, and tides. What would become of a Greenland whale, say, in those
shuddering, icy seas of the North, if unsupplied with his cosy surtout? True,
other fish are found exceedingly brisk in those Hyperborean waters; but these,
be it observed, are your cold-blooded, lungless fish, whose very bellies are
refrigerators; creatures, that warm themselves under the lee of an iceberg, as
a traveller in winter would bask before an inn fire; whereas, like man, the
whale has lungs and warm blood. Freeze his blood, and he dies. How wonderful is
it then—except after explanation—that this great monster, to whom corporeal
warmth is as indispensable as it is to man; how wonderful that he should be
found at home, immersed to his lips for life in those Arctic waters! where,
when seamen fall overboard, they are sometimes found, months afterwards,
perpendicularly frozen into the hearts of fields of ice, as a fly is found
glued in amber. But more surprising is it to know, as has been proved by
experiment, that the blood of a Polar whale is warmer than that of a Borneo
negro in summer.
It
does seem to me, that herein we see the rare virtue of a strong individual
vitality, and the rare virtue of thick walls, and the rare virtue of interior
spaciousness. Oh, man! admire and model thyself after the whale! Do thou, too,
remain warm among ice. Do thou, too, live in this world without being of it. Be
cool at the equator; keep thy blood fluid at the Pole. Like the great dome of
St. Peter's, and like the great whale, retain, O man! in all seasons a
temperature of thine own.
But
how easy and how hopeless to teach these fine things! Of erections, how few are
domed like St. Peter's! of creatures, how few vast as the whale!
CHAPTER
69. The Funeral.
“Haul
in the chains! Let the carcase go astern!”
The
vast tackles have now done their duty. The peeled white body of the beheaded
whale flashes like a marble sepulchre; though changed in hue, it has not
perceptibly lost anything in bulk. It is still colossal. Slowly it floats more
and more away, the water round it torn and splashed by the insatiate sharks,
and the air above vexed with rapacious flights of screaming fowls, whose beaks
are like so many insulting poniards in the whale. The vast white headless
phantom floats further and further from the ship, and every rod that it so
floats, what seem square roods of sharks and cubic roods of fowls, augment the
murderous din. For hours and hours from the almost stationary ship that hideous
sight is seen. Beneath the unclouded and mild azure sky, upon the fair face of
the pleasant sea, wafted by the joyous breezes, that great mass of death floats
on and on, till lost in infinite perspectives.
There's
a most doleful and most mocking funeral! The sea-vultures all in pious
mourning, the air-sharks all punctiliously in black or speckled. In life but
few of them would have helped the whale, I ween, if peradventure he had needed
it; but upon the banquet of his funeral they most piously do pounce. Oh,
horrible vultureism of earth! from which not the mightiest whale is free.
Nor
is this the end. Desecrated as the body is, a vengeful ghost survives and
hovers over it to scare. Espied by some timid man-of-war or blundering
discovery-vessel from afar, when the distance obscuring the swarming fowls,
nevertheless still shows the white mass floating in the sun, and the white
spray heaving high against it; straightway the whale's unharming corpse, with
trembling fingers is set down in the log—shoals, rocks, and breakers
hereabouts: beware! And for years afterwards, perhaps, ships shun the place;
leaping over it as silly sheep leap over a vacuum, because their leader
originally leaped there when a stick was held. There's your law of precedents;
there's your utility of traditions; there's the story of your obstinate
survival of old beliefs never bottomed on the earth, and now not even hovering
in the air! There's orthodoxy!
Thus,
while in life the great whale's body may have been a real terror to his foes,
in his death his ghost becomes a powerless panic to a world.
Are
you a believer in ghosts, my friend? There are other ghosts than the Cock-Lane
one, and far deeper men than Doctor Johnson who believe in them.
CHAPTER
70. The Sphynx.
It
should not have been omitted that previous to completely stripping the body of
the leviathan, he was beheaded. Now, the beheading of the Sperm Whale is a
scientific anatomical feat, upon which experienced whale surgeons very much
pride themselves: and not without reason.
Consider
that the whale has nothing that can properly be called a neck; on the contrary,
where his head and body seem to join, there, in that very place, is the
thickest part of him. Remember, also, that the surgeon must operate from above,
some eight or ten feet intervening between him and his subject, and that
subject almost hidden in a discoloured, rolling, and oftentimes tumultuous and
bursting sea. Bear in mind, too, that under these untoward circumstances he has
to cut many feet deep in the flesh; and in that subterraneous manner, without
so much as getting one single peep into the ever-contracting gash thus made, he
must skilfully steer clear of all adjacent, interdicted parts, and exactly
divide the spine at a critical point hard by its insertion into the skull. Do
you not marvel, then, at Stubb's boast, that he demanded but ten minutes to
behead a sperm whale?
When
first severed, the head is dropped astern and held there by a cable till the
body is stripped. That done, if it belong to a small whale it is hoisted on
deck to be deliberately disposed of. But, with a full grown leviathan this is
impossible; for the sperm whale's head embraces nearly one third of his entire
bulk, and completely to suspend such a burden as that, even by the immense
tackles of a whaler, this were as vain a thing as to attempt weighing a Dutch
barn in jewellers' scales.
The
Pequod's whale being decapitated and the body stripped, the head was hoisted
against the ship's side—about half way out of the sea, so that it might yet in
great part be buoyed up by its native element. And there with the strained
craft steeply leaning over to it, by reason of the enormous downward drag from
the lower mast-head, and every yard-arm on that side projecting like a crane
over the waves; there, that blood-dripping head hung to the Pequod's waist like
the giant Holofernes's from the girdle of Judith.
When
this last task was accomplished it was noon, and the seamen went below to their
dinner. Silence reigned over the before tumultuous but now deserted deck. An
intense copper calm, like a universal yellow lotus, was more and more unfolding
its noiseless measureless leaves upon the sea.
A
short space elapsed, and up into this noiselessness came Ahab alone from his
cabin. Taking a few turns on the quarter-deck, he paused to gaze over the side,
then slowly getting into the main-chains he took Stubb's long spade—still
remaining there after the whale's decapitation—and striking it into the lower
part of the half-suspended mass, placed its other end crutch-wise under one
arm, and so stood leaning over with eyes attentively fixed on this head.
It
was a black and hooded head; and hanging there in the midst of so intense a
calm, it seemed the Sphynx's in the desert. “Speak, thou vast and venerable
head,” muttered Ahab, “which, though ungarnished with a beard, yet here and
there lookest hoary with mosses; speak, mighty head, and tell us the secret
thing that is in thee. Of all divers, thou hast dived the deepest. That head
upon which the upper sun now gleams, has moved amid this world's foundations.
Where unrecorded names and navies rust, and untold hopes and anchors rot; where
in her murderous hold this frigate earth is ballasted with bones of millions of
the drowned; there, in that awful water-land, there was thy most familiar home.
Thou hast been where bell or diver never went; hast slept by many a sailor's
side, where sleepless mothers would give their lives to lay them down. Thou
saw'st the locked lovers when leaping from their flaming ship; heart to heart
they sank beneath the exulting wave; true to each other, when heaven seemed
false to them. Thou saw'st the murdered mate when tossed by pirates from the
midnight deck; for hours he fell into the deeper midnight of the insatiate maw;
and his murderers still sailed on unharmed—while swift lightnings shivered the
neighboring ship that would have borne a righteous husband to outstretched,
longing arms. O head! thou hast seen enough to split the planets and make an
infidel of Abraham, and not one syllable is thine!”
“Sail
ho!” cried a triumphant voice from the main-mast-head.
“Aye?
Well, now, that's cheering,” cried Ahab, suddenly erecting himself, while whole
thunder-clouds swept aside from his brow. “That lively cry upon this deadly
calm might almost convert a better man.—Where away?”
“Three
points on the starboard bow, sir, and bringing down her breeze to us!
“Better
and better, man. Would now St. Paul would come along that way, and to my
breezelessness bring his breeze! O Nature, and O soul of man! how far beyond
all utterance are your linked analogies! not the smallest atom stirs or lives
on matter, but has its cunning duplicate in mind.”
CHAPTER
71. The Jeroboam's Story.
Hand
in hand, ship and breeze blew on; but the breeze came faster than the ship, and
soon the Pequod began to rock.
By
and by, through the glass the stranger's boats and manned mast-heads proved her
a whale-ship. But as she was so far to windward, and shooting by, apparently
making a passage to some other ground, the Pequod could not hope to reach her.
So the signal was set to see what response would be made.
Here
be it said, that like the vessels of military marines, the ships of the
American Whale Fleet have each a private signal; all which signals being
collected in a book with the names of the respective vessels attached, every
captain is provided with it. Thereby, the whale commanders are enabled to
recognise each other upon the ocean, even at considerable distances and with no
small facility.
The
Pequod's signal was at last responded to by the stranger's setting her own;
which proved the ship to be the Jeroboam of Nantucket. Squaring her yards, she
bore down, ranged abeam under the Pequod's lee, and lowered a boat; it soon
drew nigh; but, as the side-ladder was being rigged by Starbuck's order to
accommodate the visiting captain, the stranger in question waved his hand from
his boat's stern in token of that proceeding being entirely unnecessary. It
turned out that the Jeroboam had a malignant epidemic on board, and that
Mayhew, her captain, was fearful of infecting the Pequod's company. For, though
himself and boat's crew remained untainted, and though his ship was half a
rifle-shot off, and an incorruptible sea and air rolling and flowing between;
yet conscientiously adhering to the timid quarantine of the land, he
peremptorily refused to come into direct contact with the Pequod.
But
this did by no means prevent all communications. Preserving an interval of some
few yards between itself and the ship, the Jeroboam's boat by the occasional
use of its oars contrived to keep parallel to the Pequod, as she heavily forged
through the sea (for by this time it blew very fresh), with her main-topsail
aback; though, indeed, at times by the sudden onset of a large rolling wave,
the boat would be pushed some way ahead; but would be soon skilfully brought to
her proper bearings again. Subject to this, and other the like interruptions
now and then, a conversation was sustained between the two parties; but at
intervals not without still another interruption of a very different sort.
Pulling
an oar in the Jeroboam's boat, was a man of a singular appearance, even in that
wild whaling life where individual notabilities make up all totalities. He was
a small, short, youngish man, sprinkled all over his face with freckles, and
wearing redundant yellow hair. A long-skirted, cabalistically-cut coat of a
faded walnut tinge enveloped him; the overlapping sleeves of which were rolled
up on his wrists. A deep, settled, fanatic delirium was in his eyes.
So
soon as this figure had been first descried, Stubb had exclaimed—“That's he!
that's he!—the long-togged scaramouch the Town-Ho's company told us of!” Stubb
here alluded to a strange story told of the Jeroboam, and a certain man among
her crew, some time previous when the Pequod spoke the Town-Ho. According to
this account and what was subsequently learned, it seemed that the scaramouch
in question had gained a wonderful ascendency over almost everybody in the
Jeroboam. His story was this:
He
had been originally nurtured among the crazy society of Neskyeuna Shakers,
where he had been a great prophet; in their cracked, secret meetings having
several times descended from heaven by the way of a trap-door, announcing the
speedy opening of the seventh vial, which he carried in his vest-pocket; but,
which, instead of containing gunpowder, was supposed to be charged with
laudanum. A strange, apostolic whim having seized him, he had left Neskyeuna
for Nantucket, where, with that cunning peculiar to craziness, he assumed a
steady, common-sense exterior, and offered himself as a green-hand candidate
for the Jeroboam's whaling voyage. They engaged him; but straightway upon the
ship's getting out of sight of land, his insanity broke out in a freshet. He
announced himself as the archangel Gabriel, and commanded the captain to jump
overboard. He published his manifesto, whereby he set himself forth as the
deliverer of the isles of the sea and vicar-general of all Oceanica. The
unflinching earnestness with which he declared these things;—the dark, daring
play of his sleepless, excited imagination, and all the preternatural terrors
of real delirium, united to invest this Gabriel in the minds of the majority of
the ignorant crew, with an atmosphere of sacredness. Moreover, they were afraid
of him. As such a man, however, was not of much practical use in the ship,
especially as he refused to work except when he pleased, the incredulous
captain would fain have been rid of him; but apprised that that individual's
intention was to land him in the first convenient port, the archangel forthwith
opened all his seals and vials—devoting the ship and all hands to unconditional
perdition, in case this intention was carried out. So strongly did he work upon
his disciples among the crew, that at last in a body they went to the captain
and told him if Gabriel was sent from the ship, not a man of them would remain.
He was therefore forced to relinquish his plan. Nor would they permit Gabriel
to be any way maltreated, say or do what he would; so that it came to pass that
Gabriel had the complete freedom of the ship. The consequence of all this was,
that the archangel cared little or nothing for the captain and mates; and since
the epidemic had broken out, he carried a higher hand than ever; declaring that
the plague, as he called it, was at his sole command; nor should it be stayed
but according to his good pleasure. The sailors, mostly poor devils, cringed,
and some of them fawned before him; in obedience to his instructions, sometimes
rendering him personal homage, as to a god. Such things may seem incredible;
but, however wondrous, they are true. Nor is the history of fanatics half so
striking in respect to the measureless self-deception of the fanatic himself,
as his measureless power of deceiving and bedevilling so many others. But it is
time to return to the Pequod.
“I
fear not thy epidemic, man,” said Ahab from the bulwarks, to Captain Mayhew,
who stood in the boat's stern; “come on board.”
But
now Gabriel started to his feet.
“Think,
think of the fevers, yellow and bilious! Beware of the horrible plague!”
“Gabriel!
Gabriel!” cried Captain Mayhew; “thou must either—” But that instant a headlong
wave shot the boat far ahead, and its seethings drowned all speech.
“Hast
thou seen the White Whale?” demanded Ahab, when the boat drifted back.
“Think,
think of thy whale-boat, stoven and sunk! Beware of the horrible tail!”
“I
tell thee again, Gabriel, that—” But again the boat tore ahead as if dragged by
fiends. Nothing was said for some moments, while a succession of riotous waves
rolled by, which by one of those occasional caprices of the seas were tumbling,
not heaving it. Meantime, the hoisted sperm whale's head jogged about very
violently, and Gabriel was seen eyeing it with rather more apprehensiveness
than his archangel nature seemed to warrant.
When
this interlude was over, Captain Mayhew began a dark story concerning Moby
Dick; not, however, without frequent interruptions from Gabriel, whenever his
name was mentioned, and the crazy sea that seemed leagued with him.
It
seemed that the Jeroboam had not long left home, when upon speaking a
whale-ship, her people were reliably apprised of the existence of Moby Dick,
and the havoc he had made. Greedily sucking in this intelligence, Gabriel
solemnly warned the captain against attacking the White Whale, in case the
monster should be seen; in his gibbering insanity, pronouncing the White Whale
to be no less a being than the Shaker God incarnated; the Shakers receiving the
Bible. But when, some year or two afterwards, Moby Dick was fairly sighted from
the mast-heads, Macey, the chief mate, burned with ardour to encounter him; and
the captain himself being not unwilling to let him have the opportunity,
despite all the archangel's denunciations and forewarnings, Macey succeeded in
persuading five men to man his boat. With them he pushed off; and, after much
weary pulling, and many perilous, unsuccessful onsets, he at last succeeded in
getting one iron fast. Meantime, Gabriel, ascending to the main-royal
mast-head, was tossing one arm in frantic gestures, and hurling forth
prophecies of speedy doom to the sacrilegious assailants of his divinity. Now,
while Macey, the mate, was standing up in his boat's bow, and with all the
reckless energy of his tribe was venting his wild exclamations upon the whale,
and essaying to get a fair chance for his poised lance, lo! a broad white
shadow rose from the sea; by its quick, fanning motion, temporarily taking the
breath out of the bodies of the oarsmen. Next instant, the luckless mate, so
full of furious life, was smitten bodily into the air, and making a long arc in
his descent, fell into the sea at the distance of about fifty yards. Not a chip
of the boat was harmed, nor a hair of any oarsman's head; but the mate for ever
sank.
It
is well to parenthesize here, that of the fatal accidents in the Sperm-Whale
Fishery, this kind is perhaps almost as frequent as any. Sometimes, nothing is
injured but the man who is thus annihilated; oftener the boat's bow is knocked
off, or the thigh-board, in which the headsman stands, is torn from its place
and accompanies the body. But strangest of all is the circumstance, that in
more instances than one, when the body has been recovered, not a single mark of
violence is discernible; the man being stark dead.
The
whole calamity, with the falling form of Macey, was plainly descried from the
ship. Raising a piercing shriek—“The vial! the vial!” Gabriel called off the
terror-stricken crew from the further hunting of the whale. This terrible event
clothed the archangel with added influence; because his credulous disciples
believed that he had specifically fore-announced it, instead of only making a
general prophecy, which any one might have done, and so have chanced to hit one
of many marks in the wide margin allowed. He became a nameless terror to the
ship.
Mayhew
having concluded his narration, Ahab put such questions to him, that the
stranger captain could not forbear inquiring whether he intended to hunt the
White Whale, if opportunity should offer. To which Ahab answered—“Aye.”
Straightway, then, Gabriel once more started to his feet, glaring upon the old
man, and vehemently exclaimed, with downward pointed finger—“Think, think of
the blasphemer—dead, and down there!—beware of the blasphemer's end!”
Ahab
stolidly turned aside; then said to Mayhew, “Captain, I have just bethought me
of my letter-bag; there is a letter for one of thy officers, if I mistake not.
Starbuck, look over the bag.”
Every
whale-ship takes out a goodly number of letters for various ships, whose
delivery to the persons to whom they may be addressed, depends upon the mere
chance of encountering them in the four oceans. Thus, most letters never reach
their mark; and many are only received after attaining an age of two or three
years or more.
Soon
Starbuck returned with a letter in his hand. It was sorely tumbled, damp, and
covered with a dull, spotted, green mould, in consequence of being kept in a
dark locker of the cabin. Of such a letter, Death himself might well have been
the post-boy.
“Can'st
not read it?” cried Ahab. “Give it me, man. Aye, aye, it's but a dim
scrawl;—what's this?” As he was studying it out, Starbuck took a long
cutting-spade pole, and with his knife slightly split the end, to insert the
letter there, and in that way, hand it to the boat, without its coming any
closer to the ship.
Meantime,
Ahab holding the letter, muttered, “Mr. Har—yes, Mr. Harry—(a woman's pinny
hand,—the man's wife, I'll wager)—Aye—Mr. Harry Macey, Ship Jeroboam;—why it's
Macey, and he's dead!”
“Poor
fellow! poor fellow! and from his wife,” sighed Mayhew; “but let me have it.”
“Nay,
keep it thyself,” cried Gabriel to Ahab; “thou art soon going that way.”
“Curses
throttle thee!” yelled Ahab. “Captain Mayhew, stand by now to receive it”; and
taking the fatal missive from Starbuck's hands, he caught it in the slit of the
pole, and reached it over towards the boat. But as he did so, the oarsmen
expectantly desisted from rowing; the boat drifted a little towards the ship's
stern; so that, as if by magic, the letter suddenly ranged along with Gabriel's
eager hand. He clutched it in an instant, seized the boat-knife, and impaling
the letter on it, sent it thus loaded back into the ship. It fell at Ahab's
feet. Then Gabriel shrieked out to his comrades to give way with their oars,
and in that manner the mutinous boat rapidly shot away from the Pequod.
As,
after this interlude, the seamen resumed their work upon the jacket of the
whale, many strange things were hinted in reference to this wild affair.
CHAPTER
72. The Monkey-Rope.
In
the tumultuous business of cutting-in and attending to a whale, there is much
running backwards and forwards among the crew. Now hands are wanted here, and
then again hands are wanted there. There is no staying in any one place; for at
one and the same time everything has to be done everywhere. It is much the same
with him who endeavors the description of the scene. We must now retrace our
way a little. It was mentioned that upon first breaking ground in the whale's
back, the blubber-hook was inserted into the original hole there cut by the
spades of the mates. But how did so clumsy and weighty a mass as that same hook
get fixed in that hole? It was inserted there by my particular friend Queequeg,
whose duty it was, as harpooneer, to descend upon the monster's back for the
special purpose referred to. But in very many cases, circumstances require that
the harpooneer shall remain on the whale till the whole flensing or stripping
operation is concluded. The whale, be it observed, lies almost entirely
submerged, excepting the immediate parts operated upon. So down there, some ten
feet below the level of the deck, the poor harpooneer flounders about, half on
the whale and half in the water, as the vast mass revolves like a tread-mill
beneath him. On the occasion in question, Queequeg figured in the Highland
costume—a shirt and socks—in which to my eyes, at least, he appeared to
uncommon advantage; and no one had a better chance to observe him, as will
presently be seen.
Being
the savage's bowsman, that is, the person who pulled the bow-oar in his boat
(the second one from forward), it was my cheerful duty to attend upon him while
taking that hard-scrabble scramble upon the dead whale's back. You have seen
Italian organ-boys holding a dancing-ape by a long cord. Just so, from the
ship's steep side, did I hold Queequeg down there in the sea, by what is
technically called in the fishery a monkey-rope, attached to a strong strip of
canvas belted round his waist.
It
was a humorously perilous business for both of us. For, before we proceed
further, it must be said that the monkey-rope was fast at both ends; fast to
Queequeg's broad canvas belt, and fast to my narrow leather one. So that for
better or for worse, we two, for the time, were wedded; and should poor
Queequeg sink to rise no more, then both usage and honor demanded, that instead
of cutting the cord, it should drag me down in his wake. So, then, an elongated
Siamese ligature united us. Queequeg was my own inseparable twin brother; nor
could I any way get rid of the dangerous liabilities which the hempen bond
entailed.
So
strongly and metaphysically did I conceive of my situation then, that while
earnestly watching his motions, I seemed distinctly to perceive that my own
individuality was now merged in a joint stock company of two; that my free will
had received a mortal wound; and that another's mistake or misfortune might
plunge innocent me into unmerited disaster and death. Therefore, I saw that
here was a sort of interregnum in Providence; for its even-handed equity never
could have so gross an injustice. And yet still further pondering—while I
jerked him now and then from between the whale and ship, which would threaten
to jam him—still further pondering, I say, I saw that this situation of mine
was the precise situation of every mortal that breathes; only, in most cases,
he, one way or other, has this Siamese connexion with a plurality of other
mortals. If your banker breaks, you snap; if your apothecary by mistake sends
you poison in your pills, you die. True, you may say that, by exceeding
caution, you may possibly escape these and the multitudinous other evil chances
of life. But handle Queequeg's monkey-rope heedfully as I would, sometimes he
jerked it so, that I came very near sliding overboard. Nor could I possibly
forget that, do what I would, I only had the management of one end of it.*
*The
monkey-rope is found in all whalers; but it was only in the Pequod that the
monkey and his holder were ever tied together. This improvement upon the
original usage was introduced by no less a man than Stubb, in order to afford
the imperilled harpooneer the strongest possible guarantee for the faithfulness
and vigilance of his monkey-rope holder.
I
have hinted that I would often jerk poor Queequeg from between the whale and
the ship—where he would occasionally fall, from the incessant rolling and swaying
of both. But this was not the only jamming jeopardy he was exposed to.
Unappalled by the massacre made upon them during the night, the sharks now
freshly and more keenly allured by the before pent blood which began to flow
from the carcass—the rabid creatures swarmed round it like bees in a beehive.
And
right in among those sharks was Queequeg; who often pushed them aside with his
floundering feet. A thing altogether incredible were it not that attracted by
such prey as a dead whale, the otherwise miscellaneously carnivorous shark will
seldom touch a man.
Nevertheless,
it may well be believed that since they have such a ravenous finger in the pie,
it is deemed but wise to look sharp to them. Accordingly, besides the
monkey-rope, with which I now and then jerked the poor fellow from too close a
vicinity to the maw of what seemed a peculiarly ferocious shark—he was provided
with still another protection. Suspended over the side in one of the stages,
Tashtego and Daggoo continually flourished over his head a couple of keen
whale-spades, wherewith they slaughtered as many sharks as they could reach.
This procedure of theirs, to be sure, was very disinterested and benevolent of
them. They meant Queequeg's best happiness, I admit; but in their hasty zeal to
befriend him, and from the circumstance that both he and the sharks were at
times half hidden by the blood-muddled water, those indiscreet spades of theirs
would come nearer amputating a leg than a tail. But poor Queequeg, I suppose,
straining and gasping there with that great iron hook—poor Queequeg, I suppose,
only prayed to his Yojo, and gave up his life into the hands of his gods.
Well,
well, my dear comrade and twin-brother, thought I, as I drew in and then
slacked off the rope to every swell of the sea—what matters it, after all? Are
you not the precious image of each and all of us men in this whaling world?
That unsounded ocean you gasp in, is Life; those sharks, your foes; those
spades, your friends; and what between sharks and spades you are in a sad
pickle and peril, poor lad.
But
courage! there is good cheer in store for you, Queequeg. For now, as with blue
lips and blood-shot eyes the exhausted savage at last climbs up the chains and
stands all dripping and involuntarily trembling over the side; the steward
advances, and with a benevolent, consolatory glance hands him—what? Some hot
Cognac? No! hands him, ye gods! hands him a cup of tepid ginger and water!
“Ginger?
Do I smell ginger?” suspiciously asked Stubb, coming near. “Yes, this must be ginger,”
peering into the as yet untasted cup. Then standing as if incredulous for a
while, he calmly walked towards the astonished steward slowly saying, “Ginger?
ginger? and will you have the goodness to tell me, Mr. Dough-Boy, where lies
the virtue of ginger? Ginger! is ginger the sort of fuel you use, Dough-boy, to
kindle a fire in this shivering cannibal? Ginger!—what the devil is ginger?
Sea-coal? firewood?—lucifer matches?—tinder?—gunpowder?—what the devil is
ginger, I say, that you offer this cup to our poor Queequeg here.”
“There
is some sneaking Temperance Society movement about this business,” he suddenly
added, now approaching Starbuck, who had just come from forward. “Will you look
at that kannakin, sir: smell of it, if you please.” Then watching the mate's
countenance, he added, “The steward, Mr. Starbuck, had the face to offer that
calomel and jalap to Queequeg, there, this instant off the whale. Is the
steward an apothecary, sir? and may I ask whether this is the sort of bitters
by which he blows back the life into a half-drowned man?”
“I
trust not,” said Starbuck, “it is poor stuff enough.”
“Aye,
aye, steward,” cried Stubb, “we'll teach you to drug a harpooneer; none of your
apothecary's medicine here; you want to poison us, do ye? You have got out
insurances on our lives and want to murder us all, and pocket the proceeds, do
ye?”
“It
was not me,” cried Dough-Boy, “it was Aunt Charity that brought the ginger on
board; and bade me never give the harpooneers any spirits, but only this ginger-jub—so
she called it.”
“Ginger-jub!
you gingerly rascal! take that! and run along with ye to the lockers, and get
something better. I hope I do no wrong, Mr. Starbuck. It is the captain's
orders—grog for the harpooneer on a whale.”
“Enough,”
replied Starbuck, “only don't hit him again, but—”
“Oh,
I never hurt when I hit, except when I hit a whale or something of that sort;
and this fellow's a weazel. What were you about saying, sir?”
“Only
this: go down with him, and get what thou wantest thyself.”
When
Stubb reappeared, he came with a dark flask in one hand, and a sort of
tea-caddy in the other. The first contained strong spirits, and was handed to
Queequeg; the second was Aunt Charity's gift, and that was freely given to the
waves.
CHAPTER
73. Stubb and Flask kill a Right Whale; and Then Have a Talk over Him.
It
must be borne in mind that all this time we have a Sperm Whale's prodigious
head hanging to the Pequod's side. But we must let it continue hanging there a
while till we can get a chance to attend to it. For the present other matters
press, and the best we can do now for the head, is to pray heaven the tackles
may hold.
Now,
during the past night and forenoon, the Pequod had gradually drifted into a
sea, which, by its occasional patches of yellow brit, gave unusual tokens of
the vicinity of Right Whales, a species of the Leviathan that but few supposed
to be at this particular time lurking anywhere near. And though all hands
commonly disdained the capture of those inferior creatures; and though the
Pequod was not commissioned to cruise for them at all, and though she had
passed numbers of them near the Crozetts without lowering a boat; yet now that
a Sperm Whale had been brought alongside and beheaded, to the surprise of all,
the announcement was made that a Right Whale should be captured that day, if
opportunity offered.
Nor
was this long wanting. Tall spouts were seen to leeward; and two boats, Stubb's
and Flask's, were detached in pursuit. Pulling further and further away, they
at last became almost invisible to the men at the mast-head. But suddenly in
the distance, they saw a great heap of tumultuous white water, and soon after
news came from aloft that one or both the boats must be fast. An interval
passed and the boats were in plain sight, in the act of being dragged right
towards the ship by the towing whale. So close did the monster come to the
hull, that at first it seemed as if he meant it malice; but suddenly going down
in a maelstrom, within three rods of the planks, he wholly disappeared from
view, as if diving under the keel. “Cut, cut!” was the cry from the ship to the
boats, which, for one instant, seemed on the point of being brought with a
deadly dash against the vessel's side. But having plenty of line yet in the
tubs, and the whale not sounding very rapidly, they paid out abundance of rope,
and at the same time pulled with all their might so as to get ahead of the
ship. For a few minutes the struggle was intensely critical; for while they
still slacked out the tightened line in one direction, and still plied their
oars in another, the contending strain threatened to take them under. But it
was only a few feet advance they sought to gain. And they stuck to it till they
did gain it; when instantly, a swift tremor was felt running like lightning
along the keel, as the strained line, scraping beneath the ship, suddenly rose
to view under her bows, snapping and quivering; and so flinging off its drippings,
that the drops fell like bits of broken glass on the water, while the whale
beyond also rose to sight, and once more the boats were free to fly. But the
fagged whale abated his speed, and blindly altering his course, went round the
stern of the ship towing the two boats after him, so that they performed a
complete circuit.
Meantime,
they hauled more and more upon their lines, till close flanking him on both
sides, Stubb answered Flask with lance for lance; and thus round and round the
Pequod the battle went, while the multitudes of sharks that had before swum
round the Sperm Whale's body, rushed to the fresh blood that was spilled,
thirstily drinking at every new gash, as the eager Israelites did at the new
bursting fountains that poured from the smitten rock.
At
last his spout grew thick, and with a frightful roll and vomit, he turned upon
his back a corpse.
While
the two headsmen were engaged in making fast cords to his flukes, and in other
ways getting the mass in readiness for towing, some conversation ensued between
them.
“I
wonder what the old man wants with this lump of foul lard,” said Stubb, not
without some disgust at the thought of having to do with so ignoble a
leviathan.
“Wants
with it?” said Flask, coiling some spare line in the boat's bow, “did you never
hear that the ship which but once has a Sperm Whale's head hoisted on her
starboard side, and at the same time a Right Whale's on the larboard; did you
never hear, Stubb, that that ship can never afterwards capsize?”
“Why
not?
“I
don't know, but I heard that gamboge ghost of a Fedallah saying so, and he
seems to know all about ships' charms. But I sometimes think he'll charm the
ship to no good at last. I don't half like that chap, Stubb. Did you ever
notice how that tusk of his is a sort of carved into a snake's head, Stubb?”
“Sink
him! I never look at him at all; but if ever I get a chance of a dark night,
and he standing hard by the bulwarks, and no one by; look down there,
Flask”—pointing into the sea with a peculiar motion of both hands—“Aye, will I!
Flask, I take that Fedallah to be the devil in disguise. Do you believe that
cock and bull story about his having been stowed away on board ship? He's the
devil, I say. The reason why you don't see his tail, is because he tucks it up
out of sight; he carries it coiled away in his pocket, I guess. Blast him! now
that I think of it, he's always wanting oakum to stuff into the toes of his
boots.”
“He
sleeps in his boots, don't he? He hasn't got any hammock; but I've seen him lay
of nights in a coil of rigging.”
“No
doubt, and it's because of his cursed tail; he coils it down, do ye see, in the
eye of the rigging.”
“What's
the old man have so much to do with him for?”
“Striking
up a swap or a bargain, I suppose.”
“Bargain?—about
what?”
“Why,
do ye see, the old man is hard bent after that White Whale, and the devil there
is trying to come round him, and get him to swap away his silver watch, or his
soul, or something of that sort, and then he'll surrender Moby Dick.”
“Pooh!
Stubb, you are skylarking; how can Fedallah do that?”
“I
don't know, Flask, but the devil is a curious chap, and a wicked one, I tell
ye. Why, they say as how he went a sauntering into the old flag-ship once,
switching his tail about devilish easy and gentlemanlike, and inquiring if the
old governor was at home. Well, he was at home, and asked the devil what he
wanted. The devil, switching his hoofs, up and says, 'I want John.' 'What for?'
says the old governor. 'What business is that of yours,' says the devil,
getting mad,—'I want to use him.' 'Take him,' says the governor—and by the
Lord, Flask, if the devil didn't give John the Asiatic cholera before he got
through with him, I'll eat this whale in one mouthful. But look sharp—ain't you
all ready there? Well, then, pull ahead, and let's get the whale alongside.”
“I
think I remember some such story as you were telling,” said Flask, when at last
the two boats were slowly advancing with their burden towards the ship, “but I
can't remember where.”
“Three
Spaniards? Adventures of those three bloody-minded soldadoes? Did ye read it
there, Flask? I guess ye did?”
“No:
never saw such a book; heard of it, though. But now, tell me, Stubb, do you
suppose that that devil you was speaking of just now, was the same you say is
now on board the Pequod?”
“Am
I the same man that helped kill this whale? Doesn't the devil live for ever;
who ever heard that the devil was dead? Did you ever see any parson a wearing
mourning for the devil? And if the devil has a latch-key to get into the
admiral's cabin, don't you suppose he can crawl into a porthole? Tell me that,
Mr. Flask?”
“How
old do you suppose Fedallah is, Stubb?”
“Do
you see that mainmast there?” pointing to the ship; “well, that's the figure
one; now take all the hoops in the Pequod's hold, and string along in a row
with that mast, for oughts, do you see; well, that wouldn't begin to be
Fedallah's age. Nor all the coopers in creation couldn't show hoops enough to
make oughts enough.”
“But
see here, Stubb, I thought you a little boasted just now, that you meant to
give Fedallah a sea-toss, if you got a good chance. Now, if he's so old as all
those hoops of yours come to, and if he is going to live for ever, what good
will it do to pitch him overboard—tell me that?
“Give
him a good ducking, anyhow.”
“But
he'd crawl back.”
“Duck
him again; and keep ducking him.”
“Suppose
he should take it into his head to duck you, though—yes, and drown you—what
then?”
“I
should like to see him try it; I'd give him such a pair of black eyes that he
wouldn't dare to show his face in the admiral's cabin again for a long while,
let alone down in the orlop there, where he lives, and hereabouts on the upper
decks where he sneaks so much. Damn the devil, Flask; so you suppose I'm afraid
of the devil? Who's afraid of him, except the old governor who daresn't catch
him and put him in double-darbies, as he deserves, but lets him go about
kidnapping people; aye, and signed a bond with him, that all the people the
devil kidnapped, he'd roast for him? There's a governor!”
“Do
you suppose Fedallah wants to kidnap Captain Ahab?”
“Do
I suppose it? You'll know it before long, Flask. But I am going now to keep a
sharp look-out on him; and if I see anything very suspicious going on, I'll
just take him by the nape of his neck, and say—Look here, Beelzebub, you don't
do it; and if he makes any fuss, by the Lord I'll make a grab into his pocket
for his tail, take it to the capstan, and give him such a wrenching and
heaving, that his tail will come short off at the stump—do you see; and then, I
rather guess when he finds himself docked in that queer fashion, he'll sneak
off without the poor satisfaction of feeling his tail between his legs.”
“And
what will you do with the tail, Stubb?”
“Do
with it? Sell it for an ox whip when we get home;—what else?”
“Now,
do you mean what you say, and have been saying all along, Stubb?”
“Mean
or not mean, here we are at the ship.”
The
boats were here hailed, to tow the whale on the larboard side, where fluke
chains and other necessaries were already prepared for securing him.
“Didn't
I tell you so?” said Flask; “yes, you'll soon see this right whale's head
hoisted up opposite that parmacetti's.”
In
good time, Flask's saying proved true. As before, the Pequod steeply leaned
over towards the sperm whale's head, now, by the counterpoise of both heads,
she regained her even keel; though sorely strained, you may well believe. So,
when on one side you hoist in Locke's head, you go over that way; but now, on
the other side, hoist in Kant's and you come back again; but in very poor plight.
Thus, some minds for ever keep trimming boat. Oh, ye foolish! throw all these
thunder-heads overboard, and then you will float light and right.
In
disposing of the body of a right whale, when brought alongside the ship, the
same preliminary proceedings commonly take place as in the case of a sperm
whale; only, in the latter instance, the head is cut off whole, but in the
former the lips and tongue are separately removed and hoisted on deck, with all
the well known black bone attached to what is called the crown-piece. But
nothing like this, in the present case, had been done. The carcases of both
whales had dropped astern; and the head-laden ship not a little resembled a
mule carrying a pair of overburdening panniers.
Meantime,
Fedallah was calmly eyeing the right whale's head, and ever and anon glancing
from the deep wrinkles there to the lines in his own hand. And Ahab chanced so
to stand, that the Parsee occupied his shadow; while, if the Parsee's shadow
was there at all it seemed only to blend with, and lengthen Ahab's. As the crew
toiled on, Laplandish speculations were bandied among them, concerning all
these passing things.
CHAPTER
74. The Sperm Whale's Head—Contrasted View.
Here,
now, are two great whales, laying their heads together; let us join them, and
lay together our own.
Of
the grand order of folio leviathans, the Sperm Whale and the Right Whale are by
far the most noteworthy. They are the only whales regularly hunted by man. To
the Nantucketer, they present the two extremes of all the known varieties of
the whale. As the external difference between them is mainly observable in
their heads; and as a head of each is this moment hanging from the Pequod's
side; and as we may freely go from one to the other, by merely stepping across
the deck:—where, I should like to know, will you obtain a better chance to
study practical cetology than here?
In
the first place, you are struck by the general contrast between these heads.
Both are massive enough in all conscience; but there is a certain mathematical
symmetry in the Sperm Whale's which the Right Whale's sadly lacks. There is
more character in the Sperm Whale's head. As you behold it, you involuntarily
yield the immense superiority to him, in point of pervading dignity. In the present
instance, too, this dignity is heightened by the pepper and salt colour of his
head at the summit, giving token of advanced age and large experience. In
short, he is what the fishermen technically call a “grey-headed whale.”
Let
us now note what is least dissimilar in these heads—namely, the two most
important organs, the eye and the ear. Far back on the side of the head, and
low down, near the angle of either whale's jaw, if you narrowly search, you
will at last see a lashless eye, which you would fancy to be a young colt's
eye; so out of all proportion is it to the magnitude of the head.
Now,
from this peculiar sideway position of the whale's eyes, it is plain that he
can never see an object which is exactly ahead, no more than he can one exactly
astern. In a word, the position of the whale's eyes corresponds to that of a
man's ears; and you may fancy, for yourself, how it would fare with you, did
you sideways survey objects through your ears. You would find that you could
only command some thirty degrees of vision in advance of the straight side-line
of sight; and about thirty more behind it. If your bitterest foe were walking
straight towards you, with dagger uplifted in broad day, you would not be able
to see him, any more than if he were stealing upon you from behind. In a word,
you would have two backs, so to speak; but, at the same time, also, two fronts
(side fronts): for what is it that makes the front of a man—what, indeed, but
his eyes?
Moreover,
while in most other animals that I can now think of, the eyes are so planted as
imperceptibly to blend their visual power, so as to produce one picture and not
two to the brain; the peculiar position of the whale's eyes, effectually
divided as they are by many cubic feet of solid head, which towers between them
like a great mountain separating two lakes in valleys; this, of course, must
wholly separate the impressions which each independent organ imparts. The
whale, therefore, must see one distinct picture on this side, and another
distinct picture on that side; while all between must be profound darkness and
nothingness to him. Man may, in effect, be said to look out on the world from a
sentry-box with two joined sashes for his window. But with the whale, these two
sashes are separately inserted, making two distinct windows, but sadly
impairing the view. This peculiarity of the whale's eyes is a thing always to
be borne in mind in the fishery; and to be remembered by the reader in some
subsequent scenes.
A
curious and most puzzling question might be started concerning this visual
matter as touching the Leviathan. But I must be content with a hint. So long as
a man's eyes are open in the light, the act of seeing is involuntary; that is,
he cannot then help mechanically seeing whatever objects are before him.
Nevertheless, any one's experience will teach him, that though he can take in
an undiscriminating sweep of things at one glance, it is quite impossible for
him, attentively, and completely, to examine any two things—however large or
however small—at one and the same instant of time; never mind if they lie side
by side and touch each other. But if you now come to separate these two
objects, and surround each by a circle of profound darkness; then, in order to
see one of them, in such a manner as to bring your mind to bear on it, the
other will be utterly excluded from your contemporary consciousness. How is it,
then, with the whale? True, both his eyes, in themselves, must simultaneously
act; but is his brain so much more comprehensive, combining, and subtle than
man's, that he can at the same moment of time attentively examine two distinct
prospects, one on one side of him, and the other in an exactly opposite
direction? If he can, then is it as marvellous a thing in him, as if a man were
able simultaneously to go through the demonstrations of two distinct problems
in Euclid. Nor, strictly investigated, is there any incongruity in this
comparison.
It
may be but an idle whim, but it has always seemed to me, that the extraordinary
vacillations of movement displayed by some whales when beset by three or four
boats; the timidity and liability to queer frights, so common to such whales; I
think that all this indirectly proceeds from the helpless perplexity of volition,
in which their divided and diametrically opposite powers of vision must involve
them.
But
the ear of the whale is full as curious as the eye. If you are an entire
stranger to their race, you might hunt over these two heads for hours, and
never discover that organ. The ear has no external leaf whatever; and into the
hole itself you can hardly insert a quill, so wondrously minute is it. It is
lodged a little behind the eye. With respect to their ears, this important
difference is to be observed between the sperm whale and the right. While the
ear of the former has an external opening, that of the latter is entirely and
evenly covered over with a membrane, so as to be quite imperceptible from
without.
Is
it not curious, that so vast a being as the whale should see the world through
so small an eye, and hear the thunder through an ear which is smaller than a
hare's? But if his eyes were broad as the lens of Herschel's great telescope;
and his ears capacious as the porches of cathedrals; would that make him any
longer of sight, or sharper of hearing? Not at all.—Why then do you try to
“enlarge” your mind? Subtilize it.
Let
us now with whatever levers and steam-engines we have at hand, cant over the
sperm whale's head, that it may lie bottom up; then, ascending by a ladder to
the summit, have a peep down the mouth; and were it not that the body is now
completely separated from it, with a lantern we might descend into the great
Kentucky Mammoth Cave of his stomach. But let us hold on here by this tooth, and
look about us where we are. What a really beautiful and chaste-looking mouth!
from floor to ceiling, lined, or rather papered with a glistening white
membrane, glossy as bridal satins.
But
come out now, and look at this portentous lower jaw, which seems like the long
narrow lid of an immense snuff-box, with the hinge at one end, instead of one
side. If you pry it up, so as to get it overhead, and expose its rows of teeth,
it seems a terrific portcullis; and such, alas! it proves to many a poor wight
in the fishery, upon whom these spikes fall with impaling force. But far more
terrible is it to behold, when fathoms down in the sea, you see some sulky
whale, floating there suspended, with his prodigious jaw, some fifteen feet
long, hanging straight down at right-angles with his body, for all the world
like a ship's jib-boom. This whale is not dead; he is only dispirited; out of
sorts, perhaps; hypochondriac; and so supine, that the hinges of his jaw have
relaxed, leaving him there in that ungainly sort of plight, a reproach to all
his tribe, who must, no doubt, imprecate lock-jaws upon him.
In
most cases this lower jaw—being easily unhinged by a practised artist—is
disengaged and hoisted on deck for the purpose of extracting the ivory teeth,
and furnishing a supply of that hard white whalebone with which the fishermen
fashion all sorts of curious articles, including canes, umbrella-stocks, and
handles to riding-whips.
With
a long, weary hoist the jaw is dragged on board, as if it were an anchor; and
when the proper time comes—some few days after the other work—Queequeg, Daggoo,
and Tashtego, being all accomplished dentists, are set to drawing teeth. With a
keen cutting-spade, Queequeg lances the gums; then the jaw is lashed down to
ringbolts, and a tackle being rigged from aloft, they drag out these teeth, as
Michigan oxen drag stumps of old oaks out of wild wood lands. There are
generally forty-two teeth in all; in old whales, much worn down, but undecayed;
nor filled after our artificial fashion. The jaw is afterwards sawn into slabs,
and piled away like joists for building houses.
CHAPTER
75. The Right Whale's Head—Contrasted View.
Crossing
the deck, let us now have a good long look at the Right Whale's head.
As
in general shape the noble Sperm Whale's head may be compared to a Roman
war-chariot (especially in front, where it is so broadly rounded); so, at a
broad view, the Right Whale's head bears a rather inelegant resemblance to a
gigantic galliot-toed shoe. Two hundred years ago an old Dutch voyager likened
its shape to that of a shoemaker's last. And in this same last or shoe, that
old woman of the nursery tale, with the swarming brood, might very comfortably
be lodged, she and all her progeny.
But
as you come nearer to this great head it begins to assume different aspects,
according to your point of view. If you stand on its summit and look at these
two F-shaped spoutholes, you would take the whole head for an enormous
bass-viol, and these spiracles, the apertures in its sounding-board. Then,
again, if you fix your eye upon this strange, crested, comb-like incrustation
on the top of the mass—this green, barnacled thing, which the Greenlanders call
the “crown,” and the Southern fishers the “bonnet” of the Right Whale; fixing
your eyes solely on this, you would take the head for the trunk of some huge
oak, with a bird's nest in its crotch. At any rate, when you watch those live
crabs that nestle here on this bonnet, such an idea will be almost sure to
occur to you; unless, indeed, your fancy has been fixed by the technical term
“crown” also bestowed upon it; in which case you will take great interest in
thinking how this mighty monster is actually a diademed king of the sea, whose
green crown has been put together for him in this marvellous manner. But if
this whale be a king, he is a very sulky looking fellow to grace a diadem. Look
at that hanging lower lip! what a huge sulk and pout is there! a sulk and pout,
by carpenter's measurement, about twenty feet long and five feet deep; a sulk and
pout that will yield you some 500 gallons of oil and more.
A
great pity, now, that this unfortunate whale should be hare-lipped. The fissure
is about a foot across. Probably the mother during an important interval was
sailing down the Peruvian coast, when earthquakes caused the beach to gape.
Over this lip, as over a slippery threshold, we now slide into the mouth. Upon
my word were I at Mackinaw, I should take this to be the inside of an Indian
wigwam. Good Lord! is this the road that Jonah went? The roof is about twelve
feet high, and runs to a pretty sharp angle, as if there were a regular
ridge-pole there; while these ribbed, arched, hairy sides, present us with
those wondrous, half vertical, scimetar-shaped slats of whalebone, say three
hundred on a side, which depending from the upper part of the head or crown
bone, form those Venetian blinds which have elsewhere been cursorily mentioned.
The edges of these bones are fringed with hairy fibres, through which the Right
Whale strains the water, and in whose intricacies he retains the small fish,
when openmouthed he goes through the seas of brit in feeding time. In the
central blinds of bone, as they stand in their natural order, there are certain
curious marks, curves, hollows, and ridges, whereby some whalemen calculate the
creature's age, as the age of an oak by its circular rings. Though the
certainty of this criterion is far from demonstrable, yet it has the savor of
analogical probability. At any rate, if we yield to it, we must grant a far
greater age to the Right Whale than at first glance will seem reasonable.
In
old times, there seem to have prevailed the most curious fancies concerning
these blinds. One voyager in Purchas calls them the wondrous “whiskers” inside
of the whale's mouth;* another, “hogs' bristles”; a third old gentleman in
Hackluyt uses the following elegant language: “There are about two hundred and
fifty fins growing on each side of his upper chop, which arch over his tongue
on each side of his mouth.”
*This
reminds us that the Right Whale really has a sort of whisker, or rather a
moustache, consisting of a few scattered white hairs on the upper part of the
outer end of the lower jaw. Sometimes these tufts impart a rather brigandish
expression to his otherwise solemn countenance.
As
every one knows, these same “hogs' bristles,” “fins,” “whiskers,” “blinds,” or
whatever you please, furnish to the ladies their busks and other stiffening
contrivances. But in this particular, the demand has long been on the decline.
It was in Queen Anne's time that the bone was in its glory, the farthingale being
then all the fashion. And as those ancient dames moved about gaily, though in
the jaws of the whale, as you may say; even so, in a shower, with the like
thoughtlessness, do we nowadays fly under the same jaws for protection; the
umbrella being a tent spread over the same bone.
But
now forget all about blinds and whiskers for a moment, and, standing in the
Right Whale's mouth, look around you afresh. Seeing all these colonnades of
bone so methodically ranged about, would you not think you were inside of the
great Haarlem organ, and gazing upon its thousand pipes? For a carpet to the
organ we have a rug of the softest Turkey—the tongue, which is glued, as it
were, to the floor of the mouth. It is very fat and tender, and apt to tear in
pieces in hoisting it on deck. This particular tongue now before us; at a
passing glance I should say it was a six-barreler; that is, it will yield you
about that amount of oil.
Ere
this, you must have plainly seen the truth of what I started with—that the
Sperm Whale and the Right Whale have almost entirely different heads. To sum
up, then: in the Right Whale's there is no great well of sperm; no ivory teeth
at all; no long, slender mandible of a lower jaw, like the Sperm Whale's. Nor
in the Sperm Whale are there any of those blinds of bone; no huge lower lip;
and scarcely anything of a tongue. Again, the Right Whale has two external
spout-holes, the Sperm Whale only one.
Look
your last, now, on these venerable hooded heads, while they yet lie together;
for one will soon sink, unrecorded, in the sea; the other will not be very long
in following.
Can
you catch the expression of the Sperm Whale's there? It is the same he died
with, only some of the longer wrinkles in the forehead seem now faded away. I
think his broad brow to be full of a prairie-like placidity, born of a
speculative indifference as to death. But mark the other head's expression. See
that amazing lower lip, pressed by accident against the vessel's side, so as
firmly to embrace the jaw. Does not this whole head seem to speak of an
enormous practical resolution in facing death? This Right Whale I take to have
been a Stoic; the Sperm Whale, a Platonian, who might have taken up Spinoza in
his latter years.
CHAPTER
76. The Battering-Ram.
Ere
quitting, for the nonce, the Sperm Whale's head, I would have you, as a
sensible physiologist, simply—particularly remark its front aspect, in all its
compacted collectedness. I would have you investigate it now with the sole view
of forming to yourself some unexaggerated, intelligent estimate of whatever
battering-ram power may be lodged there. Here is a vital point; for you must
either satisfactorily settle this matter with yourself, or for ever remain an
infidel as to one of the most appalling, but not the less true events, perhaps
anywhere to be found in all recorded history.
You
observe that in the ordinary swimming position of the Sperm Whale, the front of
his head presents an almost wholly vertical plane to the water; you observe
that the lower part of that front slopes considerably backwards, so as to
furnish more of a retreat for the long socket which receives the boom-like
lower jaw; you observe that the mouth is entirely under the head, much in the
same way, indeed, as though your own mouth were entirely under your chin.
Moreover you observe that the whale has no external nose; and that what nose he
has—his spout hole—is on the top of his head; you observe that his eyes and
ears are at the sides of his head, nearly one third of his entire length from the
front. Wherefore, you must now have perceived that the front of the Sperm
Whale's head is a dead, blind wall, without a single organ or tender prominence
of any sort whatsoever. Furthermore, you are now to consider that only in the
extreme, lower, backward sloping part of the front of the head, is there the
slightest vestige of bone; and not till you get near twenty feet from the
forehead do you come to the full cranial development. So that this whole
enormous boneless mass is as one wad. Finally, though, as will soon be
revealed, its contents partly comprise the most delicate oil; yet, you are now
to be apprised of the nature of the substance which so impregnably invests all
that apparent effeminacy. In some previous place I have described to you how
the blubber wraps the body of the whale, as the rind wraps an orange. Just so
with the head; but with this difference: about the head this envelope, though
not so thick, is of a boneless toughness, inestimable by any man who has not
handled it. The severest pointed harpoon, the sharpest lance darted by the
strongest human arm, impotently rebounds from it. It is as though the forehead
of the Sperm Whale were paved with horses' hoofs. I do not think that any
sensation lurks in it.
Bethink
yourself also of another thing. When two large, loaded Indiamen chance to crowd
and crush towards each other in the docks, what do the sailors do? They do not
suspend between them, at the point of coming contact, any merely hard
substance, like iron or wood. No, they hold there a large, round wad of tow and
cork, enveloped in the thickest and toughest of ox-hide. That bravely and
uninjured takes the jam which would have snapped all their oaken handspikes and
iron crow-bars. By itself this sufficiently illustrates the obvious fact I
drive at. But supplementary to this, it has hypothetically occurred to me, that
as ordinary fish possess what is called a swimming bladder in them, capable, at
will, of distension or contraction; and as the Sperm Whale, as far as I know,
has no such provision in him; considering, too, the otherwise inexplicable
manner in which he now depresses his head altogether beneath the surface, and
anon swims with it high elevated out of the water; considering the unobstructed
elasticity of its envelope; considering the unique interior of his head; it has
hypothetically occurred to me, I say, that those mystical lung-celled
honeycombs there may possibly have some hitherto unknown and unsuspected
connexion with the outer air, so as to be susceptible to atmospheric distension
and contraction. If this be so, fancy the irresistibleness of that might, to
which the most impalpable and destructive of all elements contributes.
Now,
mark. Unerringly impelling this dead, impregnable, uninjurable wall, and this
most buoyant thing within; there swims behind it all a mass of tremendous life,
only to be adequately estimated as piled wood is—by the cord; and all obedient
to one volition, as the smallest insect. So that when I shall hereafter detail
to you all the specialities and concentrations of potency everywhere lurking in
this expansive monster; when I shall show you some of his more inconsiderable
braining feats; I trust you will have renounced all ignorant incredulity, and
be ready to abide by this; that though the Sperm Whale stove a passage through
the Isthmus of Darien, and mixed the Atlantic with the Pacific, you would not
elevate one hair of your eye-brow. For unless you own the whale, you are but a
provincial and sentimentalist in Truth. But clear Truth is a thing for
salamander giants only to encounter; how small the chances for the provincials
then? What befell the weakling youth lifting the dread goddess's veil at Lais?
CHAPTER
77. The Great Heidelburgh Tun.
Now
comes the Baling of the Case. But to comprehend it aright, you must know
something of the curious internal structure of the thing operated upon.
Regarding
the Sperm Whale's head as a solid oblong, you may, on an inclined plane,
sideways divide it into two quoins,* whereof the lower is the bony structure,
forming the cranium and jaws, and the upper an unctuous mass wholly free from
bones; its broad forward end forming the expanded vertical apparent forehead of
the whale. At the middle of the forehead horizontally subdivide this upper
quoin, and then you have two almost equal parts, which before were naturally
divided by an internal wall of a thick tendinous substance.
*Quoin
is not a Euclidean term. It belongs to the pure nautical mathematics. I know
not that it has been defined before. A quoin is a solid which differs from a
wedge in having its sharp end formed by the steep inclination of one side,
instead of the mutual tapering of both sides.
The
lower subdivided part, called the junk, is one immense honeycomb of oil, formed
by the crossing and recrossing, into ten thousand infiltrated cells, of tough
elastic white fibres throughout its whole extent. The upper part, known as the
Case, may be regarded as the great Heidelburgh Tun of the Sperm Whale. And as
that famous great tierce is mystically carved in front, so the whale's vast
plaited forehead forms innumerable strange devices for the emblematical
adornment of his wondrous tun. Moreover, as that of Heidelburgh was always
replenished with the most excellent of the wines of the Rhenish valleys, so the
tun of the whale contains by far the most precious of all his oily vintages;
namely, the highly-prized spermaceti, in its absolutely pure, limpid, and odoriferous
state. Nor is this precious substance found unalloyed in any other part of the
creature. Though in life it remains perfectly fluid, yet, upon exposure to the
air, after death, it soon begins to concrete; sending forth beautiful
crystalline shoots, as when the first thin delicate ice is just forming in
water. A large whale's case generally yields about five hundred gallons of
sperm, though from unavoidable circumstances, considerable of it is spilled,
leaks, and dribbles away, or is otherwise irrevocably lost in the ticklish
business of securing what you can.
I
know not with what fine and costly material the Heidelburgh Tun was coated
within, but in superlative richness that coating could not possibly have
compared with the silken pearl-coloured membrane, like the lining of a fine
pelisse, forming the inner surface of the Sperm Whale's case.
It
will have been seen that the Heidelburgh Tun of the Sperm Whale embraces the
entire length of the entire top of the head; and since—as has been elsewhere set
forth—the head embraces one third of the whole length of the creature, then
setting that length down at eighty feet for a good sized whale, you have more
than twenty-six feet for the depth of the tun, when it is lengthwise hoisted up
and down against a ship's side.
As
in decapitating the whale, the operator's instrument is brought close to the
spot where an entrance is subsequently forced into the spermaceti magazine; he
has, therefore, to be uncommonly heedful, lest a careless, untimely stroke
should invade the sanctuary and wastingly let out its invaluable contents. It
is this decapitated end of the head, also, which is at last elevated out of the
water, and retained in that position by the enormous cutting tackles, whose
hempen combinations, on one side, make quite a wilderness of ropes in that
quarter.
Thus
much being said, attend now, I pray you, to that marvellous and—in this
particular instance—almost fatal operation whereby the Sperm Whale's great
Heidelburgh Tun is tapped.
CHAPTER
78. Cistern and Buckets.
Nimble
as a cat, Tashtego mounts aloft; and without altering his erect posture, runs
straight out upon the overhanging mainyard-arm, to the part where it exactly
projects over the hoisted Tun. He has carried with him a light tackle called a
whip, consisting of only two parts, travelling through a single-sheaved block.
Securing this block, so that it hangs down from the yard-arm, he swings one end
of the rope, till it is caught and firmly held by a hand on deck. Then,
hand-over-hand, down the other part, the Indian drops through the air, till
dexterously he lands on the summit of the head. There—still high elevated above
the rest of the company, to whom he vivaciously cries—he seems some Turkish
Muezzin calling the good people to prayers from the top of a tower. A
short-handled sharp spade being sent up to him, he diligently searches for the
proper place to begin breaking into the Tun. In this business he proceeds very
heedfully, like a treasure-hunter in some old house, sounding the walls to find
where the gold is masoned in. By the time this cautious search is over, a stout
iron-bound bucket, precisely like a well-bucket, has been attached to one end
of the whip; while the other end, being stretched across the deck, is there
held by two or three alert hands. These last now hoist the bucket within grasp
of the Indian, to whom another person has reached up a very long pole.
Inserting this pole into the bucket, Tashtego downward guides the bucket into
the Tun, till it entirely disappears; then giving the word to the seamen at the
whip, up comes the bucket again, all bubbling like a dairy-maid's pail of new
milk. Carefully lowered from its height, the full-freighted vessel is caught by
an appointed hand, and quickly emptied into a large tub. Then remounting aloft,
it again goes through the same round until the deep cistern will yield no more.
Towards the end, Tashtego has to ram his long pole harder and harder, and
deeper and deeper into the Tun, until some twenty feet of the pole have gone
down.
Now,
the people of the Pequod had been baling some time in this way; several tubs
had been filled with the fragrant sperm; when all at once a queer accident
happened. Whether it was that Tashtego, that wild Indian, was so heedless and
reckless as to let go for a moment his one-handed hold on the great cabled
tackles suspending the head; or whether the place where he stood was so
treacherous and oozy; or whether the Evil One himself would have it to fall out
so, without stating his particular reasons; how it was exactly, there is no
telling now; but, on a sudden, as the eightieth or ninetieth bucket came
suckingly up—my God! poor Tashtego—like the twin reciprocating bucket in a
veritable well, dropped head-foremost down into this great Tun of Heidelburgh,
and with a horrible oily gurgling, went clean out of sight!
“Man
overboard!” cried Daggoo, who amid the general consternation first came to his
senses. “Swing the bucket this way!” and putting one foot into it, so as the
better to secure his slippery hand-hold on the whip itself, the hoisters ran
him high up to the top of the head, almost before Tashtego could have reached
its interior bottom. Meantime, there was a terrible tumult. Looking over the
side, they saw the before lifeless head throbbing and heaving just below the
surface of the sea, as if that moment seized with some momentous idea; whereas
it was only the poor Indian unconsciously revealing by those struggles the
perilous depth to which he had sunk.
At
this instant, while Daggoo, on the summit of the head, was clearing the
whip—which had somehow got foul of the great cutting tackles—a sharp cracking
noise was heard; and to the unspeakable horror of all, one of the two enormous
hooks suspending the head tore out, and with a vast vibration the enormous mass
sideways swung, till the drunk ship reeled and shook as if smitten by an
iceberg. The one remaining hook, upon which the entire strain now depended,
seemed every instant to be on the point of giving way; an event still more
likely from the violent motions of the head.
“Come
down, come down!” yelled the seamen to Daggoo, but with one hand holding on to
the heavy tackles, so that if the head should drop, he would still remain
suspended; the negro having cleared the foul line, rammed down the bucket into
the now collapsed well, meaning that the buried harpooneer should grasp it, and
so be hoisted out.
“In
heaven's name, man,” cried Stubb, “are you ramming home a cartridge
there?—Avast! How will that help him; jamming that iron-bound bucket on top of
his head? Avast, will ye!”
“Stand
clear of the tackle!” cried a voice like the bursting of a rocket.
Almost
in the same instant, with a thunder-boom, the enormous mass dropped into the
sea, like Niagara's Table-Rock into the whirlpool; the suddenly relieved hull
rolled away from it, to far down her glittering copper; and all caught their
breath, as half swinging—now over the sailors' heads, and now over the
water—Daggoo, through a thick mist of spray, was dimly beheld clinging to the
pendulous tackles, while poor, buried-alive Tashtego was sinking utterly down
to the bottom of the sea! But hardly had the blinding vapor cleared away, when
a naked figure with a boarding-sword in his hand, was for one swift moment seen
hovering over the bulwarks. The next, a loud splash announced that my brave
Queequeg had dived to the rescue. One packed rush was made to the side, and
every eye counted every ripple, as moment followed moment, and no sign of
either the sinker or the diver could be seen. Some hands now jumped into a boat
alongside, and pushed a little off from the ship.
“Ha!
ha!” cried Daggoo, all at once, from his now quiet, swinging perch overhead;
and looking further off from the side, we saw an arm thrust upright from the
blue waves; a sight strange to see, as an arm thrust forth from the grass over
a grave.
“Both!
both!—it is both!”—cried Daggoo again with a joyful shout; and soon after,
Queequeg was seen boldly striking out with one hand, and with the other
clutching the long hair of the Indian. Drawn into the waiting boat, they were
quickly brought to the deck; but Tashtego was long in coming to, and Queequeg
did not look very brisk.
Now,
how had this noble rescue been accomplished? Why, diving after the slowly
descending head, Queequeg with his keen sword had made side lunges near its
bottom, so as to scuttle a large hole there; then dropping his sword, had
thrust his long arm far inwards and upwards, and so hauled out poor Tash by the
head. He averred, that upon first thrusting in for him, a leg was presented;
but well knowing that that was not as it ought to be, and might occasion great
trouble;—he had thrust back the leg, and by a dexterous heave and toss, had
wrought a somerset upon the Indian; so that with the next trial, he came forth
in the good old way—head foremost. As for the great head itself, that was doing
as well as could be expected.
And
thus, through the courage and great skill in obstetrics of Queequeg, the
deliverance, or rather, delivery of Tashtego, was successfully accomplished, in
the teeth, too, of the most untoward and apparently hopeless impediments; which
is a lesson by no means to be forgotten. Midwifery should be taught in the same
course with fencing and boxing, riding and rowing.
I
know that this queer adventure of the Gay-Header's will be sure to seem
incredible to some landsmen, though they themselves may have either seen or
heard of some one's falling into a cistern ashore; an accident which not seldom
happens, and with much less reason too than the Indian's, considering the
exceeding slipperiness of the curb of the Sperm Whale's well.
But,
peradventure, it may be sagaciously urged, how is this? We thought the tissued,
infiltrated head of the Sperm Whale, was the lightest and most corky part about
him; and yet thou makest it sink in an element of a far greater specific
gravity than itself. We have thee there. Not at all, but I have ye; for at the
time poor Tash fell in, the case had been nearly emptied of its lighter
contents, leaving little but the dense tendinous wall of the well—a double
welded, hammered substance, as I have before said, much heavier than the sea
water, and a lump of which sinks in it like lead almost. But the tendency to
rapid sinking in this substance was in the present instance materially counteracted
by the other parts of the head remaining undetached from it, so that it sank
very slowly and deliberately indeed, affording Queequeg a fair chance for
performing his agile obstetrics on the run, as you may say. Yes, it was a
running delivery, so it was.
Now,
had Tashtego perished in that head, it had been a very precious perishing;
smothered in the very whitest and daintiest of fragrant spermaceti; coffined,
hearsed, and tombed in the secret inner chamber and sanctum sanctorum of the
whale. Only one sweeter end can readily be recalled—the delicious death of an
Ohio honey-hunter, who seeking honey in the crotch of a hollow tree, found such
exceeding store of it, that leaning too far over, it sucked him in, so that he
died embalmed. How many, think ye, have likewise fallen into Plato's honey
head, and sweetly perished there?
CHAPTER
79. The Prairie.
To
scan the lines of his face, or feel the bumps on the head of this Leviathan;
this is a thing which no Physiognomist or Phrenologist has as yet undertaken.
Such an enterprise would seem almost as hopeful as for Lavater to have
scrutinized the wrinkles on the Rock of Gibraltar, or for Gall to have mounted
a ladder and manipulated the Dome of the Pantheon. Still, in that famous work
of his, Lavater not only treats of the various faces of men, but also
attentively studies the faces of horses, birds, serpents, and fish; and dwells
in detail upon the modifications of expression discernible therein. Nor have
Gall and his disciple Spurzheim failed to throw out some hints touching the
phrenological characteristics of other beings than man. Therefore, though I am
but ill qualified for a pioneer, in the application of these two semi-sciences
to the whale, I will do my endeavor. I try all things; I achieve what I can.
Physiognomically
regarded, the Sperm Whale is an anomalous creature. He has no proper nose. And
since the nose is the central and most conspicuous of the features; and since
it perhaps most modifies and finally controls their combined expression; hence
it would seem that its entire absence, as an external appendage, must very
largely affect the countenance of the whale. For as in landscape gardening, a
spire, cupola, monument, or tower of some sort, is deemed almost indispensable
to the completion of the scene; so no face can be physiognomically in keeping
without the elevated open-work belfry of the nose. Dash the nose from Phidias's
marble Jove, and what a sorry remainder! Nevertheless, Leviathan is of so
mighty a magnitude, all his proportions are so stately, that the same
deficiency which in the sculptured Jove were hideous, in him is no blemish at all.
Nay, it is an added grandeur. A nose to the whale would have been impertinent.
As on your physiognomical voyage you sail round his vast head in your
jolly-boat, your noble conceptions of him are never insulted by the reflection
that he has a nose to be pulled. A pestilent conceit, which so often will
insist upon obtruding even when beholding the mightiest royal beadle on his
throne.
In
some particulars, perhaps the most imposing physiognomical view to be had of
the Sperm Whale, is that of the full front of his head. This aspect is sublime.
In
thought, a fine human brow is like the East when troubled with the morning. In
the repose of the pasture, the curled brow of the bull has a touch of the grand
in it. Pushing heavy cannon up mountain defiles, the elephant's brow is
majestic. Human or animal, the mystical brow is as that great golden seal
affixed by the German emperors to their decrees. It signifies—“God: done this
day by my hand.” But in most creatures, nay in man himself, very often the brow
is but a mere strip of alpine land lying along the snow line. Few are the
foreheads which like Shakespeare's or Melancthon's rise so high, and descend so
low, that the eyes themselves seem clear, eternal, tideless mountain lakes; and
all above them in the forehead's wrinkles, you seem to track the antlered
thoughts descending there to drink, as the Highland hunters track the snow
prints of the deer. But in the great Sperm Whale, this high and mighty god-like
dignity inherent in the brow is so immensely amplified, that gazing on it, in
that full front view, you feel the Deity and the dread powers more forcibly
than in beholding any other object in living nature. For you see no one point
precisely; not one distinct feature is revealed; no nose, eyes, ears, or mouth;
no face; he has none, proper; nothing but that one broad firmament of a
forehead, pleated with riddles; dumbly lowering with the doom of boats, and
ships, and men. Nor, in profile, does this wondrous brow diminish; though that
way viewed its grandeur does not domineer upon you so. In profile, you plainly
perceive that horizontal, semi-crescentic depression in the forehead's middle,
which, in man, is Lavater's mark of genius.
But
how? Genius in the Sperm Whale? Has the Sperm Whale ever written a book, spoken
a speech? No, his great genius is declared in his doing nothing particular to
prove it. It is moreover declared in his pyramidical silence. And this reminds
me that had the great Sperm Whale been known to the young Orient World, he
would have been deified by their child-magian thoughts. They deified the
crocodile of the Nile, because the crocodile is tongueless; and the Sperm Whale
has no tongue, or at least it is so exceedingly small, as to be incapable of
protrusion. If hereafter any highly cultured, poetical nation shall lure back
to their birth-right, the merry May-day gods of old; and livingly enthrone them
again in the now egotistical sky; in the now unhaunted hill; then be sure,
exalted to Jove's high seat, the great Sperm Whale shall lord it.
Champollion
deciphered the wrinkled granite hieroglyphics. But there is no Champollion to
decipher the Egypt of every man's and every being's face. Physiognomy, like
every other human science, is but a passing fable. If then, Sir William Jones,
who read in thirty languages, could not read the simplest peasant's face in its
profounder and more subtle meanings, how may unlettered Ishmael hope to read
the awful Chaldee of the Sperm Whale's brow? I but put that brow before you.
Read it if you can.
CHAPTER
80. The Nut.
If
the Sperm Whale be physiognomically a Sphinx, to the phrenologist his brain
seems that geometrical circle which it is impossible to square.
In
the full-grown creature the skull will measure at least twenty feet in length.
Unhinge the lower jaw, and the side view of this skull is as the side of a
moderately inclined plane resting throughout on a level base. But in life—as we
have elsewhere seen—this inclined plane is angularly filled up, and almost
squared by the enormous superincumbent mass of the junk and sperm. At the high
end the skull forms a crater to bed that part of the mass; while under the long
floor of this crater—in another cavity seldom exceeding ten inches in length
and as many in depth—reposes the mere handful of this monster's brain. The
brain is at least twenty feet from his apparent forehead in life; it is hidden
away behind its vast outworks, like the innermost citadel within the amplified
fortifications of Quebec. So like a choice casket is it secreted in him, that I
have known some whalemen who peremptorily deny that the Sperm Whale has any
other brain than that palpable semblance of one formed by the cubic-yards of
his sperm magazine. Lying in strange folds, courses, and convolutions, to their
apprehensions, it seems more in keeping with the idea of his general might to
regard that mystic part of him as the seat of his intelligence.
It
is plain, then, that phrenologically the head of this Leviathan, in the
creature's living intact state, is an entire delusion. As for his true brain,
you can then see no indications of it, nor feel any. The whale, like all things
that are mighty, wears a false brow to the common world.
If
you unload his skull of its spermy heaps and then take a rear view of its rear
end, which is the high end, you will be struck by its resemblance to the human
skull, beheld in the same situation, and from the same point of view. Indeed,
place this reversed skull (scaled down to the human magnitude) among a plate of
men's skulls, and you would involuntarily confound it with them; and remarking
the depressions on one part of its summit, in phrenological phrase you would say—This
man had no self-esteem, and no veneration. And by those negations, considered
along with the affirmative fact of his prodigious bulk and power, you can best
form to yourself the truest, though not the most exhilarating conception of
what the most exalted potency is.
But
if from the comparative dimensions of the whale's proper brain, you deem it
incapable of being adequately charted, then I have another idea for you. If you
attentively regard almost any quadruped's spine, you will be struck with the
resemblance of its vertebræ to a strung necklace of dwarfed skulls, all bearing
rudimental resemblance to the skull proper. It is a German conceit, that the
vertebræ are absolutely undeveloped skulls. But the curious external
resemblance, I take it the Germans were not the first men to perceive. A
foreign friend once pointed it out to me, in the skeleton of a foe he had
slain, and with the vertebræ of which he was inlaying, in a sort of
basso-relievo, the beaked prow of his canoe. Now, I consider that the
phrenologists have omitted an important thing in not pushing their
investigations from the cerebellum through the spinal canal. For I believe that
much of a man's character will be found betokened in his backbone. I would
rather feel your spine than your skull, whoever you are. A thin joist of a
spine never yet upheld a full and noble soul. I rejoice in my spine, as in the
firm audacious staff of that flag which I fling half out to the world.
Apply
this spinal branch of phrenology to the Sperm Whale. His cranial cavity is
continuous with the first neck-vertebra; and in that vertebra the bottom of the
spinal canal will measure ten inches across, being eight in height, and of a
triangular figure with the base downwards. As it passes through the remaining vertebræ
the canal tapers in size, but for a considerable distance remains of large
capacity. Now, of course, this canal is filled with much the same strangely
fibrous substance—the spinal cord—as the brain; and directly communicates with
the brain. And what is still more, for many feet after emerging from the
brain's cavity, the spinal cord remains of an undecreasing girth, almost equal
to that of the brain. Under all these circumstances, would it be unreasonable
to survey and map out the whale's spine phrenologically? For, viewed in this
light, the wonderful comparative smallness of his brain proper is more than
compensated by the wonderful comparative magnitude of his spinal cord.
But
leaving this hint to operate as it may with the phrenologists, I would merely
assume the spinal theory for a moment, in reference to the Sperm Whale's hump.
This august hump, if I mistake not, rises over one of the larger vertebræ, and
is, therefore, in some sort, the outer convex mould of it. From its relative
situation then, I should call this high hump the organ of firmness or
indomitableness in the Sperm Whale. And that the great monster is indomitable,
you will yet have reason to know.
CHAPTER
81. The Pequod Meets The Virgin.
The
predestinated day arrived, and we duly met the ship Jungfrau, Derick De Deer,
master, of Bremen.
At
one time the greatest whaling people in the world, the Dutch and Germans are
now among the least; but here and there at very wide intervals of latitude and
longitude, you still occasionally meet with their flag in the Pacific.
For
some reason, the Jungfrau seemed quite eager to pay her respects. While yet
some distance from the Pequod, she rounded to, and dropping a boat, her captain
was impelled towards us, impatiently standing in the bows instead of the stern.
“What
has he in his hand there?” cried Starbuck, pointing to something wavingly held
by the German. “Impossible!—a lamp-feeder!”
“Not
that,” said Stubb, “no, no, it's a coffee-pot, Mr. Starbuck; he's coming off to
make us our coffee, is the Yarman; don't you see that big tin can there
alongside of him?—that's his boiling water. Oh! he's all right, is the Yarman.”
“Go
along with you,” cried Flask, “it's a lamp-feeder and an oil-can. He's out of
oil, and has come a-begging.”
However
curious it may seem for an oil-ship to be borrowing oil on the whale-ground,
and however much it may invertedly contradict the old proverb about carrying
coals to Newcastle, yet sometimes such a thing really happens; and in the
present case Captain Derick De Deer did indubitably conduct a lamp-feeder as
Flask did declare.
As
he mounted the deck, Ahab abruptly accosted him, without at all heeding what he
had in his hand; but in his broken lingo, the German soon evinced his complete
ignorance of the White Whale; immediately turning the conversation to his
lamp-feeder and oil can, with some remarks touching his having to turn into his
hammock at night in profound darkness—his last drop of Bremen oil being gone,
and not a single flying-fish yet captured to supply the deficiency; concluding
by hinting that his ship was indeed what in the Fishery is technically called a
clean one (that is, an empty one), well deserving the name of Jungfrau or the
Virgin.
His
necessities supplied, Derick departed; but he had not gained his ship's side,
when whales were almost simultaneously raised from the mast-heads of both
vessels; and so eager for the chase was Derick, that without pausing to put his
oil-can and lamp-feeder aboard, he slewed round his boat and made after the
leviathan lamp-feeders.
Now,
the game having risen to leeward, he and the other three German boats that soon
followed him, had considerably the start of the Pequod's keels. There were
eight whales, an average pod. Aware of their danger, they were going all
abreast with great speed straight before the wind, rubbing their flanks as
closely as so many spans of horses in harness. They left a great, wide wake, as
though continually unrolling a great wide parchment upon the sea.
Full
in this rapid wake, and many fathoms in the rear, swam a huge, humped old bull,
which by his comparatively slow progress, as well as by the unusual yellowish
incrustations overgrowing him, seemed afflicted with the jaundice, or some
other infirmity. Whether this whale belonged to the pod in advance, seemed
questionable; for it is not customary for such venerable leviathans to be at
all social. Nevertheless, he stuck to their wake, though indeed their back
water must have retarded him, because the white-bone or swell at his broad
muzzle was a dashed one, like the swell formed when two hostile currents meet.
His spout was short, slow, and laborious; coming forth with a choking sort of
gush, and spending itself in torn shreds, followed by strange subterranean
commotions in him, which seemed to have egress at his other buried extremity,
causing the waters behind him to upbubble.
“Who's
got some paregoric?” said Stubb, “he has the stomach-ache, I'm afraid. Lord,
think of having half an acre of stomach-ache! Adverse winds are holding mad
Christmas in him, boys. It's the first foul wind I ever knew to blow from
astern; but look, did ever whale yaw so before? it must be, he's lost his
tiller.”
As
an overladen Indiaman bearing down the Hindostan coast with a deck load of
frightened horses, careens, buries, rolls, and wallows on her way; so did this
old whale heave his aged bulk, and now and then partly turning over on his
cumbrous rib-ends, expose the cause of his devious wake in the unnatural stump
of his starboard fin. Whether he had lost that fin in battle, or had been born
without it, it were hard to say.
“Only
wait a bit, old chap, and I'll give ye a sling for that wounded arm,” cried
cruel Flask, pointing to the whale-line near him.
“Mind
he don't sling thee with it,” cried Starbuck. “Give way, or the German will
have him.”
With
one intent all the combined rival boats were pointed for this one fish, because
not only was he the largest, and therefore the most valuable whale, but he was
nearest to them, and the other whales were going with such great velocity,
moreover, as almost to defy pursuit for the time. At this juncture the Pequod's
keels had shot by the three German boats last lowered; but from the great start
he had had, Derick's boat still led the chase, though every moment neared by
his foreign rivals. The only thing they feared, was, that from being already so
nigh to his mark, he would be enabled to dart his iron before they could
completely overtake and pass him. As for Derick, he seemed quite confident that
this would be the case, and occasionally with a deriding gesture shook his
lamp-feeder at the other boats.
“The
ungracious and ungrateful dog!” cried Starbuck; “he mocks and dares me with the
very poor-box I filled for him not five minutes ago!”—then in his old intense
whisper—“Give way, greyhounds! Dog to it!”
“I
tell ye what it is, men”—cried Stubb to his crew—“it's against my religion to
get mad; but I'd like to eat that villainous Yarman—Pull—won't ye? Are ye going
to let that rascal beat ye? Do ye love brandy? A hogshead of brandy, then, to
the best man. Come, why don't some of ye burst a blood-vessel? Who's that been
dropping an anchor overboard—we don't budge an inch—we're becalmed. Halloo,
here's grass growing in the boat's bottom—and by the Lord, the mast there's
budding. This won't do, boys. Look at that Yarman! The short and long of it is,
men, will ye spit fire or not?”
“Oh!
see the suds he makes!” cried Flask, dancing up and down—“What a hump—Oh, do
pile on the beef—lays like a log! Oh! my lads, do spring—slap-jacks and quahogs
for supper, you know, my lads—baked clams and muffins—oh, do, do, spring,—he's
a hundred barreller—don't lose him now—don't oh, don't!—see that Yarman—Oh,
won't ye pull for your duff, my lads—such a sog! such a sogger! Don't ye love
sperm? There goes three thousand dollars, men!—a bank!—a whole bank! The bank
of England!—Oh, do, do, do!—What's that Yarman about now?”
At
this moment Derick was in the act of pitching his lamp-feeder at the advancing
boats, and also his oil-can; perhaps with the double view of retarding his
rivals' way, and at the same time economically accelerating his own by the
momentary impetus of the backward toss.
“The
unmannerly Dutch dogger!” cried Stubb. “Pull now, men, like fifty thousand
line-of-battle-ship loads of red-haired devils. What d'ye say, Tashtego; are
you the man to snap your spine in two-and-twenty pieces for the honor of old
Gayhead? What d'ye say?”
“I
say, pull like god-dam,”—cried the Indian.
Fiercely,
but evenly incited by the taunts of the German, the Pequod's three boats now
began ranging almost abreast; and, so disposed, momentarily neared him. In that
fine, loose, chivalrous attitude of the headsman when drawing near to his prey,
the three mates stood up proudly, occasionally backing the after oarsman with
an exhilarating cry of, “There she slides, now! Hurrah for the white-ash
breeze! Down with the Yarman! Sail over him!”
But
so decided an original start had Derick had, that spite of all their gallantry,
he would have proved the victor in this race, had not a righteous judgment
descended upon him in a crab which caught the blade of his midship oarsman.
While this clumsy lubber was striving to free his white-ash, and while, in
consequence, Derick's boat was nigh to capsizing, and he thundering away at his
men in a mighty rage;—that was a good time for Starbuck, Stubb, and Flask. With
a shout, they took a mortal start forwards, and slantingly ranged up on the
German's quarter. An instant more, and all four boats were diagonically in the
whale's immediate wake, while stretching from them, on both sides, was the
foaming swell that he made.
It
was a terrific, most pitiable, and maddening sight. The whale was now going
head out, and sending his spout before him in a continual tormented jet; while
his one poor fin beat his side in an agony of fright. Now to this hand, now to
that, he yawed in his faltering flight, and still at every billow that he
broke, he spasmodically sank in the sea, or sideways rolled towards the sky his
one beating fin. So have I seen a bird with clipped wing making affrighted
broken circles in the air, vainly striving to escape the piratical hawks. But
the bird has a voice, and with plaintive cries will make known her fear; but
the fear of this vast dumb brute of the sea, was chained up and enchanted in
him; he had no voice, save that choking respiration through his spiracle, and
this made the sight of him unspeakably pitiable; while still, in his amazing
bulk, portcullis jaw, and omnipotent tail, there was enough to appal the
stoutest man who so pitied.
Seeing
now that but a very few moments more would give the Pequod's boats the
advantage, and rather than be thus foiled of his game, Derick chose to hazard
what to him must have seemed a most unusually long dart, ere the last chance
would for ever escape.
But
no sooner did his harpooneer stand up for the stroke, than all three
tigers—Queequeg, Tashtego, Daggoo—instinctively sprang to their feet, and
standing in a diagonal row, simultaneously pointed their barbs; and darted over
the head of the German harpooneer, their three Nantucket irons entered the
whale. Blinding vapors of foam and white-fire! The three boats, in the first
fury of the whale's headlong rush, bumped the German's aside with such force,
that both Derick and his baffled harpooneer were spilled out, and sailed over
by the three flying keels.
“Don't
be afraid, my butter-boxes,” cried Stubb, casting a passing glance upon them as
he shot by; “ye'll be picked up presently—all right—I saw some sharks
astern—St. Bernard's dogs, you know—relieve distressed travellers. Hurrah! this
is the way to sail now. Every keel a sunbeam! Hurrah!—Here we go like three tin
kettles at the tail of a mad cougar! This puts me in mind of fastening to an
elephant in a tilbury on a plain—makes the wheel-spokes fly, boys, when you
fasten to him that way; and there's danger of being pitched out too, when you
strike a hill. Hurrah! this is the way a fellow feels when he's going to Davy
Jones—all a rush down an endless inclined plane! Hurrah! this whale carries the
everlasting mail!”
But
the monster's run was a brief one. Giving a sudden gasp, he tumultuously
sounded. With a grating rush, the three lines flew round the loggerheads with
such a force as to gouge deep grooves in them; while so fearful were the
harpooneers that this rapid sounding would soon exhaust the lines, that using
all their dexterous might, they caught repeated smoking turns with the rope to
hold on; till at last—owing to the perpendicular strain from the lead-lined
chocks of the boats, whence the three ropes went straight down into the
blue—the gunwales of the bows were almost even with the water, while the three
sterns tilted high in the air. And the whale soon ceasing to sound, for some
time they remained in that attitude, fearful of expending more line, though the
position was a little ticklish. But though boats have been taken down and lost
in this way, yet it is this “holding on,” as it is called; this hooking up by
the sharp barbs of his live flesh from the back; this it is that often torments
the Leviathan into soon rising again to meet the sharp lance of his foes. Yet
not to speak of the peril of the thing, it is to be doubted whether this course
is always the best; for it is but reasonable to presume, that the longer the
stricken whale stays under water, the more he is exhausted. Because, owing to
the enormous surface of him—in a full grown sperm whale something less than
2000 square feet—the pressure of the water is immense. We all know what an
astonishing atmospheric weight we ourselves stand up under; even here,
above-ground, in the air; how vast, then, the burden of a whale, bearing on his
back a column of two hundred fathoms of ocean! It must at least equal the
weight of fifty atmospheres. One whaleman has estimated it at the weight of
twenty line-of-battle ships, with all their guns, and stores, and men on board.
As
the three boats lay there on that gently rolling sea, gazing down into its
eternal blue noon; and as not a single groan or cry of any sort, nay, not so
much as a ripple or a bubble came up from its depths; what landsman would have
thought, that beneath all that silence and placidity, the utmost monster of the
seas was writhing and wrenching in agony! Not eight inches of perpendicular
rope were visible at the bows. Seems it credible that by three such thin
threads the great Leviathan was suspended like the big weight to an eight day
clock. Suspended? and to what? To three bits of board. Is this the creature of
whom it was once so triumphantly said—“Canst thou fill his skin with barbed
irons? or his head with fish-spears? The sword of him that layeth at him cannot
hold, the spear, the dart, nor the habergeon: he esteemeth iron as straw; the
arrow cannot make him flee; darts are counted as stubble; he laugheth at the
shaking of a spear!” This the creature? this he? Oh! that unfulfilments should
follow the prophets. For with the strength of a thousand thighs in his tail,
Leviathan had run his head under the mountains of the sea, to hide him from the
Pequod's fish-spears!
In
that sloping afternoon sunlight, the shadows that the three boats sent down
beneath the surface, must have been long enough and broad enough to shade half
Xerxes' army. Who can tell how appalling to the wounded whale must have been
such huge phantoms flitting over his head!
“Stand
by, men; he stirs,” cried Starbuck, as the three lines suddenly vibrated in the
water, distinctly conducting upwards to them, as by magnetic wires, the life
and death throbs of the whale, so that every oarsman felt them in his seat. The
next moment, relieved in great part from the downward strain at the bows, the
boats gave a sudden bounce upwards, as a small icefield will, when a dense herd
of white bears are scared from it into the sea.
“Haul
in! Haul in!” cried Starbuck again; “he's rising.”
The
lines, of which, hardly an instant before, not one hand's breadth could have
been gained, were now in long quick coils flung back all dripping into the
boats, and soon the whale broke water within two ship's lengths of the hunters.
His
motions plainly denoted his extreme exhaustion. In most land animals there are
certain valves or flood-gates in many of their veins, whereby when wounded, the
blood is in some degree at least instantly shut off in certain directions. Not
so with the whale; one of whose peculiarities it is to have an entire
non-valvular structure of the blood-vessels, so that when pierced even by so
small a point as a harpoon, a deadly drain is at once begun upon his whole
arterial system; and when this is heightened by the extraordinary pressure of
water at a great distance below the surface, his life may be said to pour from
him in incessant streams. Yet so vast is the quantity of blood in him, and so
distant and numerous its interior fountains, that he will keep thus bleeding
and bleeding for a considerable period; even as in a drought a river will flow,
whose source is in the well-springs of far-off and undiscernible hills. Even
now, when the boats pulled upon this whale, and perilously drew over his
swaying flukes, and the lances were darted into him, they were followed by
steady jets from the new made wound, which kept continually playing, while the
natural spout-hole in his head was only at intervals, however rapid, sending
its affrighted moisture into the air. From this last vent no blood yet came,
because no vital part of him had thus far been struck. His life, as they
significantly call it, was untouched.
As
the boats now more closely surrounded him, the whole upper part of his form,
with much of it that is ordinarily submerged, was plainly revealed. His eyes,
or rather the places where his eyes had been, were beheld. As strange misgrown
masses gather in the knot-holes of the noblest oaks when prostrate, so from the
points which the whale's eyes had once occupied, now protruded blind bulbs,
horribly pitiable to see. But pity there was none. For all his old age, and his
one arm, and his blind eyes, he must die the death and be murdered, in order to
light the gay bridals and other merry-makings of men, and also to illuminate
the solemn churches that preach unconditional inoffensiveness by all to all.
Still rolling in his blood, at last he partially disclosed a strangely
discoloured bunch or protuberance, the size of a bushel, low down on the flank.
“A
nice spot,” cried Flask; “just let me prick him there once.”
“Avast!”
cried Starbuck, “there's no need of that!”
But
humane Starbuck was too late. At the instant of the dart an ulcerous jet shot
from this cruel wound, and goaded by it into more than sufferable anguish, the
whale now spouting thick blood, with swift fury blindly darted at the craft,
bespattering them and their glorying crews all over with showers of gore,
capsizing Flask's boat and marring the bows. It was his death stroke. For, by
this time, so spent was he by loss of blood, that he helplessly rolled away
from the wreck he had made; lay panting on his side, impotently flapped with
his stumped fin, then over and over slowly revolved like a waning world; turned
up the white secrets of his belly; lay like a log, and died. It was most
piteous, that last expiring spout. As when by unseen hands the water is
gradually drawn off from some mighty fountain, and with half-stifled melancholy
gurglings the spray-column lowers and lowers to the ground—so the last long
dying spout of the whale.
Soon,
while the crews were awaiting the arrival of the ship, the body showed symptoms
of sinking with all its treasures unrifled. Immediately, by Starbuck's orders,
lines were secured to it at different points, so that ere long every boat was a
buoy; the sunken whale being suspended a few inches beneath them by the cords.
By very heedful management, when the ship drew nigh, the whale was transferred
to her side, and was strongly secured there by the stiffest fluke-chains, for it
was plain that unless artificially upheld, the body would at once sink to the
bottom.
It
so chanced that almost upon first cutting into him with the spade, the entire
length of a corroded harpoon was found imbedded in his flesh, on the lower part
of the bunch before described. But as the stumps of harpoons are frequently
found in the dead bodies of captured whales, with the flesh perfectly healed
around them, and no prominence of any kind to denote their place; therefore,
there must needs have been some other unknown reason in the present case fully
to account for the ulceration alluded to. But still more curious was the fact
of a lance-head of stone being found in him, not far from the buried iron, the
flesh perfectly firm about it. Who had darted that stone lance? And when? It
might have been darted by some Nor' West Indian long before America was
discovered.
What
other marvels might have been rummaged out of this monstrous cabinet there is
no telling. But a sudden stop was put to further discoveries, by the ship's
being unprecedentedly dragged over sideways to the sea, owing to the body's
immensely increasing tendency to sink. However, Starbuck, who had the ordering
of affairs, hung on to it to the last; hung on to it so resolutely, indeed,
that when at length the ship would have been capsized, if still persisting in
locking arms with the body; then, when the command was given to break clear
from it, such was the immovable strain upon the timber-heads to which the
fluke-chains and cables were fastened, that it was impossible to cast them off.
Meantime everything in the Pequod was aslant. To cross to the other side of the
deck was like walking up the steep gabled roof of a house. The ship groaned and
gasped. Many of the ivory inlayings of her bulwarks and cabins were started
from their places, by the unnatural dislocation. In vain handspikes and crows
were brought to bear upon the immovable fluke-chains, to pry them adrift from
the timberheads; and so low had the whale now settled that the submerged ends
could not be at all approached, while every moment whole tons of ponderosity
seemed added to the sinking bulk, and the ship seemed on the point of going
over.
“Hold
on, hold on, won't ye?” cried Stubb to the body, “don't be in such a devil of a
hurry to sink! By thunder, men, we must do something or go for it. No use
prying there; avast, I say with your handspikes, and run one of ye for a prayer
book and a pen-knife, and cut the big chains.”
“Knife?
Aye, aye,” cried Queequeg, and seizing the carpenter's heavy hatchet, he leaned
out of a porthole, and steel to iron, began slashing at the largest
fluke-chains. But a few strokes, full of sparks, were given, when the exceeding
strain effected the rest. With a terrific snap, every fastening went adrift; the
ship righted, the carcase sank.
Now,
this occasional inevitable sinking of the recently killed Sperm Whale is a very
curious thing; nor has any fisherman yet adequately accounted for it. Usually
the dead Sperm Whale floats with great buoyancy, with its side or belly
considerably elevated above the surface. If the only whales that thus sank were
old, meagre, and broken-hearted creatures, their pads of lard diminished and
all their bones heavy and rheumatic; then you might with some reason assert
that this sinking is caused by an uncommon specific gravity in the fish so
sinking, consequent upon this absence of buoyant matter in him. But it is not
so. For young whales, in the highest health, and swelling with noble
aspirations, prematurely cut off in the warm flush and May of life, with all
their panting lard about them; even these brawny, buoyant heroes do sometimes
sink.
Be
it said, however, that the Sperm Whale is far less liable to this accident than
any other species. Where one of that sort go down, twenty Right Whales do. This
difference in the species is no doubt imputable in no small degree to the
greater quantity of bone in the Right Whale; his Venetian blinds alone
sometimes weighing more than a ton; from this incumbrance the Sperm Whale is
wholly free. But there are instances where, after the lapse of many hours or
several days, the sunken whale again rises, more buoyant than in life. But the
reason of this is obvious. Gases are generated in him; he swells to a
prodigious magnitude; becomes a sort of animal balloon. A line-of-battle ship
could hardly keep him under then. In the Shore Whaling, on soundings, among the
Bays of New Zealand, when a Right Whale gives token of sinking, they fasten
buoys to him, with plenty of rope; so that when the body has gone down, they
know where to look for it when it shall have ascended again.
It
was not long after the sinking of the body that a cry was heard from the
Pequod's mast-heads, announcing that the Jungfrau was again lowering her boats;
though the only spout in sight was that of a Fin-Back, belonging to the species
of uncapturable whales, because of its incredible power of swimming.
Nevertheless, the Fin-Back's spout is so similar to the Sperm Whale's, that by
unskilful fishermen it is often mistaken for it. And consequently Derick and
all his host were now in valiant chase of this unnearable brute. The Virgin
crowding all sail, made after her four young keels, and thus they all
disappeared far to leeward, still in bold, hopeful chase.
Oh!
many are the Fin-Backs, and many are the Dericks, my friend.
CHAPTER
82. The Honor and Glory of Whaling.
There
are some enterprises in which a careful disorderliness is the true method.
The
more I dive into this matter of whaling, and push my researches up to the very
spring-head of it so much the more am I impressed with its great honorableness
and antiquity; and especially when I find so many great demi-gods and heroes,
prophets of all sorts, who one way or other have shed distinction upon it, I am
transported with the reflection that I myself belong, though but subordinately,
to so emblazoned a fraternity.
The
gallant Perseus, a son of Jupiter, was the first whaleman; and to the eternal
honor of our calling be it said, that the first whale attacked by our
brotherhood was not killed with any sordid intent. Those were the knightly days
of our profession, when we only bore arms to succor the distressed, and not to
fill men's lamp-feeders. Every one knows the fine story of Perseus and
Andromeda; how the lovely Andromeda, the daughter of a king, was tied to a rock
on the sea-coast, and as Leviathan was in the very act of carrying her off,
Perseus, the prince of whalemen, intrepidly advancing, harpooned the monster,
and delivered and married the maid. It was an admirable artistic exploit,
rarely achieved by the best harpooneers of the present day; inasmuch as this
Leviathan was slain at the very first dart. And let no man doubt this Arkite story;
for in the ancient Joppa, now Jaffa, on the Syrian coast, in one of the Pagan
temples, there stood for many ages the vast skeleton of a whale, which the
city's legends and all the inhabitants asserted to be the identical bones of
the monster that Perseus slew. When the Romans took Joppa, the same skeleton
was carried to Italy in triumph. What seems most singular and suggestively
important in this story, is this: it was from Joppa that Jonah set sail.
Akin
to the adventure of Perseus and Andromeda—indeed, by some supposed to be
indirectly derived from it—is that famous story of St. George and the Dragon;
which dragon I maintain to have been a whale; for in many old chronicles whales
and dragons are strangely jumbled together, and often stand for each other.
“Thou art as a lion of the waters, and as a dragon of the sea,” saith Ezekiel;
hereby, plainly meaning a whale; in truth, some versions of the Bible use that
word itself. Besides, it would much subtract from the glory of the exploit had
St. George but encountered a crawling reptile of the land, instead of doing
battle with the great monster of the deep. Any man may kill a snake, but only a
Perseus, a St. George, a Coffin, have the heart in them to march boldly up to a
whale.
Let
not the modern paintings of this scene mislead us; for though the creature
encountered by that valiant whaleman of old is vaguely represented of a
griffin-like shape, and though the battle is depicted on land and the saint on
horseback, yet considering the great ignorance of those times, when the true
form of the whale was unknown to artists; and considering that as in Perseus'
case, St. George's whale might have crawled up out of the sea on the beach; and
considering that the animal ridden by St. George might have been only a large
seal, or sea-horse; bearing all this in mind, it will not appear altogether
incompatible with the sacred legend and the ancientest draughts of the scene,
to hold this so-called dragon no other than the great Leviathan himself. In
fact, placed before the strict and piercing truth, this whole story will fare
like that fish, flesh, and fowl idol of the Philistines, Dagon by name; who
being planted before the ark of Israel, his horse's head and both the palms of
his hands fell off from him, and only the stump or fishy part of him remained.
Thus, then, one of our own noble stamp, even a whaleman, is the tutelary
guardian of England; and by good rights, we harpooneers of Nantucket should be
enrolled in the most noble order of St. George. And therefore, let not the
knights of that honorable company (none of whom, I venture to say, have ever
had to do with a whale like their great patron), let them never eye a
Nantucketer with disdain, since even in our woollen frocks and tarred trowsers
we are much better entitled to St. George's decoration than they.
Whether
to admit Hercules among us or not, concerning this I long remained dubious: for
though according to the Greek mythologies, that antique Crockett and Kit
Carson—that brawny doer of rejoicing good deeds, was swallowed down and thrown
up by a whale; still, whether that strictly makes a whaleman of him, that might
be mooted. It nowhere appears that he ever actually harpooned his fish, unless,
indeed, from the inside. Nevertheless, he may be deemed a sort of involuntary
whaleman; at any rate the whale caught him, if he did not the whale. I claim
him for one of our clan.
But,
by the best contradictory authorities, this Grecian story of Hercules and the
whale is considered to be derived from the still more ancient Hebrew story of
Jonah and the whale; and vice versâ; certainly they are very similar. If I
claim the demi-god then, why not the prophet?
Nor
do heroes, saints, demigods, and prophets alone comprise the whole roll of our
order. Our grand master is still to be named; for like royal kings of old
times, we find the head waters of our fraternity in nothing short of the great
gods themselves. That wondrous oriental story is now to be rehearsed from the
Shaster, which gives us the dread Vishnoo, one of the three persons in the
godhead of the Hindoos; gives us this divine Vishnoo himself for our
Lord;—Vishnoo, who, by the first of his ten earthly incarnations, has for ever
set apart and sanctified the whale. When Brahma, or the God of Gods, saith the
Shaster, resolved to recreate the world after one of its periodical
dissolutions, he gave birth to Vishnoo, to preside over the work; but the
Vedas, or mystical books, whose perusal would seem to have been indispensable
to Vishnoo before beginning the creation, and which therefore must have
contained something in the shape of practical hints to young architects, these
Vedas were lying at the bottom of the waters; so Vishnoo became incarnate in a
whale, and sounding down in him to the uttermost depths, rescued the sacred
volumes. Was not this Vishnoo a whaleman, then? even as a man who rides a horse
is called a horseman?
Perseus,
St. George, Hercules, Jonah, and Vishnoo! there's a member-roll for you! What
club but the whaleman's can head off like that?
CHAPTER
83. Jonah Historically Regarded.
Reference
was made to the historical story of Jonah and the whale in the preceding
chapter. Now some Nantucketers rather distrust this historical story of Jonah
and the whale. But then there were some sceptical Greeks and Romans, who,
standing out from the orthodox pagans of their times, equally doubted the story
of Hercules and the whale, and Arion and the dolphin; and yet their doubting
those traditions did not make those traditions one whit the less facts, for all
that.
One
old Sag-Harbor whaleman's chief reason for questioning the Hebrew story was
this:—He had one of those quaint old-fashioned Bibles, embellished with
curious, unscientific plates; one of which represented Jonah's whale with two
spouts in his head—a peculiarity only true with respect to a species of the
Leviathan (the Right Whale, and the varieties of that order), concerning which
the fishermen have this saying, “A penny roll would choke him”; his swallow is
so very small. But, to this, Bishop Jebb's anticipative answer is ready. It is
not necessary, hints the Bishop, that we consider Jonah as tombed in the
whale's belly, but as temporarily lodged in some part of his mouth. And this
seems reasonable enough in the good Bishop. For truly, the Right Whale's mouth
would accommodate a couple of whist-tables, and comfortably seat all the
players. Possibly, too, Jonah might have ensconced himself in a hollow tooth;
but, on second thoughts, the Right Whale is toothless.
Another
reason which Sag-Harbor (he went by that name) urged for his want of faith in
this matter of the prophet, was something obscurely in reference to his
incarcerated body and the whale's gastric juices. But this objection likewise
falls to the ground, because a German exegetist supposes that Jonah must have
taken refuge in the floating body of a dead whale—even as the French soldiers
in the Russian campaign turned their dead horses into tents, and crawled into
them. Besides, it has been divined by other continental commentators, that when
Jonah was thrown overboard from the Joppa ship, he straightway effected his
escape to another vessel near by, some vessel with a whale for a figure-head;
and, I would add, possibly called “The Whale,” as some craft are nowadays
christened the “Shark,” the “Gull,” the “Eagle.” Nor have there been wanting
learned exegetists who have opined that the whale mentioned in the book of
Jonah merely meant a life-preserver—an inflated bag of wind—which the
endangered prophet swam to, and so was saved from a watery doom. Poor
Sag-Harbor, therefore, seems worsted all round. But he had still another reason
for his want of faith. It was this, if I remember right: Jonah was swallowed by
the whale in the Mediterranean Sea, and after three days he was vomited up
somewhere within three days' journey of Nineveh, a city on the Tigris, very
much more than three days' journey across from the nearest point of the
Mediterranean coast. How is that?
But
was there no other way for the whale to land the prophet within that short distance
of Nineveh? Yes. He might have carried him round by the way of the Cape of Good
Hope. But not to speak of the passage through the whole length of the
Mediterranean, and another passage up the Persian Gulf and Red Sea, such a
supposition would involve the complete circumnavigation of all Africa in three
days, not to speak of the Tigris waters, near the site of Nineveh, being too
shallow for any whale to swim in. Besides, this idea of Jonah's weathering the
Cape of Good Hope at so early a day would wrest the honor of the discovery of
that great headland from Bartholomew Diaz, its reputed discoverer, and so make
modern history a liar.
But
all these foolish arguments of old Sag-Harbor only evinced his foolish pride of
reason—a thing still more reprehensible in him, seeing that he had but little
learning except what he had picked up from the sun and the sea. I say it only
shows his foolish, impious pride, and abominable, devilish rebellion against
the reverend clergy. For by a Portuguese Catholic priest, this very idea of
Jonah's going to Nineveh via the Cape of Good Hope was advanced as a signal
magnification of the general miracle. And so it was. Besides, to this day, the
highly enlightened Turks devoutly believe in the historical story of Jonah. And
some three centuries ago, an English traveller in old Harris's Voyages, speaks
of a Turkish Mosque built in honor of Jonah, in which Mosque was a miraculous
lamp that burnt without any oil.
CHAPTER
84. Pitchpoling.
To
make them run easily and swiftly, the axles of carriages are anointed; and for
much the same purpose, some whalers perform an analogous operation upon their
boat; they grease the bottom. Nor is it to be doubted that as such a procedure
can do no harm, it may possibly be of no contemptible advantage; considering
that oil and water are hostile; that oil is a sliding thing, and that the
object in view is to make the boat slide bravely. Queequeg believed strongly in
anointing his boat, and one morning not long after the German ship Jungfrau
disappeared, took more than customary pains in that occupation; crawling under
its bottom, where it hung over the side, and rubbing in the unctuousness as
though diligently seeking to insure a crop of hair from the craft's bald keel.
He seemed to be working in obedience to some particular presentiment. Nor did
it remain unwarranted by the event.
Towards
noon whales were raised; but so soon as the ship sailed down to them, they
turned and fled with swift precipitancy; a disordered flight, as of Cleopatra's
barges from Actium.
Nevertheless,
the boats pursued, and Stubb's was foremost. By great exertion, Tashtego at
last succeeded in planting one iron; but the stricken whale, without at all
sounding, still continued his horizontal flight, with added fleetness. Such
unintermitted strainings upon the planted iron must sooner or later inevitably
extract it. It became imperative to lance the flying whale, or be content to
lose him. But to haul the boat up to his flank was impossible, he swam so fast
and furious. What then remained?
Of
all the wondrous devices and dexterities, the sleights of hand and countless
subtleties, to which the veteran whaleman is so often forced, none exceed that
fine manœuvre with the lance called pitchpoling. Small sword, or broad sword,
in all its exercises boasts nothing like it. It is only indispensable with an
inveterate running whale; its grand fact and feature is the wonderful distance
to which the long lance is accurately darted from a violently rocking, jerking
boat, under extreme headway. Steel and wood included, the entire spear is some
ten or twelve feet in length; the staff is much slighter than that of the
harpoon, and also of a lighter material—pine. It is furnished with a small rope
called a warp, of considerable length, by which it can be hauled back to the
hand after darting.
But
before going further, it is important to mention here, that though the harpoon
may be pitchpoled in the same way with the lance, yet it is seldom done; and
when done, is still less frequently successful, on account of the greater
weight and inferior length of the harpoon as compared with the lance, which in
effect become serious drawbacks. As a general thing, therefore, you must first
get fast to a whale, before any pitchpoling comes into play.
Look
now at Stubb; a man who from his humorous, deliberate coolness and equanimity
in the direst emergencies, was specially qualified to excel in pitchpoling.
Look at him; he stands upright in the tossed bow of the flying boat; wrapt in
fleecy foam, the towing whale is forty feet ahead. Handling the long lance
lightly, glancing twice or thrice along its length to see if it be exactly
straight, Stubb whistlingly gathers up the coil of the warp in one hand, so as
to secure its free end in his grasp, leaving the rest unobstructed. Then
holding the lance full before his waistband's middle, he levels it at the
whale; when, covering him with it, he steadily depresses the butt-end in his
hand, thereby elevating the point till the weapon stands fairly balanced upon his
palm, fifteen feet in the air. He minds you somewhat of a juggler, balancing a
long staff on his chin. Next moment with a rapid, nameless impulse, in a superb
lofty arch the bright steel spans the foaming distance, and quivers in the life
spot of the whale. Instead of sparkling water, he now spouts red blood.
“That
drove the spigot out of him!” cried Stubb. “'Tis July's immortal Fourth; all
fountains must run wine today! Would now, it were old Orleans whiskey, or old
Ohio, or unspeakable old Monongahela! Then, Tashtego, lad, I'd have ye hold a
canakin to the jet, and we'd drink round it! Yea, verily, hearts alive, we'd
brew choice punch in the spread of his spout-hole there, and from that live
punch-bowl quaff the living stuff.”
Again
and again to such gamesome talk, the dexterous dart is repeated, the spear
returning to its master like a greyhound held in skilful leash. The agonized
whale goes into his flurry; the tow-line is slackened, and the pitchpoler
dropping astern, folds his hands, and mutely watches the monster die.
CHAPTER
85. The Fountain.
That
for six thousand years—and no one knows how many millions of ages before—the
great whales should have been spouting all over the sea, and sprinkling and
mistifying the gardens of the deep, as with so many sprinkling or mistifying
pots; and that for some centuries back, thousands of hunters should have been
close by the fountain of the whale, watching these sprinklings and
spoutings—that all this should be, and yet, that down to this blessed minute
(fifteen and a quarter minutes past one o'clock P.M. of this sixteenth day of
December, A.D. 1851), it should still remain a problem, whether these spoutings
are, after all, really water, or nothing but vapor—this is surely a noteworthy
thing.
Let
us, then, look at this matter, along with some interesting items contingent.
Every one knows that by the peculiar cunning of their gills, the finny tribes
in general breathe the air which at all times is combined with the element in
which they swim; hence, a herring or a cod might live a century, and never once
raise its head above the surface. But owing to his marked internal structure
which gives him regular lungs, like a human being's, the whale can only live by
inhaling the disengaged air in the open atmosphere. Wherefore the necessity for
his periodical visits to the upper world. But he cannot in any degree breathe
through his mouth, for, in his ordinary attitude, the Sperm Whale's mouth is
buried at least eight feet beneath the surface; and what is still more, his
windpipe has no connexion with his mouth. No, he breathes through his spiracle
alone; and this is on the top of his head.
If
I say, that in any creature breathing is only a function indispensable to
vitality, inasmuch as it withdraws from the air a certain element, which being
subsequently brought into contact with the blood imparts to the blood its
vivifying principle, I do not think I shall err; though I may possibly use some
superfluous scientific words. Assume it, and it follows that if all the blood
in a man could be aerated with one breath, he might then seal up his nostrils
and not fetch another for a considerable time. That is to say, he would then
live without breathing. Anomalous as it may seem, this is precisely the case
with the whale, who systematically lives, by intervals, his full hour and more
(when at the bottom) without drawing a single breath, or so much as in any way
inhaling a particle of air; for, remember, he has no gills. How is this?
Between his ribs and on each side of his spine he is supplied with a remarkable
involved Cretan labyrinth of vermicelli-like vessels, which vessels, when he
quits the surface, are completely distended with oxygenated blood. So that for
an hour or more, a thousand fathoms in the sea, he carries a surplus stock of
vitality in him, just as the camel crossing the waterless desert carries a
surplus supply of drink for future use in its four supplementary stomachs. The
anatomical fact of this labyrinth is indisputable; and that the supposition founded
upon it is reasonable and true, seems the more cogent to me, when I consider
the otherwise inexplicable obstinacy of that leviathan in having his spoutings
out, as the fishermen phrase it. This is what I mean. If unmolested, upon
rising to the surface, the Sperm Whale will continue there for a period of time
exactly uniform with all his other unmolested risings. Say he stays eleven
minutes, and jets seventy times, that is, respires seventy breaths; then
whenever he rises again, he will be sure to have his seventy breaths over
again, to a minute. Now, if after he fetches a few breaths you alarm him, so
that he sounds, he will be always dodging up again to make good his regular
allowance of air. And not till those seventy breaths are told, will he finally
go down to stay out his full term below. Remark, however, that in different
individuals these rates are different; but in any one they are alike. Now, why
should the whale thus insist upon having his spoutings out, unless it be to
replenish his reservoir of air, ere descending for good? How obvious is it,
too, that this necessity for the whale's rising exposes him to all the fatal
hazards of the chase. For not by hook or by net could this vast leviathan be
caught, when sailing a thousand fathoms beneath the sunlight. Not so much thy
skill, then, O hunter, as the great necessities that strike the victory to
thee!
In
man, breathing is incessantly going on—one breath only serving for two or three
pulsations; so that whatever other business he has to attend to, waking or
sleeping, breathe he must, or die he will. But the Sperm Whale only breathes
about one seventh or Sunday of his time.
It
has been said that the whale only breathes through his spout-hole; if it could
truthfully be added that his spouts are mixed with water, then I opine we
should be furnished with the reason why his sense of smell seems obliterated in
him; for the only thing about him that at all answers to his nose is that
identical spout-hole; and being so clogged with two elements, it could not be
expected to have the power of smelling. But owing to the mystery of the
spout—whether it be water or whether it be vapor—no absolute certainty can as
yet be arrived at on this head. Sure it is, nevertheless, that the Sperm Whale
has no proper olfactories. But what does he want of them? No roses, no violets,
no Cologne-water in the sea.
Furthermore,
as his windpipe solely opens into the tube of his spouting canal, and as that
long canal—like the grand Erie Canal—is furnished with a sort of locks (that
open and shut) for the downward retention of air or the upward exclusion of
water, therefore the whale has no voice; unless you insult him by saying, that
when he so strangely rumbles, he talks through his nose. But then again, what
has the whale to say? Seldom have I known any profound being that had anything
to say to this world, unless forced to stammer out something by way of getting
a living. Oh! happy that the world is such an excellent listener!
Now,
the spouting canal of the Sperm Whale, chiefly intended as it is for the
conveyance of air, and for several feet laid along, horizontally, just beneath
the upper surface of his head, and a little to one side; this curious canal is
very much like a gas-pipe laid down in a city on one side of a street. But the
question returns whether this gas-pipe is also a water-pipe; in other words,
whether the spout of the Sperm Whale is the mere vapor of the exhaled breath,
or whether that exhaled breath is mixed with water taken in at the mouth, and
discharged through the spiracle. It is certain that the mouth indirectly
communicates with the spouting canal; but it cannot be proved that this is for
the purpose of discharging water through the spiracle. Because the greatest
necessity for so doing would seem to be, when in feeding he accidentally takes
in water. But the Sperm Whale's food is far beneath the surface, and there he
cannot spout even if he would. Besides, if you regard him very closely, and
time him with your watch, you will find that when unmolested, there is an
undeviating rhyme between the periods of his jets and the ordinary periods of
respiration.
But
why pester one with all this reasoning on the subject? Speak out! You have seen
him spout; then declare what the spout is; can you not tell water from air? My
dear sir, in this world it is not so easy to settle these plain things. I have
ever found your plain things the knottiest of all. And as for this whale spout,
you might almost stand in it, and yet be undecided as to what it is precisely.
The
central body of it is hidden in the snowy sparkling mist enveloping it; and how
can you certainly tell whether any water falls from it, when, always, when you
are close enough to a whale to get a close view of his spout, he is in a
prodigious commotion, the water cascading all around him. And if at such times
you should think that you really perceived drops of moisture in the spout, how
do you know that they are not merely condensed from its vapor; or how do you
know that they are not those identical drops superficially lodged in the
spout-hole fissure, which is countersunk into the summit of the whale's head?
For even when tranquilly swimming through the mid-day sea in a calm, with his
elevated hump sun-dried as a dromedary's in the desert; even then, the whale
always carries a small basin of water on his head, as under a blazing sun you
will sometimes see a cavity in a rock filled up with rain.
Nor
is it at all prudent for the hunter to be over curious touching the precise
nature of the whale spout. It will not do for him to be peering into it, and
putting his face in it. You cannot go with your pitcher to this fountain and
fill it, and bring it away. For even when coming into slight contact with the
outer, vapory shreds of the jet, which will often happen, your skin will
feverishly smart, from the acridness of the thing so touching it. And I know
one, who coming into still closer contact with the spout, whether with some
scientific object in view, or otherwise, I cannot say, the skin peeled off from
his cheek and arm. Wherefore, among whalemen, the spout is deemed poisonous;
they try to evade it. Another thing; I have heard it said, and I do not much
doubt it, that if the jet is fairly spouted into your eyes, it will blind you.
The wisest thing the investigator can do then, it seems to me, is to let this
deadly spout alone.
Still,
we can hypothesize, even if we cannot prove and establish. My hypothesis is
this: that the spout is nothing but mist. And besides other reasons, to this
conclusion I am impelled, by considerations touching the great inherent dignity
and sublimity of the Sperm Whale; I account him no common, shallow being,
inasmuch as it is an undisputed fact that he is never found on soundings, or
near shores; all other whales sometimes are. He is both ponderous and profound.
And I am convinced that from the heads of all ponderous profound beings, such
as Plato, Pyrrho, the Devil, Jupiter, Dante, and so on, there always goes up a
certain semi-visible steam, while in the act of thinking deep thoughts. While
composing a little treatise on Eternity, I had the curiosity to place a mirror
before me; and ere long saw reflected there, a curious involved worming and
undulation in the atmosphere over my head. The invariable moisture of my hair,
while plunged in deep thought, after six cups of hot tea in my thin shingled
attic, of an August noon; this seems an additional argument for the above
supposition.
And
how nobly it raises our conceit of the mighty, misty monster, to behold him
solemnly sailing through a calm tropical sea; his vast, mild head overhung by a
canopy of vapor, engendered by his incommunicable contemplations, and that
vapor—as you will sometimes see it—glorified by a rainbow, as if Heaven itself
had put its seal upon his thoughts. For, d'ye see, rainbows do not visit the
clear air; they only irradiate vapor. And so, through all the thick mists of
the dim doubts in my mind, divine intuitions now and then shoot, enkindling my
fog with a heavenly ray. And for this I thank God; for all have doubts; many
deny; but doubts or denials, few along with them, have intuitions. Doubts of
all things earthly, and intuitions of some things heavenly; this combination
makes neither believer nor infidel, but makes a man who regards them both with
equal eye.
CHAPTER
86. The Tail.
Other
poets have warbled the praises of the soft eye of the antelope, and the lovely
plumage of the bird that never alights; less celestial, I celebrate a tail.
Reckoning
the largest sized Sperm Whale's tail to begin at that point of the trunk where
it tapers to about the girth of a man, it comprises upon its upper surface
alone, an area of at least fifty square feet. The compact round body of its
root expands into two broad, firm, flat palms or flukes, gradually shoaling
away to less than an inch in thickness. At the crotch or junction, these flukes
slightly overlap, then sideways recede from each other like wings, leaving a
wide vacancy between. In no living thing are the lines of beauty more
exquisitely defined than in the crescentic borders of these flukes. At its
utmost expansion in the full grown whale, the tail will considerably exceed
twenty feet across.
The
entire member seems a dense webbed bed of welded sinews; but cut into it, and
you find that three distinct strata compose it:—upper, middle, and lower. The
fibres in the upper and lower layers, are long and horizontal; those of the
middle one, very short, and running crosswise between the outside layers. This
triune structure, as much as anything else, imparts power to the tail. To the
student of old Roman walls, the middle layer will furnish a curious parallel to
the thin course of tiles always alternating with the stone in those wonderful
relics of the antique, and which undoubtedly contribute so much to the great
strength of the masonry.
But
as if this vast local power in the tendinous tail were not enough, the whole
bulk of the leviathan is knit over with a warp and woof of muscular fibres and
filaments, which passing on either side the loins and running down into the
flukes, insensibly blend with them, and largely contribute to their might; so
that in the tail the confluent measureless force of the whole whale seems
concentrated to a point. Could annihilation occur to matter, this were the
thing to do it.
Nor
does this—its amazing strength, at all tend to cripple the graceful flexion of
its motions; where infantileness of ease undulates through a Titanism of power.
On the contrary, those motions derive their most appalling beauty from it. Real
strength never impairs beauty or harmony, but it often bestows it; and in
everything imposingly beautiful, strength has much to do with the magic. Take
away the tied tendons that all over seem bursting from the marble in the carved
Hercules, and its charm would be gone. As devout Eckerman lifted the linen
sheet from the naked corpse of Goethe, he was overwhelmed with the massive
chest of the man, that seemed as a Roman triumphal arch. When Angelo paints
even God the Father in human form, mark what robustness is there. And whatever
they may reveal of the divine love in the Son, the soft, curled,
hermaphroditical Italian pictures, in which his idea has been most successfully
embodied; these pictures, so destitute as they are of all brawniness, hint
nothing of any power, but the mere negative, feminine one of submission and
endurance, which on all hands it is conceded, form the peculiar practical
virtues of his teachings.
Such
is the subtle elasticity of the organ I treat of, that whether wielded in
sport, or in earnest, or in anger, whatever be the mood it be in, its flexions
are invariably marked by exceeding grace. Therein no fairy's arm can transcend
it.
Five
great motions are peculiar to it. First, when used as a fin for progression;
Second, when used as a mace in battle; Third, in sweeping; Fourth, in
lobtailing; Fifth, in peaking flukes.
First:
Being horizontal in its position, the Leviathan's tail acts in a different
manner from the tails of all other sea creatures. It never wriggles. In man or
fish, wriggling is a sign of inferiority. To the whale, his tail is the sole
means of propulsion. Scroll-wise coiled forwards beneath the body, and then
rapidly sprung backwards, it is this which gives that singular darting, leaping
motion to the monster when furiously swimming. His side-fins only serve to
steer by.
Second:
It is a little significant, that while one sperm whale only fights another
sperm whale with his head and jaw, nevertheless, in his conflicts with man, he
chiefly and contemptuously uses his tail. In striking at a boat, he swiftly
curves away his flukes from it, and the blow is only inflicted by the recoil.
If it be made in the unobstructed air, especially if it descend to its mark,
the stroke is then simply irresistible. No ribs of man or boat can withstand
it. Your only salvation lies in eluding it; but if it comes sideways through
the opposing water, then partly owing to the light buoyancy of the whale-boat,
and the elasticity of its materials, a cracked rib or a dashed plank or two, a
sort of stitch in the side, is generally the most serious result. These
submerged side blows are so often received in the fishery, that they are
accounted mere child's play. Some one strips off a frock, and the hole is
stopped.
Third:
I cannot demonstrate it, but it seems to me, that in the whale the sense of
touch is concentrated in the tail; for in this respect there is a delicacy in
it only equalled by the daintiness of the elephant's trunk. This delicacy is
chiefly evinced in the action of sweeping, when in maidenly gentleness the
whale with a certain soft slowness moves his immense flukes from side to side
upon the surface of the sea; and if he feel but a sailor's whisker, woe to that
sailor, whiskers and all. What tenderness there is in that preliminary touch!
Had this tail any prehensile power, I should straightway bethink me of
Darmonodes' elephant that so frequented the flower-market, and with low
salutations presented nosegays to damsels, and then caressed their zones. On
more accounts than one, a pity it is that the whale does not possess this
prehensile virtue in his tail; for I have heard of yet another elephant, that
when wounded in the fight, curved round his trunk and extracted the dart.
Fourth:
Stealing unawares upon the whale in the fancied security of the middle of
solitary seas, you find him unbent from the vast corpulence of his dignity, and
kitten-like, he plays on the ocean as if it were a hearth. But still you see
his power in his play. The broad palms of his tail are flirted high into the
air; then smiting the surface, the thunderous concussion resounds for miles.
You would almost think a great gun had been discharged; and if you noticed the
light wreath of vapor from the spiracle at his other extremity, you would think
that that was the smoke from the touch-hole.
Fifth:
As in the ordinary floating posture of the leviathan the flukes lie
considerably below the level of his back, they are then completely out of sight
beneath the surface; but when he is about to plunge into the deeps, his entire
flukes with at least thirty feet of his body are tossed erect in the air, and
so remain vibrating a moment, till they downwards shoot out of view. Excepting
the sublime breach—somewhere else to be described—this peaking of the whale's
flukes is perhaps the grandest sight to be seen in all animated nature. Out of
the bottomless profundities the gigantic tail seems spasmodically snatching at
the highest heaven. So in dreams, have I seen majestic Satan thrusting forth
his tormented colossal claw from the flame Baltic of Hell. But in gazing at
such scenes, it is all in all what mood you are in; if in the Dantean, the
devils will occur to you; if in that of Isaiah, the archangels. Standing at the
mast-head of my ship during a sunrise that crimsoned sky and sea, I once saw a
large herd of whales in the east, all heading towards the sun, and for a moment
vibrating in concert with peaked flukes. As it seemed to me at the time, such a
grand embodiment of adoration of the gods was never beheld, even in Persia, the
home of the fire worshippers. As Ptolemy Philopater testified of the African
elephant, I then testified of the whale, pronouncing him the most devout of all
beings. For according to King Juba, the military elephants of antiquity often
hailed the morning with their trunks uplifted in the profoundest silence.
The
chance comparison in this chapter, between the whale and the elephant, so far
as some aspects of the tail of the one and the trunk of the other are
concerned, should not tend to place those two opposite organs on an equality,
much less the creatures to which they respectively belong. For as the mightiest
elephant is but a terrier to Leviathan, so, compared with Leviathan's tail, his
trunk is but the stalk of a lily. The most direful blow from the elephant's
trunk were as the playful tap of a fan, compared with the measureless crush and
crash of the sperm whale's ponderous flukes, which in repeated instances have
one after the other hurled entire boats with all their oars and crews into the
air, very much as an Indian juggler tosses his balls.*
*Though
all comparison in the way of general bulk between the whale and the elephant is
preposterous, inasmuch as in that particular the elephant stands in much the
same respect to the whale that a dog does to the elephant; nevertheless, there
are not wanting some points of curious similitude; among these is the spout. It
is well known that the elephant will often draw up water or dust in his trunk,
and then elevating it, jet it forth in a stream.
The
more I consider this mighty tail, the more do I deplore my inability to express
it. At times there are gestures in it, which, though they would well grace the
hand of man, remain wholly inexplicable. In an extensive herd, so remarkable,
occasionally, are these mystic gestures, that I have heard hunters who have
declared them akin to Free-Mason signs and symbols; that the whale, indeed, by
these methods intelligently conversed with the world. Nor are there wanting
other motions of the whale in his general body, full of strangeness, and
unaccountable to his most experienced assailant. Dissect him how I may, then, I
but go skin deep; I know him not, and never will. But if I know not even the
tail of this whale, how understand his head? much more, how comprehend his
face, when face he has none? Thou shalt see my back parts, my tail, he seems to
say, but my face shall not be seen. But I cannot completely make out his back
parts; and hint what he will about his face, I say again he has no face.
CHAPTER
87. The Grand Armada.
The
long and narrow peninsula of Malacca, extending south-eastward from the
territories of Birmah, forms the most southerly point of all Asia. In a
continuous line from that peninsula stretch the long islands of Sumatra, Java,
Bally, and Timor; which, with many others, form a vast mole, or rampart,
lengthwise connecting Asia with Australia, and dividing the long unbroken
Indian ocean from the thickly studded oriental archipelagoes. This rampart is
pierced by several sally-ports for the convenience of ships and whales;
conspicuous among which are the straits of Sunda and Malacca. By the straits of
Sunda, chiefly, vessels bound to China from the west, emerge into the China
seas.
Those
narrow straits of Sunda divide Sumatra from Java; and standing midway in that
vast rampart of islands, buttressed by that bold green promontory, known to
seamen as Java Head; they not a little correspond to the central gateway
opening into some vast walled empire: and considering the inexhaustible wealth
of spices, and silks, and jewels, and gold, and ivory, with which the thousand
islands of that oriental sea are enriched, it seems a significant provision of
nature, that such treasures, by the very formation of the land, should at least
bear the appearance, however ineffectual, of being guarded from the
all-grasping western world. The shores of the Straits of Sunda are unsupplied
with those domineering fortresses which guard the entrances to the
Mediterranean, the Baltic, and the Propontis. Unlike the Danes, these Orientals
do not demand the obsequious homage of lowered top-sails from the endless procession
of ships before the wind, which for centuries past, by night and by day, have
passed between the islands of Sumatra and Java, freighted with the costliest
cargoes of the east. But while they freely waive a ceremonial like this, they
do by no means renounce their claim to more solid tribute.
Time
out of mind the piratical proas of the Malays, lurking among the low shaded
coves and islets of Sumatra, have sallied out upon the vessels sailing through
the straits, fiercely demanding tribute at the point of their spears. Though by
the repeated bloody chastisements they have received at the hands of European
cruisers, the audacity of these corsairs has of late been somewhat repressed;
yet, even at the present day, we occasionally hear of English and American
vessels, which, in those waters, have been remorselessly boarded and pillaged.
With
a fair, fresh wind, the Pequod was now drawing nigh to these straits; Ahab
purposing to pass through them into the Javan sea, and thence, cruising
northwards, over waters known to be frequented here and there by the Sperm
Whale, sweep inshore by the Philippine Islands, and gain the far coast of
Japan, in time for the great whaling season there. By these means, the
circumnavigating Pequod would sweep almost all the known Sperm Whale cruising
grounds of the world, previous to descending upon the Line in the Pacific;
where Ahab, though everywhere else foiled in his pursuit, firmly counted upon
giving battle to Moby Dick, in the sea he was most known to frequent; and at a
season when he might most reasonably be presumed to be haunting it.
But
how now? in this zoned quest, does Ahab touch no land? does his crew drink air?
Surely, he will stop for water. Nay. For a long time, now, the circus-running
sun has raced within his fiery ring, and needs no sustenance but what's in
himself. So Ahab. Mark this, too, in the whaler. While other hulls are loaded
down with alien stuff, to be transferred to foreign wharves; the
world-wandering whale-ship carries no cargo but herself and crew, their weapons
and their wants. She has a whole lake's contents bottled in her ample hold. She
is ballasted with utilities; not altogether with unusable pig-lead and
kentledge. She carries years' water in her. Clear old prime Nantucket water;
which, when three years afloat, the Nantucketer, in the Pacific, prefers to
drink before the brackish fluid, but yesterday rafted off in casks, from the
Peruvian or Indian streams. Hence it is, that, while other ships may have gone
to China from New York, and back again, touching at a score of ports, the
whale-ship, in all that interval, may not have sighted one grain of soil; her
crew having seen no man but floating seamen like themselves. So that did you
carry them the news that another flood had come; they would only answer—“Well,
boys, here's the ark!”
Now,
as many Sperm Whales had been captured off the western coast of Java, in the
near vicinity of the Straits of Sunda; indeed, as most of the ground,
roundabout, was generally recognised by the fishermen as an excellent spot for
cruising; therefore, as the Pequod gained more and more upon Java Head, the look-outs
were repeatedly hailed, and admonished to keep wide awake. But though the green
palmy cliffs of the land soon loomed on the starboard bow, and with delighted
nostrils the fresh cinnamon was snuffed in the air, yet not a single jet was
descried. Almost renouncing all thought of falling in with any game hereabouts,
the ship had well nigh entered the straits, when the customary cheering cry was
heard from aloft, and ere long a spectacle of singular magnificence saluted us.
But
here be it premised, that owing to the unwearied activity with which of late
they have been hunted over all four oceans, the Sperm Whales, instead of almost
invariably sailing in small detached companies, as in former times, are now
frequently met with in extensive herds, sometimes embracing so great a
multitude, that it would almost seem as if numerous nations of them had sworn
solemn league and covenant for mutual assistance and protection. To this
aggregation of the Sperm Whale into such immense caravans, may be imputed the circumstance
that even in the best cruising grounds, you may now sometimes sail for weeks
and months together, without being greeted by a single spout; and then be
suddenly saluted by what sometimes seems thousands on thousands.
Broad
on both bows, at the distance of some two or three miles, and forming a great
semicircle, embracing one half of the level horizon, a continuous chain of
whale-jets were up-playing and sparkling in the noon-day air. Unlike the
straight perpendicular twin-jets of the Right Whale, which, dividing at top,
fall over in two branches, like the cleft drooping boughs of a willow, the
single forward-slanting spout of the Sperm Whale presents a thick curled bush
of white mist, continually rising and falling away to leeward.
Seen
from the Pequod's deck, then, as she would rise on a high hill of the sea, this
host of vapory spouts, individually curling up into the air, and beheld through
a blending atmosphere of bluish haze, showed like the thousand cheerful
chimneys of some dense metropolis, descried of a balmy autumnal morning, by
some horseman on a height.
As
marching armies approaching an unfriendly defile in the mountains, accelerate
their march, all eagerness to place that perilous passage in their rear, and
once more expand in comparative security upon the plain; even so did this vast
fleet of whales now seem hurrying forward through the straits; gradually
contracting the wings of their semicircle, and swimming on, in one solid, but
still crescentic centre.
Crowding
all sail the Pequod pressed after them; the harpooneers handling their weapons,
and loudly cheering from the heads of their yet suspended boats. If the wind
only held, little doubt had they, that chased through these Straits of Sunda,
the vast host would only deploy into the Oriental seas to witness the capture
of not a few of their number. And who could tell whether, in that congregated
caravan, Moby Dick himself might not temporarily be swimming, like the
worshipped white-elephant in the coronation procession of the Siamese! So with
stun-sail piled on stun-sail, we sailed along, driving these leviathans before
us; when, of a sudden, the voice of Tashtego was heard, loudly directing
attention to something in our wake.
Corresponding
to the crescent in our van, we beheld another in our rear. It seemed formed of
detached white vapors, rising and falling something like the spouts of the
whales; only they did not so completely come and go; for they constantly
hovered, without finally disappearing. Levelling his glass at this sight, Ahab
quickly revolved in his pivot-hole, crying, “Aloft there, and rig whips and
buckets to wet the sails;—Malays, sir, and after us!”
As
if too long lurking behind the headlands, till the Pequod should fairly have
entered the straits, these rascally Asiatics were now in hot pursuit, to make
up for their over-cautious delay. But when the swift Pequod, with a fresh
leading wind, was herself in hot chase; how very kind of these tawny
philanthropists to assist in speeding her on to her own chosen pursuit,—mere
riding-whips and rowels to her, that they were. As with glass under arm, Ahab
to-and-fro paced the deck; in his forward turn beholding the monsters he
chased, and in the after one the bloodthirsty pirates chasing him; some such
fancy as the above seemed his. And when he glanced upon the green walls of the
watery defile in which the ship was then sailing, and bethought him that
through that gate lay the route to his vengeance, and beheld, how that through
that same gate he was now both chasing and being chased to his deadly end; and
not only that, but a herd of remorseless wild pirates and inhuman atheistical
devils were infernally cheering him on with their curses;—when all these
conceits had passed through his brain, Ahab's brow was left gaunt and ribbed,
like the black sand beach after some stormy tide has been gnawing it, without
being able to drag the firm thing from its place.
But
thoughts like these troubled very few of the reckless crew; and when, after
steadily dropping and dropping the pirates astern, the Pequod at last shot by
the vivid green Cockatoo Point on the Sumatra side, emerging at last upon the
broad waters beyond; then, the harpooneers seemed more to grieve that the swift
whales had been gaining upon the ship, than to rejoice that the ship had so
victoriously gained upon the Malays. But still driving on in the wake of the
whales, at length they seemed abating their speed; gradually the ship neared
them; and the wind now dying away, word was passed to spring to the boats. But
no sooner did the herd, by some presumed wonderful instinct of the Sperm Whale,
become notified of the three keels that were after them,—though as yet a mile
in their rear,—than they rallied again, and forming in close ranks and
battalions, so that their spouts all looked like flashing lines of stacked
bayonets, moved on with redoubled velocity.
Stripped
to our shirts and drawers, we sprang to the white-ash, and after several hours'
pulling were almost disposed to renounce the chase, when a general pausing commotion
among the whales gave animating token that they were now at last under the
influence of that strange perplexity of inert irresolution, which, when the
fishermen perceive it in the whale, they say he is gallied. The compact martial
columns in which they had been hitherto rapidly and steadily swimming, were now
broken up in one measureless rout; and like King Porus' elephants in the Indian
battle with Alexander, they seemed going mad with consternation. In all
directions expanding in vast irregular circles, and aimlessly swimming hither
and thither, by their short thick spoutings, they plainly betrayed their
distraction of panic. This was still more strangely evinced by those of their
number, who, completely paralysed as it were, helplessly floated like
water-logged dismantled ships on the sea. Had these Leviathans been but a flock
of simple sheep, pursued over the pasture by three fierce wolves, they could
not possibly have evinced such excessive dismay. But this occasional timidity
is characteristic of almost all herding creatures. Though banding together in
tens of thousands, the lion-maned buffaloes of the West have fled before a
solitary horseman. Witness, too, all human beings, how when herded together in
the sheepfold of a theatre's pit, they will, at the slightest alarm of fire,
rush helter-skelter for the outlets, crowding, trampling, jamming, and
remorselessly dashing each other to death. Best, therefore, withhold any
amazement at the strangely gallied whales before us, for there is no folly of
the beasts of the earth which is not infinitely outdone by the madness of men.
Though
many of the whales, as has been said, were in violent motion, yet it is to be
observed that as a whole the herd neither advanced nor retreated, but
collectively remained in one place. As is customary in those cases, the boats
at once separated, each making for some one lone whale on the outskirts of the
shoal. In about three minutes' time, Queequeg's harpoon was flung; the stricken
fish darted blinding spray in our faces, and then running away with us like
light, steered straight for the heart of the herd. Though such a movement on
the part of the whale struck under such circumstances, is in no wise
unprecedented; and indeed is almost always more or less anticipated; yet does
it present one of the more perilous vicissitudes of the fishery. For as the
swift monster drags you deeper and deeper into the frantic shoal, you bid adieu
to circumspect life and only exist in a delirious throb.
As,
blind and deaf, the whale plunged forward, as if by sheer power of speed to rid
himself of the iron leech that had fastened to him; as we thus tore a white
gash in the sea, on all sides menaced as we flew, by the crazed creatures to
and fro rushing about us; our beset boat was like a ship mobbed by ice-isles in
a tempest, and striving to steer through their complicated channels and
straits, knowing not at what moment it may be locked in and crushed.
But
not a bit daunted, Queequeg steered us manfully; now sheering off from this
monster directly across our route in advance; now edging away from that, whose
colossal flukes were suspended overhead, while all the time, Starbuck stood up
in the bows, lance in hand, pricking out of our way whatever whales he could
reach by short darts, for there was no time to make long ones. Nor were the
oarsmen quite idle, though their wonted duty was now altogether dispensed with.
They chiefly attended to the shouting part of the business. “Out of the way,
Commodore!” cried one, to a great dromedary that of a sudden rose bodily to the
surface, and for an instant threatened to swamp us. “Hard down with your tail,
there!” cried a second to another, which, close to our gunwale, seemed calmly
cooling himself with his own fan-like extremity.
All
whaleboats carry certain curious contrivances, originally invented by the
Nantucket Indians, called druggs. Two thick squares of wood of equal size are
stoutly clenched together, so that they cross each other's grain at right
angles; a line of considerable length is then attached to the middle of this
block, and the other end of the line being looped, it can in a moment be
fastened to a harpoon. It is chiefly among gallied whales that this drugg is
used. For then, more whales are close round you than you can possibly chase at
one time. But sperm whales are not every day encountered; while you may, then,
you must kill all you can. And if you cannot kill them all at once, you must
wing them, so that they can be afterwards killed at your leisure. Hence it is,
that at times like these the drugg, comes into requisition. Our boat was
furnished with three of them. The first and second were successfully darted,
and we saw the whales staggeringly running off, fettered by the enormous
sidelong resistance of the towing drugg. They were cramped like malefactors
with the chain and ball. But upon flinging the third, in the act of tossing
overboard the clumsy wooden block, it caught under one of the seats of the
boat, and in an instant tore it out and carried it away, dropping the oarsman
in the boat's bottom as the seat slid from under him. On both sides the sea
came in at the wounded planks, but we stuffed two or three drawers and shirts
in, and so stopped the leaks for the time.
It
had been next to impossible to dart these drugged-harpoons, were it not that as
we advanced into the herd, our whale's way greatly diminished; moreover, that
as we went still further and further from the circumference of commotion, the
direful disorders seemed waning. So that when at last the jerking harpoon drew
out, and the towing whale sideways vanished; then, with the tapering force of
his parting momentum, we glided between two whales into the innermost heart of
the shoal, as if from some mountain torrent we had slid into a serene valley
lake. Here the storms in the roaring glens between the outermost whales, were
heard but not felt. In this central expanse the sea presented that smooth
satin-like surface, called a sleek, produced by the subtle moisture thrown off
by the whale in his more quiet moods. Yes, we were now in that enchanted calm
which they say lurks at the heart of every commotion. And still in the
distracted distance we beheld the tumults of the outer concentric circles, and
saw successive pods of whales, eight or ten in each, swiftly going round and
round, like multiplied spans of horses in a ring; and so closely shoulder to
shoulder, that a Titanic circus-rider might easily have over-arched the middle
ones, and so have gone round on their backs. Owing to the density of the crowd
of reposing whales, more immediately surrounding the embayed axis of the herd,
no possible chance of escape was at present afforded us. We must watch for a
breach in the living wall that hemmed us in; the wall that had only admitted us
in order to shut us up. Keeping at the centre of the lake, we were occasionally
visited by small tame cows and calves; the women and children of this routed
host.
Now,
inclusive of the occasional wide intervals between the revolving outer circles,
and inclusive of the spaces between the various pods in any one of those
circles, the entire area at this juncture, embraced by the whole multitude,
must have contained at least two or three square miles. At any rate—though
indeed such a test at such a time might be deceptive—spoutings might be
discovered from our low boat that seemed playing up almost from the rim of the
horizon. I mention this circumstance, because, as if the cows and calves had
been purposely locked up in this innermost fold; and as if the wide extent of
the herd had hitherto prevented them from learning the precise cause of its
stopping; or, possibly, being so young, unsophisticated, and every way innocent
and inexperienced; however it may have been, these smaller whales—now and then
visiting our becalmed boat from the margin of the lake—evinced a wondrous
fearlessness and confidence, or else a still becharmed panic which it was
impossible not to marvel at. Like household dogs they came snuffling round us,
right up to our gunwales, and touching them; till it almost seemed that some
spell had suddenly domesticated them. Queequeg patted their foreheads; Starbuck
scratched their backs with his lance; but fearful of the consequences, for the
time refrained from darting it.
But
far beneath this wondrous world upon the surface, another and still stranger
world met our eyes as we gazed over the side. For, suspended in those watery
vaults, floated the forms of the nursing mothers of the whales, and those that
by their enormous girth seemed shortly to become mothers. The lake, as I have
hinted, was to a considerable depth exceedingly transparent; and as human
infants while suckling will calmly and fixedly gaze away from the breast, as if
leading two different lives at the time; and while yet drawing mortal
nourishment, be still spiritually feasting upon some unearthly
reminiscence;—even so did the young of these whales seem looking up towards us,
but not at us, as if we were but a bit of Gulfweed in their new-born sight.
Floating on their sides, the mothers also seemed quietly eyeing us. One of
these little infants, that from certain queer tokens seemed hardly a day old,
might have measured some fourteen feet in length, and some six feet in girth.
He was a little frisky; though as yet his body seemed scarce yet recovered from
that irksome position it had so lately occupied in the maternal reticule;
where, tail to head, and all ready for the final spring, the unborn whale lies
bent like a Tartar's bow. The delicate side-fins, and the palms of his flukes,
still freshly retained the plaited crumpled appearance of a baby's ears newly
arrived from foreign parts.
“Line!
line!” cried Queequeg, looking over the gunwale; “him fast! him fast!—Who line
him! Who struck?—Two whale; one big, one little!”
“What
ails ye, man?” cried Starbuck.
“Look-e
here,” said Queequeg, pointing down.
As
when the stricken whale, that from the tub has reeled out hundreds of fathoms
of rope; as, after deep sounding, he floats up again, and shows the slackened
curling line buoyantly rising and spiralling towards the air; so now, Starbuck
saw long coils of the umbilical cord of Madame Leviathan, by which the young
cub seemed still tethered to its dam. Not seldom in the rapid vicissitudes of
the chase, this natural line, with the maternal end loose, becomes entangled
with the hempen one, so that the cub is thereby trapped. Some of the subtlest
secrets of the seas seemed divulged to us in this enchanted pond. We saw young
Leviathan amours in the deep.*
*The
sperm whale, as with all other species of the Leviathan, but unlike most other
fish, breeds indifferently at all seasons; after a gestation which may probably
be set down at nine months, producing but one at a time; though in some few
known instances giving birth to an Esau and Jacob:—a contingency provided for
in suckling by two teats, curiously situated, one on each side of the anus; but
the breasts themselves extend upwards from that. When by chance these precious
parts in a nursing whale are cut by the hunter's lance, the mother's pouring
milk and blood rivallingly discolour the sea for rods. The milk is very sweet
and rich; it has been tasted by man; it might do well with strawberries. When
overflowing with mutual esteem, the whales salute more hominum.
And
thus, though surrounded by circle upon circle of consternations and affrights,
did these inscrutable creatures at the centre freely and fearlessly indulge in
all peaceful concernments; yea, serenely revelled in dalliance and delight. But
even so, amid the tornadoed Atlantic of my being, do I myself still for ever
centrally disport in mute calm; and while ponderous planets of unwaning woe
revolve round me, deep down and deep inland there I still bathe me in eternal
mildness of joy.
Meanwhile,
as we thus lay entranced, the occasional sudden frantic spectacles in the
distance evinced the activity of the other boats, still engaged in drugging the
whales on the frontier of the host; or possibly carrying on the war within the
first circle, where abundance of room and some convenient retreats were
afforded them. But the sight of the enraged drugged whales now and then blindly
darting to and fro across the circles, was nothing to what at last met our
eyes. It is sometimes the custom when fast to a whale more than commonly
powerful and alert, to seek to hamstring him, as it were, by sundering or
maiming his gigantic tail-tendon. It is done by darting a short-handled
cutting-spade, to which is attached a rope for hauling it back again. A whale
wounded (as we afterwards learned) in this part, but not effectually, as it
seemed, had broken away from the boat, carrying along with him half of the
harpoon line; and in the extraordinary agony of the wound, he was now dashing
among the revolving circles like the lone mounted desperado Arnold, at the
battle of Saratoga, carrying dismay wherever he went.
But
agonizing as was the wound of this whale, and an appalling spectacle enough,
any way; yet the peculiar horror with which he seemed to inspire the rest of
the herd, was owing to a cause which at first the intervening distance obscured
from us. But at length we perceived that by one of the unimaginable accidents
of the fishery, this whale had become entangled in the harpoon-line that he
towed; he had also run away with the cutting-spade in him; and while the free
end of the rope attached to that weapon, had permanently caught in the coils of
the harpoon-line round his tail, the cutting-spade itself had worked loose from
his flesh. So that tormented to madness, he was now churning through the water,
violently flailing with his flexible tail, and tossing the keen spade about
him, wounding and murdering his own comrades.
This
terrific object seemed to recall the whole herd from their stationary fright.
First, the whales forming the margin of our lake began to crowd a little, and
tumble against each other, as if lifted by half spent billows from afar; then
the lake itself began faintly to heave and swell; the submarine bridal-chambers
and nurseries vanished; in more and more contracting orbits the whales in the
more central circles began to swim in thickening clusters. Yes, the long calm
was departing. A low advancing hum was soon heard; and then like to the
tumultuous masses of block-ice when the great river Hudson breaks up in Spring,
the entire host of whales came tumbling upon their inner centre, as if to pile
themselves up in one common mountain. Instantly Starbuck and Queequeg changed
places; Starbuck taking the stern.
“Oars!
Oars!” he intensely whispered, seizing the helm—“gripe your oars, and clutch
your souls, now! My God, men, stand by! Shove him off, you Queequeg—the whale
there!—prick him!—hit him! Stand up—stand up, and stay so! Spring, men—pull,
men; never mind their backs—scrape them!—scrape away!”
The
boat was now all but jammed between two vast black bulks, leaving a narrow
Dardanelles between their long lengths. But by desperate endeavor we at last
shot into a temporary opening; then giving way rapidly, and at the same time
earnestly watching for another outlet. After many similar hair-breadth escapes,
we at last swiftly glided into what had just been one of the outer circles, but
now crossed by random whales, all violently making for one centre. This lucky salvation
was cheaply purchased by the loss of Queequeg's hat, who, while standing in the
bows to prick the fugitive whales, had his hat taken clean from his head by the
air-eddy made by the sudden tossing of a pair of broad flukes close by.
Riotous
and disordered as the universal commotion now was, it soon resolved itself into
what seemed a systematic movement; for having clumped together at last in one
dense body, they then renewed their onward flight with augmented fleetness.
Further pursuit was useless; but the boats still lingered in their wake to pick
up what drugged whales might be dropped astern, and likewise to secure one
which Flask had killed and waifed. The waif is a pennoned pole, two or three of
which are carried by every boat; and which, when additional game is at hand,
are inserted upright into the floating body of a dead whale, both to mark its
place on the sea, and also as token of prior possession, should the boats of
any other ship draw near.
The
result of this lowering was somewhat illustrative of that sagacious saying in
the Fishery,—the more whales the less fish. Of all the drugged whales only one
was captured. The rest contrived to escape for the time, but only to be taken,
as will hereafter be seen, by some other craft than the Pequod.
CHAPTER
88. Schools and Schoolmasters.
The
previous chapter gave account of an immense body or herd of Sperm Whales, and
there was also then given the probable cause inducing those vast aggregations.
Now,
though such great bodies are at times encountered, yet, as must have been seen,
even at the present day, small detached bands are occasionally observed,
embracing from twenty to fifty individuals each. Such bands are known as
schools. They generally are of two sorts; those composed almost entirely of
females, and those mustering none but young vigorous males, or bulls, as they
are familiarly designated.
In
cavalier attendance upon the school of females, you invariably see a male of
full grown magnitude, but not old; who, upon any alarm, evinces his gallantry
by falling in the rear and covering the flight of his ladies. In truth, this
gentleman is a luxurious Ottoman, swimming about over the watery world,
surroundingly accompanied by all the solaces and endearments of the harem. The
contrast between this Ottoman and his concubines is striking; because, while he
is always of the largest leviathanic proportions, the ladies, even at full
growth, are not more than one-third of the bulk of an average-sized male. They
are comparatively delicate, indeed; I dare say, not to exceed half a dozen
yards round the waist. Nevertheless, it cannot be denied, that upon the whole
they are hereditarily entitled to en bon point.
It
is very curious to watch this harem and its lord in their indolent ramblings. Like
fashionables, they are for ever on the move in leisurely search of variety. You
meet them on the Line in time for the full flower of the Equatorial feeding
season, having just returned, perhaps, from spending the summer in the Northern
seas, and so cheating summer of all unpleasant weariness and warmth. By the
time they have lounged up and down the promenade of the Equator awhile, they
start for the Oriental waters in anticipation of the cool season there, and so
evade the other excessive temperature of the year.
When
serenely advancing on one of these journeys, if any strange suspicious sights
are seen, my lord whale keeps a wary eye on his interesting family. Should any
unwarrantably pert young Leviathan coming that way, presume to draw
confidentially close to one of the ladies, with what prodigious fury the Bashaw
assails him, and chases him away! High times, indeed, if unprincipled young
rakes like him are to be permitted to invade the sanctity of domestic bliss;
though do what the Bashaw will, he cannot keep the most notorious Lothario out
of his bed; for, alas! all fish bed in common. As ashore, the ladies often
cause the most terrible duels among their rival admirers; just so with the
whales, who sometimes come to deadly battle, and all for love. They fence with
their long lower jaws, sometimes locking them together, and so striving for the
supremacy like elks that warringly interweave their antlers. Not a few are
captured having the deep scars of these encounters,—furrowed heads, broken
teeth, scolloped fins; and in some instances, wrenched and dislocated mouths.
But
supposing the invader of domestic bliss to betake himself away at the first
rush of the harem's lord, then is it very diverting to watch that lord. Gently
he insinuates his vast bulk among them again and revels there awhile, still in
tantalizing vicinity to young Lothario, like pious Solomon devoutly worshipping
among his thousand concubines. Granting other whales to be in sight, the
fishermen will seldom give chase to one of these Grand Turks; for these Grand
Turks are too lavish of their strength, and hence their unctuousness is small.
As for the sons and the daughters they beget, why, those sons and daughters
must take care of themselves; at least, with only the maternal help. For like
certain other omnivorous roving lovers that might be named, my Lord Whale has
no taste for the nursery, however much for the bower; and so, being a great
traveller, he leaves his anonymous babies all over the world; every baby an
exotic. In good time, nevertheless, as the ardour of youth declines; as years
and dumps increase; as reflection lends her solemn pauses; in short, as a
general lassitude overtakes the sated Turk; then a love of ease and virtue
supplants the love for maidens; our Ottoman enters upon the impotent,
repentant, admonitory stage of life, forswears, disbands the harem, and grown
to an exemplary, sulky old soul, goes about all alone among the meridians and
parallels saying his prayers, and warning each young Leviathan from his amorous
errors.
Now,
as the harem of whales is called by the fishermen a school, so is the lord and
master of that school technically known as the schoolmaster. It is therefore
not in strict character, however admirably satirical, that after going to
school himself, he should then go abroad inculcating not what he learned there,
but the folly of it. His title, schoolmaster, would very naturally seem derived
from the name bestowed upon the harem itself, but some have surmised that the
man who first thus entitled this sort of Ottoman whale, must have read the
memoirs of Vidocq, and informed himself what sort of a country-schoolmaster
that famous Frenchman was in his younger days, and what was the nature of those
occult lessons he inculcated into some of his pupils.
The
same secludedness and isolation to which the schoolmaster whale betakes himself
in his advancing years, is true of all aged Sperm Whales. Almost universally, a
lone whale—as a solitary Leviathan is called—proves an ancient one. Like
venerable moss-bearded Daniel Boone, he will have no one near him but Nature
herself; and her he takes to wife in the wilderness of waters, and the best of
wives she is, though she keeps so many moody secrets.
The
schools composing none but young and vigorous males, previously mentioned,
offer a strong contrast to the harem schools. For while those female whales are
characteristically timid, the young males, or forty-barrel-bulls, as they call
them, are by far the most pugnacious of all Leviathans, and proverbially the most
dangerous to encounter; excepting those wondrous grey-headed, grizzled whales,
sometimes met, and these will fight you like grim fiends exasperated by a penal
gout.
The
Forty-barrel-bull schools are larger than the harem schools. Like a mob of
young collegians, they are full of fight, fun, and wickedness, tumbling round
the world at such a reckless, rollicking rate, that no prudent underwriter
would insure them any more than he would a riotous lad at Yale or Harvard. They
soon relinquish this turbulence though, and when about three-fourths grown,
break up, and separately go about in quest of settlements, that is, harems.
Another
point of difference between the male and female schools is still more
characteristic of the sexes. Say you strike a Forty-barrel-bull—poor devil! all
his comrades quit him. But strike a member of the harem school, and her
companions swim around her with every token of concern, sometimes lingering so
near her and so long, as themselves to fall a prey.
CHAPTER
89. Fast-Fish and Loose-Fish.
The
allusion to the waif and waif-poles in the last chapter but one, necessitates
some account of the laws and regulations of the whale fishery, of which the
waif may be deemed the grand symbol and badge.
It
frequently happens that when several ships are cruising in company, a whale may
be struck by one vessel, then escape, and be finally killed and captured by
another vessel; and herein are indirectly comprised many minor contingencies,
all partaking of this one grand feature. For example,—after a weary and
perilous chase and capture of a whale, the body may get loose from the ship by
reason of a violent storm; and drifting far away to leeward, be retaken by a
second whaler, who, in a calm, snugly tows it alongside, without risk of life
or line. Thus the most vexatious and violent disputes would often arise between
the fishermen, were there not some written or unwritten, universal, undisputed
law applicable to all cases.
Perhaps
the only formal whaling code authorized by legislative enactment, was that of
Holland. It was decreed by the States-General in A.D. 1695. But though no other
nation has ever had any written whaling law, yet the American fishermen have
been their own legislators and lawyers in this matter. They have provided a system
which for terse comprehensiveness surpasses Justinian's Pandects and the
By-laws of the Chinese Society for the Suppression of Meddling with other
People's Business. Yes; these laws might be engraven on a Queen Anne's
farthing, or the barb of a harpoon, and worn round the neck, so small are they.
I.
A Fast-Fish belongs to the party fast to it.
II.
A Loose-Fish is fair game for anybody who can soonest catch it.
But
what plays the mischief with this masterly code is the admirable brevity of it,
which necessitates a vast volume of commentaries to expound it.
First:
What is a Fast-Fish? Alive or dead a fish is technically fast, when it is
connected with an occupied ship or boat, by any medium at all controllable by
the occupant or occupants,—a mast, an oar, a nine-inch cable, a telegraph wire,
or a strand of cobweb, it is all the same. Likewise a fish is technically fast
when it bears a waif, or any other recognised symbol of possession; so long as
the party waifing it plainly evince their ability at any time to take it
alongside, as well as their intention so to do.
These
are scientific commentaries; but the commentaries of the whalemen themselves
sometimes consist in hard words and harder knocks—the Coke-upon-Littleton of
the fist. True, among the more upright and honorable whalemen allowances are
always made for peculiar cases, where it would be an outrageous moral injustice
for one party to claim possession of a whale previously chased or killed by
another party. But others are by no means so scrupulous.
Some
fifty years ago there was a curious case of whale-trover litigated in England,
wherein the plaintiffs set forth that after a hard chase of a whale in the
Northern seas; and when indeed they (the plaintiffs) had succeeded in
harpooning the fish; they were at last, through peril of their lives, obliged
to forsake not only their lines, but their boat itself. Ultimately the
defendants (the crew of another ship) came up with the whale, struck, killed,
seized, and finally appropriated it before the very eyes of the plaintiffs. And
when those defendants were remonstrated with, their captain snapped his fingers
in the plaintiffs' teeth, and assured them that by way of doxology to the deed
he had done, he would now retain their line, harpoons, and boat, which had
remained attached to the whale at the time of the seizure. Wherefore the
plaintiffs now sued for the recovery of the value of their whale, line,
harpoons, and boat.
Mr.
Erskine was counsel for the defendants; Lord Ellenborough was the judge. In the
course of the defence, the witty Erskine went on to illustrate his position, by
alluding to a recent crim. con. case, wherein a gentleman, after in vain trying
to bridle his wife's viciousness, had at last abandoned her upon the seas of
life; but in the course of years, repenting of that step, he instituted an
action to recover possession of her. Erskine was on the other side; and he then
supported it by saying, that though the gentleman had originally harpooned the
lady, and had once had her fast, and only by reason of the great stress of her
plunging viciousness, had at last abandoned her; yet abandon her he did, so
that she became a loose-fish; and therefore when a subsequent gentleman
re-harpooned her, the lady then became that subsequent gentleman's property,
along with whatever harpoon might have been found sticking in her.
Now
in the present case Erskine contended that the examples of the whale and the
lady were reciprocally illustrative of each other.
These
pleadings, and the counter pleadings, being duly heard, the very learned judge
in set terms decided, to wit,—That as for the boat, he awarded it to the
plaintiffs, because they had merely abandoned it to save their lives; but that
with regard to the controverted whale, harpoons, and line, they belonged to the
defendants; the whale, because it was a Loose-Fish at the time of the final
capture; and the harpoons and line because when the fish made off with them, it
(the fish) acquired a property in those articles; and hence anybody who
afterwards took the fish had a right to them. Now the defendants afterwards took
the fish; ergo, the aforesaid articles were theirs.
A
common man looking at this decision of the very learned Judge, might possibly
object to it. But ploughed up to the primary rock of the matter, the two great
principles laid down in the twin whaling laws previously quoted, and applied
and elucidated by Lord Ellenborough in the above cited case; these two laws
touching Fast-Fish and Loose-Fish, I say, will, on reflection, be found the
fundamentals of all human jurisprudence; for notwithstanding its complicated
tracery of sculpture, the Temple of the Law, like the Temple of the
Philistines, has but two props to stand on.
Is
it not a saying in every one's mouth, Possession is half of the law: that is,
regardless of how the thing came into possession? But often possession is the
whole of the law. What are the sinews and souls of Russian serfs and Republican
slaves but Fast-Fish, whereof possession is the whole of the law? What to the
rapacious landlord is the widow's last mite but a Fast-Fish? What is yonder
undetected villain's marble mansion with a door-plate for a waif; what is that
but a Fast-Fish? What is the ruinous discount which Mordecai, the broker, gets
from poor Woebegone, the bankrupt, on a loan to keep Woebegone's family from
starvation; what is that ruinous discount but a Fast-Fish? What is the
Archbishop of Savesoul's income of £100,000 seized from the scant bread and
cheese of hundreds of thousands of broken-backed laborers (all sure of heaven
without any of Savesoul's help) what is that globular £100,000 but a Fast-Fish?
What are the Duke of Dunder's hereditary towns and hamlets but Fast-Fish? What
to that redoubted harpooneer, John Bull, is poor Ireland, but a Fast-Fish? What
to that apostolic lancer, Brother Jonathan, is Texas but a Fast-Fish? And
concerning all these, is not Possession the whole of the law?
But
if the doctrine of Fast-Fish be pretty generally applicable, the kindred
doctrine of Loose-Fish is still more widely so. That is internationally and
universally applicable.
What
was America in 1492 but a Loose-Fish, in which Columbus struck the Spanish
standard by way of waifing it for his royal master and mistress? What was
Poland to the Czar? What Greece to the Turk? What India to England? What at
last will Mexico be to the United States? All Loose-Fish.
What
are the Rights of Man and the Liberties of the World but Loose-Fish? What all
men's minds and opinions but Loose-Fish? What is the principle of religious
belief in them but a Loose-Fish? What to the ostentatious smuggling verbalists
are the thoughts of thinkers but Loose-Fish? What is the great globe itself but
a Loose-Fish? And what are you, reader, but a Loose-Fish and a Fast-Fish, too?
CHAPTER
90. Heads or Tails.
“De
balena vero sufficit, si rex habeat caput, et regina caudam.” Bracton, l. 3, c. 3.
Latin
from the books of the Laws of England, which taken along with the context,
means, that of all whales captured by anybody on the coast of that land, the
King, as Honorary Grand Harpooneer, must have the head, and the Queen be
respectfully presented with the tail. A division which, in the whale, is much
like halving an apple; there is no intermediate remainder. Now as this law,
under a modified form, is to this day in force in England; and as it offers in
various respects a strange anomaly touching the general law of Fast and
Loose-Fish, it is here treated of in a separate chapter, on the same courteous
principle that prompts the English railways to be at the expense of a separate
car, specially reserved for the accommodation of royalty. In the first place,
in curious proof of the fact that the above-mentioned law is still in force, I
proceed to lay before you a circumstance that happened within the last two
years.
It
seems that some honest mariners of Dover, or Sandwich, or some one of the
Cinque Ports, had after a hard chase succeeded in killing and beaching a fine
whale which they had originally descried afar off from the shore. Now the
Cinque Ports are partially or somehow under the jurisdiction of a sort of
policeman or beadle, called a Lord Warden. Holding the office directly from the
crown, I believe, all the royal emoluments incident to the Cinque Port
territories become by assignment his. By some writers this office is called a
sinecure. But not so. Because the Lord Warden is busily employed at times in
fobbing his perquisites; which are his chiefly by virtue of that same fobbing
of them.
Now
when these poor sun-burnt mariners, bare-footed, and with their trowsers rolled
high up on their eely legs, had wearily hauled their fat fish high and dry,
promising themselves a good £150 from the precious oil and bone; and in fantasy
sipping rare tea with their wives, and good ale with their cronies, upon the
strength of their respective shares; up steps a very learned and most Christian
and charitable gentleman, with a copy of Blackstone under his arm; and laying
it upon the whale's head, he says—“Hands off! this fish, my masters, is a
Fast-Fish. I seize it as the Lord Warden's.” Upon this the poor mariners in
their respectful consternation—so truly English—knowing not what to say, fall
to vigorously scratching their heads all round; meanwhile ruefully glancing
from the whale to the stranger. But that did in no wise mend the matter, or at
all soften the hard heart of the learned gentleman with the copy of Blackstone.
At length one of them, after long scratching about for his ideas, made bold to
speak,
“Please,
sir, who is the Lord Warden?”
“The
Duke.”
“But
the duke had nothing to do with taking this fish?”
“It
is his.”
“We
have been at great trouble, and peril, and some expense, and is all that to go
to the Duke's benefit; we getting nothing at all for our pains but our
blisters?”
“It
is his.”
“Is
the Duke so very poor as to be forced to this desperate mode of getting a
livelihood?”
“It
is his.”
“I
thought to relieve my old bed-ridden mother by part of my share of this whale.”
“It
is his.”
“Won't
the Duke be content with a quarter or a half?”
“It
is his.”
In
a word, the whale was seized and sold, and his Grace the Duke of Wellington
received the money. Thinking that viewed in some particular lights, the case
might by a bare possibility in some small degree be deemed, under the
circumstances, a rather hard one, an honest clergyman of the town respectfully
addressed a note to his Grace, begging him to take the case of those
unfortunate mariners into full consideration. To which my Lord Duke in
substance replied (both letters were published) that he had already done so,
and received the money, and would be obliged to the reverend gentleman if for
the future he (the reverend gentleman) would decline meddling with other
people's business. Is this the still militant old man, standing at the corners
of the three kingdoms, on all hands coercing alms of beggars?
It
will readily be seen that in this case the alleged right of the Duke to the
whale was a delegated one from the Sovereign. We must needs inquire then on
what principle the Sovereign is originally invested with that right. The law
itself has already been set forth. But Plowdon gives us the reason for it. Says
Plowdon, the whale so caught belongs to the King and Queen, “because of its
superior excellence.” And by the soundest commentators this has ever been held
a cogent argument in such matters.
But
why should the King have the head, and the Queen the tail? A reason for that,
ye lawyers!
In
his treatise on “Queen-Gold,” or Queen-pinmoney, an old King's Bench author,
one William Prynne, thus discourseth: “Ye tail is ye Queen's, that ye Queen's
wardrobe may be supplied with ye whalebone.” Now this was written at a time
when the black limber bone of the Greenland or Right whale was largely used in
ladies' bodices. But this same bone is not in the tail; it is in the head,
which is a sad mistake for a sagacious lawyer like Prynne. But is the Queen a
mermaid, to be presented with a tail? An allegorical meaning may lurk here.
There
are two royal fish so styled by the English law writers—the whale and the
sturgeon; both royal property under certain limitations, and nominally
supplying the tenth branch of the crown's ordinary revenue. I know not that any
other author has hinted of the matter; but by inference it seems to me that the
sturgeon must be divided in the same way as the whale, the King receiving the
highly dense and elastic head peculiar to that fish, which, symbolically
regarded, may possibly be humorously grounded upon some presumed congeniality.
And thus there seems a reason in all things, even in law.
CHAPTER
91. The Pequod Meets The Rose-Bud.
“In
vain it was to rake for Ambergriese in the paunch of this Leviathan,
insufferable fetor denying not inquiry.” Sir T. Browne, V.E.
It
was a week or two after the last whaling scene recounted, and when we were
slowly sailing over a sleepy, vapory, mid-day sea, that the many noses on the
Pequod's deck proved more vigilant discoverers than the three pairs of eyes
aloft. A peculiar and not very pleasant smell was smelt in the sea.
“I
will bet something now,” said Stubb, “that somewhere hereabouts are some of
those drugged whales we tickled the other day. I thought they would keel up
before long.”
Presently,
the vapors in advance slid aside; and there in the distance lay a ship, whose
furled sails betokened that some sort of whale must be alongside. As we glided
nearer, the stranger showed French colours from his peak; and by the eddying
cloud of vulture sea-fowl that circled, and hovered, and swooped around him, it
was plain that the whale alongside must be what the fishermen call a blasted
whale, that is, a whale that has died unmolested on the sea, and so floated an
unappropriated corpse. It may well be conceived, what an unsavory odor such a
mass must exhale; worse than an Assyrian city in the plague, when the living
are incompetent to bury the departed. So intolerable indeed is it regarded by
some, that no cupidity could persuade them to moor alongside of it. Yet are
there those who will still do it; notwithstanding the fact that the oil
obtained from such subjects is of a very inferior quality, and by no means of
the nature of attar-of-rose.
Coming
still nearer with the expiring breeze, we saw that the Frenchman had a second
whale alongside; and this second whale seemed even more of a nosegay than the
first. In truth, it turned out to be one of those problematical whales that
seem to dry up and die with a sort of prodigious dyspepsia, or indigestion;
leaving their defunct bodies almost entirely bankrupt of anything like oil.
Nevertheless, in the proper place we shall see that no knowing fisherman will
ever turn up his nose at such a whale as this, however much he may shun blasted
whales in general.
The
Pequod had now swept so nigh to the stranger, that Stubb vowed he recognised
his cutting spade-pole entangled in the lines that were knotted round the tail
of one of these whales.
“There's
a pretty fellow, now,” he banteringly laughed, standing in the ship's bows,
“there's a jackal for ye! I well know that these Crappoes of Frenchmen are but
poor devils in the fishery; sometimes lowering their boats for breakers,
mistaking them for Sperm Whale spouts; yes, and sometimes sailing from their
port with their hold full of boxes of tallow candles, and cases of snuffers,
foreseeing that all the oil they will get won't be enough to dip the Captain's
wick into; aye, we all know these things; but look ye, here's a Crappo that is
content with our leavings, the drugged whale there, I mean; aye, and is content
too with scraping the dry bones of that other precious fish he has there. Poor
devil! I say, pass round a hat, some one, and let's make him a present of a
little oil for dear charity's sake. For what oil he'll get from that drugged
whale there, wouldn't be fit to burn in a jail; no, not in a condemned cell.
And as for the other whale, why, I'll agree to get more oil by chopping up and
trying out these three masts of ours, than he'll get from that bundle of bones;
though, now that I think of it, it may contain something worth a good deal more
than oil; yes, ambergris. I wonder now if our old man has thought of that. It's
worth trying. Yes, I'm for it;” and so saying he started for the quarter-deck.
By
this time the faint air had become a complete calm; so that whether or no, the
Pequod was now fairly entrapped in the smell, with no hope of escaping except
by its breezing up again. Issuing from the cabin, Stubb now called his boat's
crew, and pulled off for the stranger. Drawing across her bow, he perceived
that in accordance with the fanciful French taste, the upper part of her
stem-piece was carved in the likeness of a huge drooping stalk, was painted
green, and for thorns had copper spikes projecting from it here and there; the
whole terminating in a symmetrical folded bulb of a bright red colour. Upon her
head boards, in large gilt letters, he read “Bouton de Rose,”—Rose-button, or
Rose-bud; and this was the romantic name of this aromatic ship.
Though
Stubb did not understand the Bouton part of the inscription, yet the word rose,
and the bulbous figure-head put together, sufficiently explained the whole to
him.
“A
wooden rose-bud, eh?” he cried with his hand to his nose, “that will do very
well; but how like all creation it smells!”
Now
in order to hold direct communication with the people on deck, he had to pull
round the bows to the starboard side, and thus come close to the blasted whale;
and so talk over it.
Arrived
then at this spot, with one hand still to his nose, he bawled—“Bouton-de-Rose,
ahoy! are there any of you Bouton-de-Roses that speak English?”
“Yes,”
rejoined a Guernsey-man from the bulwarks, who turned out to be the chief-mate.
“Well,
then, my Bouton-de-Rose-bud, have you seen the White Whale?”
“What
whale?”
“The
White Whale—a Sperm Whale—Moby Dick, have ye seen him?
“Never
heard of such a whale. Cachalot Blanche! White Whale—no.”
“Very
good, then; good bye now, and I'll call again in a minute.”
Then
rapidly pulling back towards the Pequod, and seeing Ahab leaning over the
quarter-deck rail awaiting his report, he moulded his two hands into a trumpet
and shouted—“No, Sir! No!” Upon which Ahab retired, and Stubb returned to the
Frenchman.
He
now perceived that the Guernsey-man, who had just got into the chains, and was
using a cutting-spade, had slung his nose in a sort of bag.
“What's
the matter with your nose, there?” said Stubb. “Broke it?”
“I
wish it was broken, or that I didn't have any nose at all!” answered the
Guernsey-man, who did not seem to relish the job he was at very much. “But what
are you holding yours for?”
“Oh,
nothing! It's a wax nose; I have to hold it on. Fine day, ain't it? Air rather
gardenny, I should say; throw us a bunch of posies, will ye, Bouton-de-Rose?”
“What
in the devil's name do you want here?” roared the Guernseyman, flying into a
sudden passion.
“Oh!
keep cool—cool? yes, that's the word! why don't you pack those whales in ice
while you're working at 'em? But joking aside, though; do you know, Rose-bud,
that it's all nonsense trying to get any oil out of such whales? As for that
dried up one, there, he hasn't a gill in his whole carcase.”
“I
know that well enough; but, d'ye see, the Captain here won't believe it; this
is his first voyage; he was a Cologne manufacturer before. But come aboard, and
mayhap he'll believe you, if he won't me; and so I'll get out of this dirty
scrape.”
“Anything
to oblige ye, my sweet and pleasant fellow,” rejoined Stubb, and with that he
soon mounted to the deck. There a queer scene presented itself. The sailors, in
tasselled caps of red worsted, were getting the heavy tackles in readiness for
the whales. But they worked rather slow and talked very fast, and seemed in anything
but a good humor. All their noses upwardly projected from their faces like so
many jib-booms. Now and then pairs of them would drop their work, and run up to
the mast-head to get some fresh air. Some thinking they would catch the plague,
dipped oakum in coal-tar, and at intervals held it to their nostrils. Others
having broken the stems of their pipes almost short off at the bowl, were
vigorously puffing tobacco-smoke, so that it constantly filled their
olfactories.
Stubb
was struck by a shower of outcries and anathemas proceeding from the Captain's
round-house abaft; and looking in that direction saw a fiery face thrust from
behind the door, which was held ajar from within. This was the tormented
surgeon, who, after in vain remonstrating against the proceedings of the day,
had betaken himself to the Captain's round-house (cabinet he called it) to
avoid the pest; but still, could not help yelling out his entreaties and
indignations at times.
Marking
all this, Stubb argued well for his scheme, and turning to the Guernsey-man had
a little chat with him, during which the stranger mate expressed his
detestation of his Captain as a conceited ignoramus, who had brought them all
into so unsavory and unprofitable a pickle. Sounding him carefully, Stubb further
perceived that the Guernsey-man had not the slightest suspicion concerning the
ambergris. He therefore held his peace on that head, but otherwise was quite
frank and confidential with him, so that the two quickly concocted a little
plan for both circumventing and satirizing the Captain, without his at all
dreaming of distrusting their sincerity. According to this little plan of
theirs, the Guernsey-man, under cover of an interpreter's office, was to tell
the Captain what he pleased, but as coming from Stubb; and as for Stubb, he was
to utter any nonsense that should come uppermost in him during the interview.
By
this time their destined victim appeared from his cabin. He was a small and
dark, but rather delicate looking man for a sea-captain, with large whiskers
and moustache, however; and wore a red cotton velvet vest with watch-seals at
his side. To this gentleman, Stubb was now politely introduced by the
Guernsey-man, who at once ostentatiously put on the aspect of interpreting
between them.
“What
shall I say to him first?” said he.
“Why,”
said Stubb, eyeing the velvet vest and the watch and seals, “you may as well
begin by telling him that he looks a sort of babyish to me, though I don't
pretend to be a judge.”
“He
says, Monsieur,” said the Guernsey-man, in French, turning to his captain,
“that only yesterday his ship spoke a vessel, whose captain and chief-mate,
with six sailors, had all died of a fever caught from a blasted whale they had
brought alongside.”
Upon
this the captain started, and eagerly desired to know more.
“What
now?” said the Guernsey-man to Stubb.
“Why,
since he takes it so easy, tell him that now I have eyed him carefully, I'm
quite certain that he's no more fit to command a whale-ship than a St. Jago
monkey. In fact, tell him from me he's a baboon.”
“He
vows and declares, Monsieur, that the other whale, the dried one, is far more
deadly than the blasted one; in fine, Monsieur, he conjures us, as we value our
lives, to cut loose from these fish.”
Instantly
the captain ran forward, and in a loud voice commanded his crew to desist from
hoisting the cutting-tackles, and at once cast loose the cables and chains
confining the whales to the ship.
“What
now?” said the Guernsey-man, when the Captain had returned to them.
“Why,
let me see; yes, you may as well tell him now that—that—in fact, tell him I've
diddled him, and (aside to himself) perhaps somebody else.”
“He
says, Monsieur, that he's very happy to have been of any service to us.”
Hearing
this, the captain vowed that they were the grateful parties (meaning himself
and mate) and concluded by inviting Stubb down into his cabin to drink a bottle
of Bordeaux.
“He
wants you to take a glass of wine with him,” said the interpreter.
“Thank
him heartily; but tell him it's against my principles to drink with the man
I've diddled. In fact, tell him I must go.”
“He
says, Monsieur, that his principles won't admit of his drinking; but that if
Monsieur wants to live another day to drink, then Monsieur had best drop all
four boats, and pull the ship away from these whales, for it's so calm they
won't drift.”
By
this time Stubb was over the side, and getting into his boat, hailed the
Guernsey-man to this effect,—that having a long tow-line in his boat, he would
do what he could to help them, by pulling out the lighter whale of the two from
the ship's side. While the Frenchman's boats, then, were engaged in towing the
ship one way, Stubb benevolently towed away at his whale the other way, ostentatiously
slacking out a most unusually long tow-line.
Presently
a breeze sprang up; Stubb feigned to cast off from the whale; hoisting his
boats, the Frenchman soon increased his distance, while the Pequod slid in
between him and Stubb's whale. Whereupon Stubb quickly pulled to the floating
body, and hailing the Pequod to give notice of his intentions, at once
proceeded to reap the fruit of his unrighteous cunning. Seizing his sharp
boat-spade, he commenced an excavation in the body, a little behind the side
fin. You would almost have thought he was digging a cellar there in the sea;
and when at length his spade struck against the gaunt ribs, it was like turning
up old Roman tiles and pottery buried in fat English loam. His boat's crew were
all in high excitement, eagerly helping their chief, and looking as anxious as
gold-hunters.
And
all the time numberless fowls were diving, and ducking, and screaming, and
yelling, and fighting around them. Stubb was beginning to look disappointed,
especially as the horrible nosegay increased, when suddenly from out the very
heart of this plague, there stole a faint stream of perfume, which flowed
through the tide of bad smells without being absorbed by it, as one river will
flow into and then along with another, without at all blending with it for a
time.
“I
have it, I have it,” cried Stubb, with delight, striking something in the
subterranean regions, “a purse! a purse!”
Dropping
his spade, he thrust both hands in, and drew out handfuls of something that
looked like ripe Windsor soap, or rich mottled old cheese; very unctuous and
savory withal. You might easily dent it with your thumb; it is of a hue between
yellow and ash colour. And this, good friends, is ambergris, worth a gold
guinea an ounce to any druggist. Some six handfuls were obtained; but more was
unavoidably lost in the sea, and still more, perhaps, might have been secured
were it not for impatient Ahab's loud command to Stubb to desist, and come on
board, else the ship would bid them good bye.
CHAPTER
92. Ambergris.
Now
this ambergris is a very curious substance, and so important as an article of
commerce, that in 1791 a certain Nantucket-born Captain Coffin was examined at
the bar of the English House of Commons on that subject. For at that time, and
indeed until a comparatively late day, the precise origin of ambergris remained,
like amber itself, a problem to the learned. Though the word ambergris is but
the French compound for grey amber, yet the two substances are quite distinct.
For amber, though at times found on the sea-coast, is also dug up in some far
inland soils, whereas ambergris is never found except upon the sea. Besides,
amber is a hard, transparent, brittle, odorless substance, used for
mouth-pieces to pipes, for beads and ornaments; but ambergris is soft, waxy,
and so highly fragrant and spicy, that it is largely used in perfumery, in
pastiles, precious candles, hair-powders, and pomatum. The Turks use it in
cooking, and also carry it to Mecca, for the same purpose that frankincense is
carried to St. Peter's in Rome. Some wine merchants drop a few grains into
claret, to flavor it.
Who
would think, then, that such fine ladies and gentlemen should regale themselves
with an essence found in the inglorious bowels of a sick whale! Yet so it is.
By some, ambergris is supposed to be the cause, and by others the effect, of
the dyspepsia in the whale. How to cure such a dyspepsia it were hard to say,
unless by administering three or four boat loads of Brandreth's pills, and then
running out of harm's way, as laborers do in blasting rocks.
I
have forgotten to say that there were found in this ambergris, certain hard,
round, bony plates, which at first Stubb thought might be sailors' trowsers
buttons; but it afterwards turned out that they were nothing more than pieces
of small squid bones embalmed in that manner.
Now
that the incorruption of this most fragrant ambergris should be found in the
heart of such decay; is this nothing? Bethink thee of that saying of St. Paul
in Corinthians, about corruption and incorruption; how that we are sown in
dishonor, but raised in glory. And likewise call to mind that saying of
Paracelsus about what it is that maketh the best musk. Also forget not the
strange fact that of all things of ill-savor, Cologne-water, in its rudimental
manufacturing stages, is the worst.
I
should like to conclude the chapter with the above appeal, but cannot, owing to
my anxiety to repel a charge often made against whalemen, and which, in the
estimation of some already biased minds, might be considered as indirectly
substantiated by what has been said of the Frenchman's two whales. Elsewhere in
this volume the slanderous aspersion has been disproved, that the vocation of
whaling is throughout a slatternly, untidy business. But there is another thing
to rebut. They hint that all whales always smell bad. Now how did this odious
stigma originate?
I
opine, that it is plainly traceable to the first arrival of the Greenland
whaling ships in London, more than two centuries ago. Because those whalemen
did not then, and do not now, try out their oil at sea as the Southern ships
have always done; but cutting up the fresh blubber in small bits, thrust it
through the bung holes of large casks, and carry it home in that manner; the
shortness of the season in those Icy Seas, and the sudden and violent storms to
which they are exposed, forbidding any other course. The consequence is, that
upon breaking into the hold, and unloading one of these whale cemeteries, in
the Greenland dock, a savor is given forth somewhat similar to that arising
from excavating an old city grave-yard, for the foundations of a Lying-in
Hospital.
I
partly surmise also, that this wicked charge against whalers may be likewise
imputed to the existence on the coast of Greenland, in former times, of a Dutch
village called Schmerenburgh or Smeerenberg, which latter name is the one used
by the learned Fogo Von Slack, in his great work on Smells, a text-book on that
subject. As its name imports (smeer, fat; berg, to put up), this village was
founded in order to afford a place for the blubber of the Dutch whale fleet to
be tried out, without being taken home to Holland for that purpose. It was a
collection of furnaces, fat-kettles, and oil sheds; and when the works were in
full operation certainly gave forth no very pleasant savor. But all this is
quite different with a South Sea Sperm Whaler; which in a voyage of four years
perhaps, after completely filling her hold with oil, does not, perhaps, consume
fifty days in the business of boiling out; and in the state that it is casked,
the oil is nearly scentless. The truth is, that living or dead, if but decently
treated, whales as a species are by no means creatures of ill odor; nor can
whalemen be recognised, as the people of the middle ages affected to detect a
Jew in the company, by the nose. Nor indeed can the whale possibly be otherwise
than fragrant, when, as a general thing, he enjoys such high health; taking
abundance of exercise; always out of doors; though, it is true, seldom in the
open air. I say, that the motion of a Sperm Whale's flukes above water
dispenses a perfume, as when a musk-scented lady rustles her dress in a warm
parlor. What then shall I liken the Sperm Whale to for fragrance, considering
his magnitude? Must it not be to that famous elephant, with jewelled tusks, and
redolent with myrrh, which was led out of an Indian town to do honor to
Alexander the Great?
CHAPTER
93. The Castaway.
It
was but some few days after encountering the Frenchman, that a most significant
event befell the most insignificant of the Pequod's crew; an event most
lamentable; and which ended in providing the sometimes madly merry and
predestinated craft with a living and ever accompanying prophecy of whatever
shattered sequel might prove her own.
Now,
in the whale ship, it is not every one that goes in the boats. Some few hands
are reserved called ship-keepers, whose province it is to work the vessel while
the boats are pursuing the whale. As a general thing, these ship-keepers are as
hardy fellows as the men comprising the boats' crews. But if there happen to be
an unduly slender, clumsy, or timorous wight in the ship, that wight is certain
to be made a ship-keeper. It was so in the Pequod with the little negro Pippin
by nick-name, Pip by abbreviation. Poor Pip! ye have heard of him before; ye
must remember his tambourine on that dramatic midnight, so gloomy-jolly.
In
outer aspect, Pip and Dough-Boy made a match, like a black pony and a white
one, of equal developments, though of dissimilar colour, driven in one
eccentric span. But while hapless Dough-Boy was by nature dull and torpid in
his intellects, Pip, though over tender-hearted, was at bottom very bright, with
that pleasant, genial, jolly brightness peculiar to his tribe; a tribe, which
ever enjoy all holidays and festivities with finer, freer relish than any other
race. For blacks, the year's calendar should show naught but three hundred and
sixty-five Fourth of Julys and New Year's Days. Nor smile so, while I write
that this little black was brilliant, for even blackness has its brilliancy;
behold yon lustrous ebony, panelled in king's cabinets. But Pip loved life, and
all life's peaceable securities; so that the panic-striking business in which
he had somehow unaccountably become entrapped, had most sadly blurred his
brightness; though, as ere long will be seen, what was thus temporarily subdued
in him, in the end was destined to be luridly illumined by strange wild fires,
that fictitiously showed him off to ten times the natural lustre with which in
his native Tolland County in Connecticut, he had once enlivened many a
fiddler's frolic on the green; and at melodious even-tide, with his gay ha-ha!
had turned the round horizon into one star-belled tambourine. So, though in the
clear air of day, suspended against a blue-veined neck, the pure-watered
diamond drop will healthful glow; yet, when the cunning jeweller would show you
the diamond in its most impressive lustre, he lays it against a gloomy ground,
and then lights it up, not by the sun, but by some unnatural gases. Then come
out those fiery effulgences, infernally superb; then the evil-blazing diamond,
once the divinest symbol of the crystal skies, looks like some crown-jewel
stolen from the King of Hell. But let us to the story.
It
came to pass, that in the ambergris affair Stubb's after-oarsman chanced so to
sprain his hand, as for a time to become quite maimed; and, temporarily, Pip
was put into his place.
The
first time Stubb lowered with him, Pip evinced much nervousness; but happily,
for that time, escaped close contact with the whale; and therefore came off not
altogether discreditably; though Stubb observing him, took care, afterwards, to
exhort him to cherish his courageousness to the utmost, for he might often find
it needful.
Now
upon the second lowering, the boat paddled upon the whale; and as the fish
received the darted iron, it gave its customary rap, which happened, in this
instance, to be right under poor Pip's seat. The involuntary consternation of
the moment caused him to leap, paddle in hand, out of the boat; and in such a
way, that part of the slack whale line coming against his chest, he breasted it
overboard with him, so as to become entangled in it, when at last plumping into
the water. That instant the stricken whale started on a fierce run, the line
swiftly straightened; and presto! poor Pip came all foaming up to the chocks of
the boat, remorselessly dragged there by the line, which had taken several
turns around his chest and neck.
Tashtego
stood in the bows. He was full of the fire of the hunt. He hated Pip for a
poltroon. Snatching the boat-knife from its sheath, he suspended its sharp edge
over the line, and turning towards Stubb, exclaimed interrogatively, “Cut?”
Meantime Pip's blue, choked face plainly looked, Do, for God's sake! All passed
in a flash. In less than half a minute, this entire thing happened.
“Damn
him, cut!” roared Stubb; and so the whale was lost and Pip was saved.
So
soon as he recovered himself, the poor little negro was assailed by yells and
execrations from the crew. Tranquilly permitting these irregular cursings to
evaporate, Stubb then in a plain, business-like, but still half humorous
manner, cursed Pip officially; and that done, unofficially gave him much
wholesome advice. The substance was, Never jump from a boat, Pip, except—but
all the rest was indefinite, as the soundest advice ever is. Now, in general,
Stick to the boat, is your true motto in whaling; but cases will sometimes
happen when Leap from the boat, is still better. Moreover, as if perceiving at
last that if he should give undiluted conscientious advice to Pip, he would be
leaving him too wide a margin to jump in for the future; Stubb suddenly dropped
all advice, and concluded with a peremptory command, “Stick to the boat, Pip,
or by the Lord, I won't pick you up if you jump; mind that. We can't afford to
lose whales by the likes of you; a whale would sell for thirty times what you would,
Pip, in Alabama. Bear that in mind, and don't jump any more.” Hereby perhaps
Stubb indirectly hinted, that though man loved his fellow, yet man is a
money-making animal, which propensity too often interferes with his
benevolence.
But
we are all in the hands of the Gods; and Pip jumped again. It was under very
similar circumstances to the first performance; but this time he did not breast
out the line; and hence, when the whale started to run, Pip was left behind on
the sea, like a hurried traveller's trunk. Alas! Stubb was but too true to his
word. It was a beautiful, bounteous, blue day; the spangled sea calm and cool,
and flatly stretching away, all round, to the horizon, like gold-beater's skin
hammered out to the extremest. Bobbing up and down in that sea, Pip's ebon head
showed like a head of cloves. No boat-knife was lifted when he fell so rapidly
astern. Stubb's inexorable back was turned upon him; and the whale was winged.
In three minutes, a whole mile of shoreless ocean was between Pip and Stubb.
Out from the centre of the sea, poor Pip turned his crisp, curling, black head
to the sun, another lonely castaway, though the loftiest and the brightest.
Now,
in calm weather, to swim in the open ocean is as easy to the practised swimmer
as to ride in a spring-carriage ashore. But the awful lonesomeness is
intolerable. The intense concentration of self in the middle of such a
heartless immensity, my God! who can tell it? Mark, how when sailors in a dead
calm bathe in the open sea—mark how closely they hug their ship and only coast
along her sides.
But
had Stubb really abandoned the poor little negro to his fate? No; he did not
mean to, at least. Because there were two boats in his wake, and he supposed,
no doubt, that they would of course come up to Pip very quickly, and pick him
up; though, indeed, such considerations towards oarsmen jeopardized through
their own timidity, is not always manifested by the hunters in all similar
instances; and such instances not unfrequently occur; almost invariably in the
fishery, a coward, so called, is marked with the same ruthless detestation
peculiar to military navies and armies.
But
it so happened, that those boats, without seeing Pip, suddenly spying whales
close to them on one side, turned, and gave chase; and Stubb's boat was now so
far away, and he and all his crew so intent upon his fish, that Pip's ringed
horizon began to expand around him miserably. By the merest chance the ship
itself at last rescued him; but from that hour the little negro went about the
deck an idiot; such, at least, they said he was. The sea had jeeringly kept his
finite body up, but drowned the infinite of his soul. Not drowned entirely,
though. Rather carried down alive to wondrous depths, where strange shapes of
the unwarped primal world glided to and fro before his passive eyes; and the
miser-merman, Wisdom, revealed his hoarded heaps; and among the joyous,
heartless, ever-juvenile eternities, Pip saw the multitudinous,
God-omnipresent, coral insects, that out of the firmament of waters heaved the
colossal orbs. He saw God's foot upon the treadle of the loom, and spoke it;
and therefore his shipmates called him mad. So man's insanity is heaven's
sense; and wandering from all mortal reason, man comes at last to that
celestial thought, which, to reason, is absurd and frantic; and weal or woe,
feels then uncompromised, indifferent as his God.
For
the rest, blame not Stubb too hardly. The thing is common in that fishery; and
in the sequel of the narrative, it will then be seen what like abandonment
befell myself.
CHAPTER
94. A Squeeze of the Hand.
That
whale of Stubb's, so dearly purchased, was duly brought to the Pequod's side,
where all those cutting and hoisting operations previously detailed, were
regularly gone through, even to the baling of the Heidelburgh Tun, or Case.
While
some were occupied with this latter duty, others were employed in dragging away
the larger tubs, so soon as filled with the sperm; and when the proper time
arrived, this same sperm was carefully manipulated ere going to the try-works,
of which anon.
It
had cooled and crystallized to such a degree, that when, with several others, I
sat down before a large Constantine's bath of it, I found it strangely
concreted into lumps, here and there rolling about in the liquid part. It was
our business to squeeze these lumps back into fluid. A sweet and unctuous duty!
No wonder that in old times this sperm was such a favourite cosmetic. Such a
clearer! such a sweetener! such a softener! such a delicious molifier! After
having my hands in it for only a few minutes, my fingers felt like eels, and
began, as it were, to serpentine and spiralise.
As
I sat there at my ease, cross-legged on the deck; after the bitter exertion at
the windlass; under a blue tranquil sky; the ship under indolent sail, and
gliding so serenely along; as I bathed my hands among those soft, gentle
globules of infiltrated tissues, woven almost within the hour; as they richly
broke to my fingers, and discharged all their opulence, like fully ripe grapes
their wine; as I snuffed up that uncontaminated aroma,—literally and truly,
like the smell of spring violets; I declare to you, that for the time I lived
as in a musky meadow; I forgot all about our horrible oath; in that
inexpressible sperm, I washed my hands and my heart of it; I almost began to
credit the old Paracelsan superstition that sperm is of rare virtue in allaying
the heat of anger; while bathing in that bath, I felt divinely free from all
ill-will, or petulance, or malice, of any sort whatsoever.
Squeeze!
squeeze! squeeze! all the morning long; I squeezed that sperm till I myself
almost melted into it; I squeezed that sperm till a strange sort of insanity
came over me; and I found myself unwittingly squeezing my co-laborers' hands in
it, mistaking their hands for the gentle globules. Such an abounding,
affectionate, friendly, loving feeling did this avocation beget; that at last I
was continually squeezing their hands, and looking up into their eyes
sentimentally; as much as to say,—Oh! my dear fellow beings, why should we
longer cherish any social acerbities, or know the slightest ill-humor or envy!
Come; let us squeeze hands all round; nay, let us all squeeze ourselves into
each other; let us squeeze ourselves universally into the very milk and sperm
of kindness.
Would
that I could keep squeezing that sperm for ever! For now, since by many
prolonged, repeated experiences, I have perceived that in all cases man must
eventually lower, or at least shift, his conceit of attainable felicity; not
placing it anywhere in the intellect or the fancy; but in the wife, the heart,
the bed, the table, the saddle, the fireside, the country; now that I have
perceived all this, I am ready to squeeze case eternally. In thoughts of the
visions of the night, I saw long rows of angels in paradise, each with his
hands in a jar of spermaceti.
Now,
while discoursing of sperm, it behooves to speak of other things akin to it, in
the business of preparing the sperm whale for the try-works.
First
comes white-horse, so called, which is obtained from the tapering part of the
fish, and also from the thicker portions of his flukes. It is tough with
congealed tendons—a wad of muscle—but still contains some oil. After being
severed from the whale, the white-horse is first cut into portable oblongs ere
going to the mincer. They look much like blocks of Berkshire marble.
Plum-pudding
is the term bestowed upon certain fragmentary parts of the whale's flesh, here
and there adhering to the blanket of blubber, and often participating to a
considerable degree in its unctuousness. It is a most refreshing, convivial,
beautiful object to behold. As its name imports, it is of an exceedingly rich,
mottled tint, with a bestreaked snowy and golden ground, dotted with spots of
the deepest crimson and purple. It is plums of rubies, in pictures of citron.
Spite of reason, it is hard to keep yourself from eating it. I confess, that
once I stole behind the foremast to try it. It tasted something as I should
conceive a royal cutlet from the thigh of Louis le Gros might have tasted,
supposing him to have been killed the first day after the venison season, and
that particular venison season contemporary with an unusually fine vintage of
the vineyards of Champagne.
There
is another substance, and a very singular one, which turns up in the course of
this business, but which I feel it to be very puzzling adequately to describe.
It is called slobgollion; an appellation original with the whalemen, and even
so is the nature of the substance. It is an ineffably oozy, stringy affair,
most frequently found in the tubs of sperm, after a prolonged squeezing, and
subsequent decanting. I hold it to be the wondrously thin, ruptured membranes
of the case, coalescing.
Gurry,
so called, is a term properly belonging to right whalemen, but sometimes
incidentally used by the sperm fishermen. It designates the dark, glutinous
substance which is scraped off the back of the Greenland or right whale, and
much of which covers the decks of those inferior souls who hunt that ignoble
Leviathan.
Nippers.
Strictly this word is not indigenous to the whale's vocabulary. But as applied
by whalemen, it becomes so. A whaleman's nipper is a short firm strip of
tendinous stuff cut from the tapering part of Leviathan's tail: it averages an
inch in thickness, and for the rest, is about the size of the iron part of a
hoe. Edgewise moved along the oily deck, it operates like a leathern squilgee;
and by nameless blandishments, as of magic, allures along with it all
impurities.
But
to learn all about these recondite matters, your best way is at once to descend
into the blubber-room, and have a long talk with its inmates. This place has
previously been mentioned as the receptacle for the blanket-pieces, when stript
and hoisted from the whale. When the proper time arrives for cutting up its
contents, this apartment is a scene of terror to all tyros, especially by
night. On one side, lit by a dull lantern, a space has been left clear for the
workmen. They generally go in pairs,—a pike-and-gaffman and a spade-man. The
whaling-pike is similar to a frigate's boarding-weapon of the same name. The
gaff is something like a boat-hook. With his gaff, the gaffman hooks on to a
sheet of blubber, and strives to hold it from slipping, as the ship pitches and
lurches about. Meanwhile, the spade-man stands on the sheet itself,
perpendicularly chopping it into the portable horse-pieces. This spade is sharp
as hone can make it; the spademan's feet are shoeless; the thing he stands on
will sometimes irresistibly slide away from him, like a sledge. If he cuts off
one of his own toes, or one of his assistants', would you be very much
astonished? Toes are scarce among veteran blubber-room men.
CHAPTER
95. The Cassock.
Had
you stepped on board the Pequod at a certain juncture of this post-mortemizing
of the whale; and had you strolled forward nigh the windlass, pretty sure am I
that you would have scanned with no small curiosity a very strange, enigmatical
object, which you would have seen there, lying along lengthwise in the lee
scuppers. Not the wondrous cistern in the whale's huge head; not the prodigy of
his unhinged lower jaw; not the miracle of his symmetrical tail; none of these
would so surprise you, as half a glimpse of that unaccountable cone,—longer
than a Kentuckian is tall, nigh a foot in diameter at the base, and jet-black
as Yojo, the ebony idol of Queequeg. And an idol, indeed, it is; or, rather, in
old times, its likeness was. Such an idol as that found in the secret groves of
Queen Maachah in Judea; and for worshipping which, King Asa, her son, did
depose her, and destroyed the idol, and burnt it for an abomination at the
brook Kedron, as darkly set forth in the 15th chapter of the First Book of
Kings.
Look
at the sailor, called the mincer, who now comes along, and assisted by two
allies, heavily backs the grandissimus, as the mariners call it, and with bowed
shoulders, staggers off with it as if he were a grenadier carrying a dead
comrade from the field. Extending it upon the forecastle deck, he now proceeds
cylindrically to remove its dark pelt, as an African hunter the pelt of a boa.
This done he turns the pelt inside out, like a pantaloon leg; gives it a good
stretching, so as almost to double its diameter; and at last hangs it, well
spread, in the rigging, to dry. Ere long, it is taken down; when removing some
three feet of it, towards the pointed extremity, and then cutting two slits for
arm-holes at the other end, he lengthwise slips himself bodily into it. The
mincer now stands before you invested in the full canonicals of his calling.
Immemorial to all his order, this investiture alone will adequately protect
him, while employed in the peculiar functions of his office.
That
office consists in mincing the horse-pieces of blubber for the pots; an
operation which is conducted at a curious wooden horse, planted endwise against
the bulwarks, and with a capacious tub beneath it, into which the minced pieces
drop, fast as the sheets from a rapt orator's desk. Arrayed in decent black;
occupying a conspicuous pulpit; intent on bible leaves; what a candidate for an
archbishopric, what a lad for a Pope were this mincer!*
*Bible
leaves! Bible leaves! This is the invariable cry from the mates to the mincer.
It enjoins him to be careful, and cut his work into as thin slices as possible,
inasmuch as by so doing the business of boiling out the oil is much
accelerated, and its quantity considerably increased, besides perhaps improving
it in quality.
CHAPTER
96. The Try-Works.
Besides
her hoisted boats, an American whaler is outwardly distinguished by her
try-works. She presents the curious anomaly of the most solid masonry joining
with oak and hemp in constituting the completed ship. It is as if from the open
field a brick-kiln were transported to her planks.
The
try-works are planted between the foremast and mainmast, the most roomy part of
the deck. The timbers beneath are of a peculiar strength, fitted to sustain the
weight of an almost solid mass of brick and mortar, some ten feet by eight
square, and five in height. The foundation does not penetrate the deck, but the
masonry is firmly secured to the surface by ponderous knees of iron bracing it
on all sides, and screwing it down to the timbers. On the flanks it is cased
with wood, and at top completely covered by a large, sloping, battened
hatchway. Removing this hatch we expose the great try-pots, two in number, and
each of several barrels' capacity. When not in use, they are kept remarkably
clean. Sometimes they are polished with soapstone and sand, till they shine
within like silver punch-bowls. During the night-watches some cynical old
sailors will crawl into them and coil themselves away there for a nap. While
employed in polishing them—one man in each pot, side by side—many confidential
communications are carried on, over the iron lips. It is a place also for
profound mathematical meditation. It was in the left hand try-pot of the Pequod,
with the soapstone diligently circling round me, that I was first indirectly
struck by the remarkable fact, that in geometry all bodies gliding along the
cycloid, my soapstone for example, will descend from any point in precisely the
same time.
Removing
the fire-board from the front of the try-works, the bare masonry of that side
is exposed, penetrated by the two iron mouths of the furnaces, directly
underneath the pots. These mouths are fitted with heavy doors of iron. The
intense heat of the fire is prevented from communicating itself to the deck, by
means of a shallow reservoir extending under the entire inclosed surface of the
works. By a tunnel inserted at the rear, this reservoir is kept replenished
with water as fast as it evaporates. There are no external chimneys; they open
direct from the rear wall. And here let us go back for a moment.
It
was about nine o'clock at night that the Pequod's try-works were first started
on this present voyage. It belonged to Stubb to oversee the business.
“All
ready there? Off hatch, then, and start her. You cook, fire the works.” This
was an easy thing, for the carpenter had been thrusting his shavings into the
furnace throughout the passage. Here be it said that in a whaling voyage the
first fire in the try-works has to be fed for a time with wood. After that no
wood is used, except as a means of quick ignition to the staple fuel. In a
word, after being tried out, the crisp, shrivelled blubber, now called scraps
or fritters, still contains considerable of its unctuous properties. These
fritters feed the flames. Like a plethoric burning martyr, or a self-consuming
misanthrope, once ignited, the whale supplies his own fuel and burns by his own
body. Would that he consumed his own smoke! for his smoke is horrible to
inhale, and inhale it you must, and not only that, but you must live in it for
the time. It has an unspeakable, wild, Hindoo odor about it, such as may lurk
in the vicinity of funereal pyres. It smells like the left wing of the day of
judgment; it is an argument for the pit.
By
midnight the works were in full operation. We were clear from the carcase; sail
had been made; the wind was freshening; the wild ocean darkness was intense.
But that darkness was licked up by the fierce flames, which at intervals forked
forth from the sooty flues, and illuminated every lofty rope in the rigging, as
with the famed Greek fire. The burning ship drove on, as if remorselessly
commissioned to some vengeful deed. So the pitch and sulphur-freighted brigs of
the bold Hydriote, Canaris, issuing from their midnight harbors, with broad
sheets of flame for sails, bore down upon the Turkish frigates, and folded them
in conflagrations.
The
hatch, removed from the top of the works, now afforded a wide hearth in front
of them. Standing on this were the Tartarean shapes of the pagan harpooneers,
always the whale-ship's stokers. With huge pronged poles they pitched hissing
masses of blubber into the scalding pots, or stirred up the fires beneath, till
the snaky flames darted, curling, out of the doors to catch them by the feet.
The smoke rolled away in sullen heaps. To every pitch of the ship there was a
pitch of the boiling oil, which seemed all eagerness to leap into their faces.
Opposite the mouth of the works, on the further side of the wide wooden hearth,
was the windlass. This served for a sea-sofa. Here lounged the watch, when not
otherwise employed, looking into the red heat of the fire, till their eyes felt
scorched in their heads. Their tawny features, now all begrimed with smoke and
sweat, their matted beards, and the contrasting barbaric brilliancy of their
teeth, all these were strangely revealed in the capricious emblazonings of the
works. As they narrated to each other their unholy adventures, their tales of
terror told in words of mirth; as their uncivilized laughter forked upwards out
of them, like the flames from the furnace; as to and fro, in their front, the
harpooneers wildly gesticulated with their huge pronged forks and dippers; as
the wind howled on, and the sea leaped, and the ship groaned and dived, and yet
steadfastly shot her red hell further and further into the blackness of the sea
and the night, and scornfully champed the white bone in her mouth, and
viciously spat round her on all sides; then the rushing Pequod, freighted with
savages, and laden with fire, and burning a corpse, and plunging into that
blackness of darkness, seemed the material counterpart of her monomaniac
commander's soul.
So
seemed it to me, as I stood at her helm, and for long hours silently guided the
way of this fire-ship on the sea. Wrapped, for that interval, in darkness
myself, I but the better saw the redness, the madness, the ghastliness of
others. The continual sight of the fiend shapes before me, capering half in
smoke and half in fire, these at last begat kindred visions in my soul, so soon
as I began to yield to that unaccountable drowsiness which ever would come over
me at a midnight helm.
But
that night, in particular, a strange (and ever since inexplicable) thing occurred
to me. Starting from a brief standing sleep, I was horribly conscious of
something fatally wrong. The jaw-bone tiller smote my side, which leaned
against it; in my ears was the low hum of sails, just beginning to shake in the
wind; I thought my eyes were open; I was half conscious of putting my fingers
to the lids and mechanically stretching them still further apart. But, spite of
all this, I could see no compass before me to steer by; though it seemed but a
minute since I had been watching the card, by the steady binnacle lamp
illuminating it. Nothing seemed before me but a jet gloom, now and then made
ghastly by flashes of redness. Uppermost was the impression, that whatever
swift, rushing thing I stood on was not so much bound to any haven ahead as rushing
from all havens astern. A stark, bewildered feeling, as of death, came over me.
Convulsively my hands grasped the tiller, but with the crazy conceit that the
tiller was, somehow, in some enchanted way, inverted. My God! what is the
matter with me? thought I. Lo! in my brief sleep I had turned myself about, and
was fronting the ship's stern, with my back to her prow and the compass. In an
instant I faced back, just in time to prevent the vessel from flying up into
the wind, and very probably capsizing her. How glad and how grateful the relief
from this unnatural hallucination of the night, and the fatal contingency of
being brought by the lee!
Look
not too long in the face of the fire, O man! Never dream with thy hand on the
helm! Turn not thy back to the compass; accept the first hint of the hitching
tiller; believe not the artificial fire, when its redness makes all things look
ghastly. To-morrow, in the natural sun, the skies will be bright; those who
glared like devils in the forking flames, the morn will show in far other, at
least gentler, relief; the glorious, golden, glad sun, the only true lamp—all
others but liars!
Nevertheless
the sun hides not Virginia's Dismal Swamp, nor Rome's accursed Campagna, nor
wide Sahara, nor all the millions of miles of deserts and of griefs beneath the
moon. The sun hides not the ocean, which is the dark side of this earth, and
which is two thirds of this earth. So, therefore, that mortal man who hath more
of joy than sorrow in him, that mortal man cannot be true—not true, or
undeveloped. With books the same. The truest of all men was the Man of Sorrows,
and the truest of all books is Solomon's, and Ecclesiastes is the fine hammered
steel of woe. “All is vanity.” ALL. This wilful world hath not got hold of
unchristian Solomon's wisdom yet. But he who dodges hospitals and jails, and
walks fast crossing graveyards, and would rather talk of operas than hell;
calls Cowper, Young, Pascal, Rousseau, poor devils all of sick men; and
throughout a care-free lifetime swears by Rabelais as passing wise, and
therefore jolly;—not that man is fitted to sit down on tomb-stones, and break
the green damp mould with unfathomably wondrous Solomon.
But
even Solomon, he says, “the man that wandereth out of the way of understanding
shall remain” (i.e., even while living) “in the congregation of the dead.” Give
not thyself up, then, to fire, lest it invert thee, deaden thee; as for the
time it did me. There is a wisdom that is woe; but there is a woe that is
madness. And there is a Catskill eagle in some souls that can alike dive down
into the blackest gorges, and soar out of them again and become invisible in
the sunny spaces. And even if he for ever flies within the gorge, that gorge is
in the mountains; so that even in his lowest swoop the mountain eagle is still
higher than other birds upon the plain, even though they soar.
CHAPTER
97. The Lamp.
Had
you descended from the Pequod's try-works to the Pequod's forecastle, where the
off duty watch were sleeping, for one single moment you would have almost
thought you were standing in some illuminated shrine of canonized kings and
counsellors. There they lay in their triangular oaken vaults, each mariner a
chiselled muteness; a score of lamps flashing upon his hooded eyes.
In
merchantmen, oil for the sailor is more scarce than the milk of queens. To
dress in the dark, and eat in the dark, and stumble in darkness to his pallet,
this is his usual lot. But the whaleman, as he seeks the food of light, so he
lives in light. He makes his berth an Aladdin's lamp, and lays him down in it;
so that in the pitchiest night the ship's black hull still houses an illumination.
See
with what entire freedom the whaleman takes his handful of lamps—often but old
bottles and vials, though—to the copper cooler at the try-works, and
replenishes them there, as mugs of ale at a vat. He burns, too, the purest of
oil, in its unmanufactured, and, therefore, unvitiated state; a fluid unknown
to solar, lunar, or astral contrivances ashore. It is sweet as early grass
butter in April. He goes and hunts for his oil, so as to be sure of its
freshness and genuineness, even as the traveller on the prairie hunts up his
own supper of game.
CHAPTER
98. Stowing Down and Clearing Up.
Already
has it been related how the great leviathan is afar off descried from the
mast-head; how he is chased over the watery moors, and slaughtered in the
valleys of the deep; how he is then towed alongside and beheaded; and how (on
the principle which entitled the headsman of old to the garments in which the
beheaded was killed) his great padded surtout becomes the property of his
executioner; how, in due time, he is condemned to the pots, and, like Shadrach,
Meshach, and Abednego, his spermaceti, oil, and bone pass unscathed through the
fire;—but now it remains to conclude the last chapter of this part of the
description by rehearsing—singing, if I may—the romantic proceeding of
decanting off his oil into the casks and striking them down into the hold,
where once again leviathan returns to his native profundities, sliding along
beneath the surface as before; but, alas! never more to rise and blow.
While
still warm, the oil, like hot punch, is received into the six-barrel casks; and
while, perhaps, the ship is pitching and rolling this way and that in the
midnight sea, the enormous casks are slewed round and headed over, end for end,
and sometimes perilously scoot across the slippery deck, like so many land
slides, till at last man-handled and stayed in their course; and all round the
hoops, rap, rap, go as many hammers as can play upon them, for now, ex officio,
every sailor is a cooper.
At
length, when the last pint is casked, and all is cool, then the great hatchways
are unsealed, the bowels of the ship are thrown open, and down go the casks to
their final rest in the sea. This done, the hatches are replaced, and
hermetically closed, like a closet walled up.
In
the sperm fishery, this is perhaps one of the most remarkable incidents in all
the business of whaling. One day the planks stream with freshets of blood and
oil; on the sacred quarter-deck enormous masses of the whale's head are
profanely piled; great rusty casks lie about, as in a brewery yard; the smoke
from the try-works has besooted all the bulwarks; the mariners go about
suffused with unctuousness; the entire ship seems great leviathan himself;
while on all hands the din is deafening.
But
a day or two after, you look about you, and prick your ears in this self-same
ship; and were it not for the tell-tale boats and try-works, you would all but
swear you trod some silent merchant vessel, with a most scrupulously neat
commander. The unmanufactured sperm oil possesses a singularly cleansing
virtue. This is the reason why the decks never look so white as just after what
they call an affair of oil. Besides, from the ashes of the burned scraps of the
whale, a potent lye is readily made; and whenever any adhesiveness from the
back of the whale remains clinging to the side, that lye quickly exterminates
it. Hands go diligently along the bulwarks, and with buckets of water and rags
restore them to their full tidiness. The soot is brushed from the lower
rigging. All the numerous implements which have been in use are likewise
faithfully cleansed and put away. The great hatch is scrubbed and placed upon
the try-works, completely hiding the pots; every cask is out of sight; all
tackles are coiled in unseen nooks; and when by the combined and simultaneous
industry of almost the entire ship's company, the whole of this conscientious
duty is at last concluded, then the crew themselves proceed to their own
ablutions; shift themselves from top to toe; and finally issue to the
immaculate deck, fresh and all aglow, as bridegrooms new-leaped from out the
daintiest Holland.
Now,
with elated step, they pace the planks in twos and threes, and humorously
discourse of parlors, sofas, carpets, and fine cambrics; propose to mat the
deck; think of having hanging to the top; object not to taking tea by moonlight
on the piazza of the forecastle. To hint to such musked mariners of oil, and
bone, and blubber, were little short of audacity. They know not the thing you
distantly allude to. Away, and bring us napkins!
But
mark: aloft there, at the three mast heads, stand three men intent on spying
out more whales, which, if caught, infallibly will again soil the old oaken
furniture, and drop at least one small grease-spot somewhere. Yes; and many is
the time, when, after the severest uninterrupted labors, which know no night;
continuing straight through for ninety-six hours; when from the boat, where
they have swelled their wrists with all day rowing on the Line,—they only step
to the deck to carry vast chains, and heave the heavy windlass, and cut and
slash, yea, and in their very sweatings to be smoked and burned anew by the
combined fires of the equatorial sun and the equatorial try-works; when, on the
heel of all this, they have finally bestirred themselves to cleanse the ship,
and make a spotless dairy room of it; many is the time the poor fellows, just
buttoning the necks of their clean frocks, are startled by the cry of “There
she blows!” and away they fly to fight another whale, and go through the whole
weary thing again. Oh! my friends, but this is man-killing! Yet this is life.
For hardly have we mortals by long toilings extracted from this world's vast
bulk its small but valuable sperm; and then, with weary patience, cleansed
ourselves from its defilements, and learned to live here in clean tabernacles
of the soul; hardly is this done, when—There she blows!—the ghost is spouted
up, and away we sail to fight some other world, and go through young life's old
routine again.
Oh!
the metempsychosis! Oh! Pythagoras, that in bright Greece, two thousand years
ago, did die, so good, so wise, so mild; I sailed with thee along the Peruvian
coast last voyage—and, foolish as I am, taught thee, a green simple boy, how to
splice a rope!
CHAPTER
99. The Doubloon.
Ere
now it has been related how Ahab was wont to pace his quarter-deck, taking
regular turns at either limit, the binnacle and mainmast; but in the
multiplicity of other things requiring narration it has not been added how that
sometimes in these walks, when most plunged in his mood, he was wont to pause
in turn at each spot, and stand there strangely eyeing the particular object
before him. When he halted before the binnacle, with his glance fastened on the
pointed needle in the compass, that glance shot like a javelin with the pointed
intensity of his purpose; and when resuming his walk he again paused before the
mainmast, then, as the same riveted glance fastened upon the riveted gold coin
there, he still wore the same aspect of nailed firmness, only dashed with a
certain wild longing, if not hopefulness.
But
one morning, turning to pass the doubloon, he seemed to be newly attracted by
the strange figures and inscriptions stamped on it, as though now for the first
time beginning to interpret for himself in some monomaniac way whatever
significance might lurk in them. And some certain significance lurks in all
things, else all things are little worth, and the round world itself but an
empty cipher, except to sell by the cartload, as they do hills about Boston, to
fill up some morass in the Milky Way.
Now
this doubloon was of purest, virgin gold, raked somewhere out of the heart of
gorgeous hills, whence, east and west, over golden sands, the head-waters of
many a Pactolus flows. And though now nailed amidst all the rustiness of iron
bolts and the verdigris of copper spikes, yet, untouchable and immaculate to
any foulness, it still preserved its Quito glow. Nor, though placed amongst a
ruthless crew and every hour passed by ruthless hands, and through the livelong
nights shrouded with thick darkness which might cover any pilfering approach,
nevertheless every sunrise found the doubloon where the sunset left it last.
For it was set apart and sanctified to one awe-striking end; and however wanton
in their sailor ways, one and all, the mariners revered it as the white whale's
talisman. Sometimes they talked it over in the weary watch by night, wondering
whose it was to be at last, and whether he would ever live to spend it.
Now
those noble golden coins of South America are as medals of the sun and tropic
token-pieces. Here palms, alpacas, and volcanoes; sun's disks and stars;
ecliptics, horns-of-plenty, and rich banners waving, are in luxuriant profusion
stamped; so that the precious gold seems almost to derive an added preciousness
and enhancing glories, by passing through those fancy mints, so Spanishly
poetic.
It
so chanced that the doubloon of the Pequod was a most wealthy example of these
things. On its round border it bore the letters, REPUBLICA DEL ECUADOR: QUITO.
So this bright coin came from a country planted in the middle of the world, and
beneath the great equator, and named after it; and it had been cast midway up
the Andes, in the unwaning clime that knows no autumn. Zoned by those letters
you saw the likeness of three Andes' summits; from one a flame; a tower on
another; on the third a crowing cock; while arching over all was a segment of
the partitioned zodiac, the signs all marked with their usual cabalistics, and
the keystone sun entering the equinoctial point at Libra.
Before
this equatorial coin, Ahab, not unobserved by others, was now pausing.
“There's
something ever egotistical in mountain-tops and towers, and all other grand and
lofty things; look here,—three peaks as proud as Lucifer. The firm tower, that
is Ahab; the volcano, that is Ahab; the courageous, the undaunted, and
victorious fowl, that, too, is Ahab; all are Ahab; and this round gold is but
the image of the rounder globe, which, like a magician's glass, to each and
every man in turn but mirrors back his own mysterious self. Great pains, small
gains for those who ask the world to solve them; it cannot solve itself.
Methinks now this coined sun wears a ruddy face; but see! aye, he enters the sign
of storms, the equinox! and but six months before he wheeled out of a former
equinox at Aries! From storm to storm! So be it, then. Born in throes, 'tis fit
that man should live in pains and die in pangs! So be it, then! Here's stout
stuff for woe to work on. So be it, then.”
“No
fairy fingers can have pressed the gold, but devil's claws must have left their
mouldings there since yesterday,” murmured Starbuck to himself, leaning against
the bulwarks. “The old man seems to read Belshazzar's awful writing. I have
never marked the coin inspectingly. He goes below; let me read. A dark valley
between three mighty, heaven-abiding peaks, that almost seem the Trinity, in
some faint earthly symbol. So in this vale of Death, God girds us round; and
over all our gloom, the sun of Righteousness still shines a beacon and a hope.
If we bend down our eyes, the dark vale shows her mouldy soil; but if we lift
them, the bright sun meets our glance half way, to cheer. Yet, oh, the great
sun is no fixture; and if, at midnight, we would fain snatch some sweet solace
from him, we gaze for him in vain! This coin speaks wisely, mildly, truly, but
still sadly to me. I will quit it, lest Truth shake me falsely.”
“There
now's the old Mogul,” soliloquized Stubb by the try-works, “he's been twigging
it; and there goes Starbuck from the same, and both with faces which I should
say might be somewhere within nine fathoms long. And all from looking at a
piece of gold, which did I have it now on Negro Hill or in Corlaer's Hook, I'd
not look at it very long ere spending it. Humph! in my poor, insignificant
opinion, I regard this as queer. I have seen doubloons before now in my
voyagings; your doubloons of old Spain, your doubloons of Peru, your doubloons
of Chili, your doubloons of Bolivia, your doubloons of Popayan; with plenty of
gold moidores and pistoles, and joes, and half joes, and quarter joes. What
then should there be in this doubloon of the Equator that is so killing
wonderful? By Golconda! let me read it once. Halloa! here's signs and wonders
truly! That, now, is what old Bowditch in his Epitome calls the zodiac, and
what my almanac below calls ditto. I'll get the almanac and as I have heard
devils can be raised with Daboll's arithmetic, I'll try my hand at raising a
meaning out of these queer curvicues here with the Massachusetts calendar.
Here's the book. Let's see now. Signs and wonders; and the sun, he's always
among 'em. Hem, hem, hem; here they are—here they go—all alive:—Aries, or the
Ram; Taurus, or the Bull and Jimimi! here's Gemini himself, or the Twins. Well;
the sun he wheels among 'em. Aye, here on the coin he's just crossing the
threshold between two of twelve sitting-rooms all in a ring. Book! you lie
there; the fact is, you books must know your places. You'll do to give us the
bare words and facts, but we come in to supply the thoughts. That's my small
experience, so far as the Massachusetts calendar, and Bowditch's navigator, and
Daboll's arithmetic go. Signs and wonders, eh? Pity if there is nothing
wonderful in signs, and significant in wonders! There's a clue somewhere; wait
a bit; hist—hark! By Jove, I have it! Look you, Doubloon, your zodiac here is
the life of man in one round chapter; and now I'll read it off, straight out of
the book. Come, Almanack! To begin: there's Aries, or the Ram—lecherous dog, he
begets us; then, Taurus, or the Bull—he bumps us the first thing; then Gemini,
or the Twins—that is, Virtue and Vice; we try to reach Virtue, when lo! comes
Cancer the Crab, and drags us back; and here, going from Virtue, Leo, a roaring
Lion, lies in the path—he gives a few fierce bites and surly dabs with his paw;
we escape, and hail Virgo, the Virgin! that's our first love; we marry and
think to be happy for aye, when pop comes Libra, or the Scales—happiness weighed
and found wanting; and while we are very sad about that, Lord! how we suddenly
jump, as Scorpio, or the Scorpion, stings us in the rear; we are curing the
wound, when whang come the arrows all round; Sagittarius, or the Archer, is
amusing himself. As we pluck out the shafts, stand aside! here's the
battering-ram, Capricornus, or the Goat; full tilt, he comes rushing, and
headlong we are tossed; when Aquarius, or the Water-bearer, pours out his whole
deluge and drowns us; and to wind up with Pisces, or the Fishes, we sleep.
There's a sermon now, writ in high heaven, and the sun goes through it every
year, and yet comes out of it all alive and hearty. Jollily he, aloft there,
wheels through toil and trouble; and so, alow here, does jolly Stubb. Oh, jolly's
the word for aye! Adieu, Doubloon! But stop; here comes little King-Post; dodge
round the try-works, now, and let's hear what he'll have to say. There; he's
before it; he'll out with something presently. So, so; he's beginning.”
“I
see nothing here, but a round thing made of gold, and whoever raises a certain
whale, this round thing belongs to him. So, what's all this staring been about?
It is worth sixteen dollars, that's true; and at two cents the cigar, that's
nine hundred and sixty cigars. I won't smoke dirty pipes like Stubb, but I like
cigars, and here's nine hundred and sixty of them; so here goes Flask aloft to
spy 'em out.”
“Shall
I call that wise or foolish, now; if it be really wise it has a foolish look to
it; yet, if it be really foolish, then has it a sort of wiseish look to it.
But, avast; here comes our old Manxman—the old hearse-driver, he must have
been, that is, before he took to the sea. He luffs up before the doubloon;
halloa, and goes round on the other side of the mast; why, there's a horse-shoe
nailed on that side; and now he's back again; what does that mean? Hark! he's
muttering—voice like an old worn-out coffee-mill. Prick ears, and listen!”
“If
the White Whale be raised, it must be in a month and a day, when the sun stands
in some one of these signs. I've studied signs, and know their marks; they were
taught me two score years ago, by the old witch in Copenhagen. Now, in what
sign will the sun then be? The horse-shoe sign; for there it is, right opposite
the gold. And what's the horse-shoe sign? The lion is the horse-shoe sign—the
roaring and devouring lion. Ship, old ship! my old head shakes to think of thee.”
“There's
another rendering now; but still one text. All sorts of men in one kind of
world, you see. Dodge again! here comes Queequeg—all tattooing—looks like the
signs of the Zodiac himself. What says the Cannibal? As I live he's comparing
notes; looking at his thigh bone; thinks the sun is in the thigh, or in the
calf, or in the bowels, I suppose, as the old women talk Surgeon's Astronomy in
the back country. And by Jove, he's found something there in the vicinity of
his thigh—I guess it's Sagittarius, or the Archer. No: he don't know what to
make of the doubloon; he takes it for an old button off some king's trowsers.
But, aside again! here comes that ghost-devil, Fedallah; tail coiled out of
sight as usual, oakum in the toes of his pumps as usual. What does he say, with
that look of his? Ah, only makes a sign to the sign and bows himself; there is
a sun on the coin—fire worshipper, depend upon it. Ho! more and more. This way
comes Pip—poor boy! would he had died, or I; he's half horrible to me. He too
has been watching all of these interpreters—myself included—and look now, he
comes to read, with that unearthly idiot face. Stand away again and hear him.
Hark!”
“I
look, you look, he looks; we look, ye look, they look.”
“Upon
my soul, he's been studying Murray's Grammar! Improving his mind, poor fellow!
But what's that he says now—hist!”
“I
look, you look, he looks; we look, ye look, they look.”
“Why,
he's getting it by heart—hist! again.”
“I
look, you look, he looks; we look, ye look, they look.”
“Well,
that's funny.”
“And
I, you, and he; and we, ye, and they, are all bats; and I'm a crow, especially
when I stand a'top of this pine tree here. Caw! caw! caw! caw! caw! caw! Ain't
I a crow? And where's the scare-crow? There he stands; two bones stuck into a
pair of old trowsers, and two more poked into the sleeves of an old jacket.”
“Wonder
if he means me?—complimentary!—poor lad!—I could go hang myself. Any way, for
the present, I'll quit Pip's vicinity. I can stand the rest, for they have plain
wits; but he's too crazy-witty for my sanity. So, so, I leave him muttering.”
“Here's
the ship's navel, this doubloon here, and they are all on fire to unscrew it.
But, unscrew your navel, and what's the consequence? Then again, if it stays
here, that is ugly, too, for when aught's nailed to the mast it's a sign that
things grow desperate. Ha, ha! old Ahab! the White Whale; he'll nail ye! This
is a pine tree. My father, in old Tolland county, cut down a pine tree once,
and found a silver ring grown over in it; some old darkey's wedding ring. How
did it get there? And so they'll say in the resurrection, when they come to
fish up this old mast, and find a doubloon lodged in it, with bedded oysters
for the shaggy bark. Oh, the gold! the precious, precious, gold! the green
miser'll hoard ye soon! Hish! hish! God goes 'mong the worlds blackberrying.
Cook! ho, cook! and cook us! Jenny! hey, hey, hey, hey, hey, Jenny, Jenny! and
get your hoe-cake done!”
Comments
Post a Comment